TW379495B - Electronic mail system and storage medium storing electronic mail processing program - Google Patents

Electronic mail system and storage medium storing electronic mail processing program Download PDF

Info

Publication number
TW379495B
TW379495B TW87118845A TW87118845A TW379495B TW 379495 B TW379495 B TW 379495B TW 87118845 A TW87118845 A TW 87118845A TW 87118845 A TW87118845 A TW 87118845A TW 379495 B TW379495 B TW 379495B
Authority
TW
Taiwan
Prior art keywords
itinerary
mail
data
email
display
Prior art date
Application number
TW87118845A
Other languages
Chinese (zh)
Inventor
Yoshito Yamaguchi
Original Assignee
Casio Computer Co Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from JP32971897A external-priority patent/JPH11149506A/en
Priority claimed from JP33084397A external-priority patent/JPH11150558A/en
Priority claimed from JP36378197A external-priority patent/JPH11187065A/en
Priority claimed from JP35446197A external-priority patent/JPH11184929A/en
Application filed by Casio Computer Co Ltd filed Critical Casio Computer Co Ltd
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of TW379495B publication Critical patent/TW379495B/en

Links

Classifications

    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06QINFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGY [ICT] SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES; SYSTEMS OR METHODS SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES, NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
    • G06Q10/00Administration; Management
    • G06Q10/10Office automation; Time management
    • G06Q10/109Time management, e.g. calendars, reminders, meetings or time accounting
    • GPHYSICS
    • G06COMPUTING; CALCULATING OR COUNTING
    • G06QINFORMATION AND COMMUNICATION TECHNOLOGY [ICT] SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES; SYSTEMS OR METHODS SPECIALLY ADAPTED FOR ADMINISTRATIVE, COMMERCIAL, FINANCIAL, MANAGERIAL OR SUPERVISORY PURPOSES, NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
    • G06Q10/00Administration; Management
    • G06Q10/10Office automation; Time management
    • G06Q10/107Computer-aided management of electronic mailing [e-mailing]
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H04ELECTRIC COMMUNICATION TECHNIQUE
    • H04LTRANSMISSION OF DIGITAL INFORMATION, e.g. TELEGRAPHIC COMMUNICATION
    • H04L51/00User-to-user messaging in packet-switching networks, transmitted according to store-and-forward or real-time protocols, e.g. e-mail
    • H04L51/42Mailbox-related aspects, e.g. synchronisation of mailboxes

Landscapes

  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Business, Economics & Management (AREA)
  • Human Resources & Organizations (AREA)
  • Entrepreneurship & Innovation (AREA)
  • Strategic Management (AREA)
  • Operations Research (AREA)
  • Tourism & Hospitality (AREA)
  • Theoretical Computer Science (AREA)
  • Economics (AREA)
  • Marketing (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Quality & Reliability (AREA)
  • Data Mining & Analysis (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • General Business, Economics & Management (AREA)
  • Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
  • Signal Processing (AREA)
  • Computer Hardware Design (AREA)
  • Information Transfer Between Computers (AREA)
  • Management, Administration, Business Operations System, And Electronic Commerce (AREA)

Abstract

When an electronic mail system receives an electronic mail for schedule registration of an event from an electronic mail server, a schedule which has been registered in RAM is confirmed and if a free time zone for an assembly of an event is available, the event is registered. If the assembly time zone of the event is in duplication with a schedule which has been registered, not only is another free time zone on the same day as the event noticed but an electronic mail inquiring whether or not a change of the assembly time zone of the event to the free time zone is possible is transmitted to a transmitter of the mail for schedule registration. Thereafter, it is determined whether or not received is a response electronic mail indicating that the assembly time zone of the event is changed to the free time zone, the changed event schedule is registered in RAM.

Description

經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(》) 〔發明之背景〕 1 .發明之領域 本發明有關於用以收發電子郵件之電子郵件裝置,和 有關記錄為收發電子郵件所需的電子郵件處理程式之記 錄媒體。 2 .相關技術之説明 電子郵件是用以提高生産性之強力工具,被導入到多 數企業,日漸急速普及。 例如,擬舉行會議時,會議主辦人必須要將會議預定 事項通知給要求參加的人。作為此種通知之手段電子郵 件即備受活用〇這時作業大概依照下列方式之流程。 首先,主辦人將記載有會議之日期和場所之電子郵件 發信給被要求參加會議之人。收信到該電子郵件之收信 人應通知表示是否出席該會議之電子郵件發信給會議主 辦人,若要出席該會議時,就令本身之行程管理,進行 登錄作業將該會議之預定登錄在行程表上。 然而,施行此種管理之行程表以前是以筆記工具寫入 筆記本之行程表等。但是,最近即使用行程軟體,在個 人電腦畫面上之行程表予以行程之登錄、刪除、變更等 , ,曰益廣泛普及。另外,尤其是在市場上被稱為可動 (mobile)電腦等攜帶型之資訊終端機器等,兼備著行程 功能和電子郵件功能者,已大量被銷售著。 即使為習知技術之此種兼具有行程功能和電子郵件功 能之機器,因為未使雙方之功能連動的緣故,例如,上 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標隼(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) ---------〈wei— (請先閣讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(&gt; ) 述會議開議通知之電子郵件等,即使收信到表示需要施 行行程之新預定登錄之電子郵件時,使用該機器之使用 者亦必需進行電子郵件内容之確認,行程内容之確認, 告知是否出席之電子郵件回信,和將新的預定輸入到行 程表之一連貫作業,要使電子郵件之處理和行程管理結 合時其作業非常麻煩。 其中可考慮之一種方式是當收信到包含項目(event) 之預定電子郵件時,使行程功能和電子郵件功能連動而 將該項目預定單純的登錄在行程表。但是,如此種方式 者,因為未考慮到已在行程表上登錄過之行程,所以在 項目被預定之時間,會發生重複登錄新的項目預定之間 題。 本發明之目的在於當收信到之電子郵件所記載之項目 預定與登錄過之行程重複時,可自動調整行程。另外, 欲使電子郵件之處理和行程管理加以連結之場合,可使 該等處理簡化,以減輕使用者之負擔者。 〔發明之概要] 本發明之目的是提供一種電子郵件裝置,當收信到之 電子郵件所記載之項目預定與登錄過之行程重複時,可 自動調整行程。3外,提供一種電子郵件裝置,欲使電 子郵件之處理和行程管理加以連結時,可使該處理簡化 ,以減輕使用者之負擔。另外,本發明更可提供用以記 錄該等電子郵件處理程式之記錄媒體。 (1 )亦即,若依照本發明電子郵件裝置之第1形態所 -4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先Μ讀f·面之注意事項异填寫本J) -s A7 B7 五、發明説明(今) 提供者乃包括: 用來接受電子郵件的電子郵件收信手段; 用來記億行程資料的行程資料記億手段; 行程郵件辨別手段,用來辨別藉由上述電子郵件收信 手段所收信到之電子郵件是否為包含有行程資料之行程 郵件; 行程資料比較手段,當藉由上述.行程郵件辨別手段辨 別為上述電子郵件收信手段所收信到之電子郵件為行程 郵件時,用來使上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料和上述 行程資料記億手段所記億之行程資料加以比較,藉以檢 測該兩個行程資料間有無重複; 行程資料記億控制手段,用於當藉由上述行程資料比 較手段之比較,檢測到上述兩個行程資料間並無重複時 ,用來將上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料記億在上述行 程資料記億手段; 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (讀先閩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 用來自動發送電子郵件的電子郵件自動發信手段; 第一電子郵件自動發信控制手段,用於當藉由上述行 程資料比較手段之比較,檢測到上述兩値行程資料之間 有重複時,就在上述電子郵件自動發信手段,將具有避 免上逑重複行程變更的有關資訊之電子郵件,自動發信 給上述行程郵件之發信人;和 變更行程資料記憶控制手段,在藉由上述電子郵件自 動發信手段發送具有上述資訊之電子郵件後,因應具有 該資訊之電子郵件,而能避免上述重複般通知變更上述 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS )八4規格(210X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(4 ) 行程郵件所包含之行程資料,被上述電子郵件收信手段 收到該變更通知之電子郵件時,就將根據上逑資訊變更 之上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料記億在上述行程資料 記億手段。 (2) 依照本發明電子郵件裝置之第2形態所提供者乃 包括: 用來接受電子郵件的郵件收信手段; 用來記億行程資料的行程記憶手段; 用來變更該行程記億手段之記億内容的變更手段和 自動發信手段,用於當藉由該變更手段加以變更時, 將對應該變更内容之電子郵件自動發信給特定之對象。 (3) 依照本發明電子郵件裝置之第3形態所提供者包 括: 、 用來接受電子郵件的郵件收信手段; 用來記億行程資料的行程記億手段; 辨別手段,用來辨別藉由上述郵件收信手段所收信到 之電子郵件是否為包含有行程資料之行程郵件; 比較手段,當藉由該辨別手段辨別為行程郵件時,用 來將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料和上述行程記億手段 所記億之行程資料加以比較; 記億控制手段,當藉由該比較手段檢測到該兩値行程 資料並不重複時,用來將收信到之行程郵件之行程資料 記憶在上述行程記億手段;和 自動發信手段,當藉由上述比較手段檢測到上述之兩 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) ----------------訂------..VI (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 五、發明説明( r A7 B7 信 發 之 件 郵 程 行 之 到 信 收 對 來 用' , 0 時件 複郵 重形 有定 料送 資發 程動 行 自 個源 乃 者 供 提 所 態 形 4 第 之 置 裝 件 郵 子 電 明 發 本 照 依 若 括 包 段段 手手 信億 收記 件程 郵行 的的 件料 郵資 子程 電行 受億 接記 來來 用用 OU 0 信 收 所 ; 段件 手郵 信程 收行 件之 郵料 述資 上程 由行 藉有 別含 辨包 來為 用否 ,是 段件 手郵 別子 辨電 之 用段 ,手 時憶 件記 郵程 程行 行述 為上 別和 辨料 段資 手程 別行 辨之 該含 由包 藉所 當件 ,郵 段程 手行 較該 比將 來 較 比 較該 比由 以藉 加當 料 , 資段 程手 行制 之控 億億 記記 所 到 信 收 將 來 用 時 複 重 不 並 料 資 程料 行資 値程 兩行 該之 到件 測郵 檢程 段行 手之 否 兩可 述件 上郵 到程 測行 檢之 段到 手信 較收 比別 述辨 上來 由用 藉 , 憶 當 時 記,複 程段重 行手有 述別料 上辨資 在件程 憶條行 記 個 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 段 手 足 滿 可 為 dy 0 辨 段 手 別 辨 件 條 該 由 藉 和當 件段 條手 之新 定更 指憶 足記 滿 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 刪 來 用 時 件 條 定 指 述 上 上段 將手 和億 ,記 料程 資行 程述 行上 之在 複億 重記 所料 段資 手程 億 行 記之 程含 行包 述所 上件 在郵 憶程 記行 被述 除 包 者 供 提 所 態 形 5 第 之 置 裝 件 郵 子 電 明 發 本 照 依 括 段 手- 信 7 收- 件 郵 的 件 郵 受 接 來 用 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) 五、發明説明(b A7 B7 郵 33 之 到 信 收 所 段 ; 手 ., 段信件 手收郵 億件程 記郵行 程述之 行上料 的別資 料辨程 資來行 程用有 行 ,含 億段包 記手為 來別否 用辨是 件 用段 ,手 時億 件記 郵 程 TWI-ΙΑ- 程行 行述 為上 別和 辨料 段資 手程 別行 辨之 該含 由包 藉所 當件 ,郵 段程 手行 較該 比將 來 較 ; 比 較該 比由 以藉 加當 料 , 資段 程手 -1 _ 之控 億億 記記 所 程 行 個 兩 該 -«U 0 測 檢 段 料 資 程 一1 /i 之 件 郵 程 一了 //1 之 到 信 收 ; 將段 來手 用億 ,記 時程 複行 重述 不上 並在 料億 資記 述 上 由 藉 當 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 個 ·,行 兩件之 述郵段 上程手 到行憶 測之記 檢到程 段信行 手收述 較億上 比記在 時憶 暫記 來被 用更 ,變 ,時來 段複用 手重 ., 憶有段 記料手 時資更 暫程變 行 上 在 時 更 變 以 加 段 手 更 變 該 由 藉 當 段 手 和送 ., 轉 料料 資資 程 場資 的程 白行 空的 成複 變重 料之 資段 程手 行億 的記 複時 重暫 之述 億上 記在 所億 段記 手被 ^將 記來 程用 行 , 述合 段 手 億 記 程 行 逑 上 ^nu 至 送 轉 料 者 供 提 所 態 形 1 第 之 體 媒 錄 記 明 發 本 照 依 若 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 驟 步 信 。收 式件 程郵 的子 件電 郵的 子件 電郵 理子 處電 述受 下接 錄來 記用 於 驟 步 信 收 件 *, 郵 驟子 步電 億述 記上 料別 資辨 程來 行用 的 , 料驟 資步 程別 行辨 億件 記郵 來程 用行 件辨 郵驟 程步 行別 之辨 料件 資郵 程程 一了 一了 Λ4· ywl 有述 含上 包由 為藉 否當 是 , 件驟 郵步 子較 電比 之料 到資 信程 收行 所 8 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(7 ) 別為上述電子郵件收信步驟所收信到之電子郵件是行程 郵件時,就使上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料和上述行 程資料記憶步驟所記憶之行程資料加以比較,藉以檢測 該兩痼行程資料間有無重複; 行程資料記億控制步驟,當藉由上述行程資料比較步 驟之比較,檢測到上述兩個行程資料間並無重複時,用 來將上述行程郵件所包含之行程資.料以上述行程資料記 億步驟加以記億; 用來自動地發送電子郵件的電子郵件自動發信步驟; 第一電子郵件自動發信控制步驟,當藉由上述行程資 料比較步驟之比較,檢測到上述兩値行程資料之間有重 複時,就在上逑電子郵件自動發信步驟,將具有避免上 述重複的行程變更之有關資訊之電子郵件,自動地發信 給上述行程郵件之發信人;和 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 變更行程資料記億控制步驟,在藉由上逑電子郵件自 動發信步驟發送具有上述資訊之電子郵件後,因應具有 該資訊之電子郵件,以避免上述重複般變更上述行程郵 件所包含之行程資料,而藉由上逑電子郵件收信步驟收 信到通知該變更之電子郵件時,就將根據上述資訊變更 之上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料,以上述行程資料記 億步驟加以記億。 (7 )依照本發明記錄媒體之第2形態為,將被電腦讀 取之程式加以記錄的一種記錄媒體其特徵為;可記錄實 行下列各電子郵件處理程式的步驟: 用來接受電子郵件的電子郵件收信步驟; 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(《) 用來記億行程資料的行程資料記億步驟; 用於變更行程之記億内容的行程資料變更步驟;和 電子郵件自動發信步驟,當藉由該行程資料變更步驟 變更行程時,用來將對應該變更内容的内容之電子郵件 自動地發信給特定之對象。 (8)依照本發明記錄媒體之第3形態為,用於記錄被 電腦讀取之程式的一種記錄媒體其特徵為;可記錄實 行下列電子郵件處理程式的各步驟: 用來接受電子郵件的電子郵件收信步驟; 行程資料辨別步驟,用來辨別收受到之電子郵件是否 為包含有行程資料之行程郵件; 行程資料比較步驟,當藉由該行程資料辨別步驟辨別 為行程郵件時,用來將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料和 被記億之行程資料加以比較; 行程資料記億控制步驟,當藉由該行程資料比較步驟 檢測到該兩個行程資料並不重複時,用來記億收信到之 行程郵件之行程資料;和 行程資料自動發信步驟,當藉由上述行程資料比較步 驟檢測到上述兩値行程資料有重複時,用來對收信到之 行程郵件之發信源自動地發出定形郵件。 (9 )依照本發明記錄媒體之第4形態即為,用於記錄被 電腦讀取之程式的一種記錄媒體,其特徵為;可記錄實 行下列電子郵件處理程式的各步驟: 用來接受電子郵件的電子郵件收信步驟; -1 0 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明( 9 ) 1 1 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 9 用來辨別所信到之電子郵件是否 1 1 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 1 1 行 程 資 料 tb 較 步 驟 &gt; 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 辨 別 -S 諳 1 1 先 1 為 行 程 郵 件 時 9 用 來 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 閱 讀 1 1 被 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 fcb 較 背 1 I 之 1 I 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 bb 較 步 驟 注 意 1 1 事 1 撿 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 並 不 重 複 時. 5 用 來 記 億 收 信 到 之 項 1 再 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 填 寫 本 郵 件 條 件 辨 別 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 檢 頁 1 1 測 到 上 述 兩 値 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 用 來 辨 別 收 倍 到 之 行 I 1 程 郵 件 可 否 滿 足 指 定 之 條 件 和 1 1 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 該 郵 件 條 件 辨 別 步 驟 1 訂 辨 別 為 可 滿 足 上 述 指 定 條 件 時 用 來 刪 除 被 記 憶 的 重 複 1 之 行 程 資 料 和 用 來 記 億 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 1 1 料 〇 1 I (1 依照本發明記錄媒體之第 5 形 態 即 為 用 於 記 錄 1 广·、 被 電 腦 讀 取 之 程 式 的 一 種 記 錄 媒 體 ί 其 特 徵 為 » 可 記 錄 I 實 行 下 列 電 子 郵 件 處 理 程 式 的 各 步 驟 ; 1 | 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 的 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 用 來 將 行 程 資 料 記 憶 在 行 程 記 憶 手 段 的 行 程 資 料 記 憶 1 步 驟 1 I 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 9 用 來辨別收信到之郵件是否為包 1 1 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 1 I 行 程 資 料 tb 較 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 辨 別 1 1 1 -1 1 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明(V。 ) 1 1 為 行 程 郵 件 時 9 用 來 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 1 1 I 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 所 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 比 較 1 1 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 先 1 1 檢 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 並 不 重 複 時 用 來 將 收 信 到 之 行 閲 1 1 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 記 億 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 面 之 1 行 程 資 料 暫 時 記 憶 控 制 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 上 逑 行 程 資 料 fcb 注 意 1 事 1 較 步 驟 撿 測 到 上 述 兩 個 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 1 用 來 暫 時 記 項 再 1 億 上 逑 收 信 到 之 行 程 郵 件 Ψτ 寫 本 ϊ\ 行 程 資 料 變 更 步 驟 &gt; 用 來 變 更 被 記 億 在 上 逑 行 程 記 億 頁 '—^ 1 | 手 段 之 行 程 資 料 和 1 I 行 程 資 料 轉 送 步 驟 &gt; 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 變 更 步 驟 加 以 I 1 變 更 時 ♦ 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 所 記 億 之 重 複 的 行 程 資 料 1 訂 變 成 空 白 之 場 合 9 用 來 將 上 述 被 暫 時 記 憶 的 重 複 之 行 程 1 1 資 料 轉 送 到 上 述 行 程 記 憶 手 段 Ο 1 1 C 附 画 之 簡 C3D 早 説 明 ] 1 1 下 面 經 由 參 昭 附 圖 對 本 發 明 之 較 佳 實 施 形 態 的 說 明 9 1 1 諒 必 可 對 本 發 明 其 他 巨 的 和 特 徽 更 容 易 瞭 解 〇 Ψ 在 附 圖 中 1 I 第 1 圖 表 示 本 發 明 各 實 施 形 態 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 之 % 統 \ I 構 造 〇 1 |ν, 第 2 圔 表 示 第 1 實 施 形 態 之 RAM之記億内容。 1 I 第 3 圖 表 示 第 2(a)圖所示之收信郵件區域之細節 〇 1 1 第 4 圖 表 示 第 2 ( a )圖所示 之 位 址 列 表 區 域 之 細 節 〇 1 1 第 5 圖 表 示 第 2 ( a)_所示之行程區域之細節 〇 1 I -1 2 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) 五、發明説明( A7 B7 第6圖表示第5(c)画所示每一日行程資料之細節 圖 程 流 主 之 U P C 之 態 形 施 實 11- 第 是 圔 7 第 。圔 圖程 程流 流之 之理 理處 處示 示顯 顯信 信收 收後 之圔 圔 8 C-.第 第繼 是是 画圖 ο 1 CC 9 1 1 第第第第 0示 圔顯 程面 流畫 之之 il 311 理理 處處 示示 顯顯 信 信 收收 後圖 _10 05 第 第示 繼表 是為 圔圖 之 1TM1 理 處 示 顯 表 ϋ 歹 址 位之 trri 1 理 處 示 顯 信 收 圔 9 第 是 圔 。 12圖 第程 流 顯 。面 圔圔 程之 流理 之處 理示 處顯 示表 顯列 表址 列位 址之 位圖 : 2 後1 圖第 2 1 藉 第示 繼表 是是 圖圖 3 4 1X 11 第第 ---------' II (讀先聞讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 示 流 之 ym.1 理 處 示 顯 程 行 中 理 處 示 顯 信 收 之 圏 9 第 是 圖 5 1 0 第圖 程 第第第第第画 程 圔圔圔 程程程 流流流 之之之 rtRt mc3 二 理理理 處處 示 示 顯顯 程程 一了 一了 一了 yvT if κι 後後後 圔圔圔 5 6 7 li 1x 1X 第第第 0 0 0 ηΜΜ 是是是 _ 圖 _ 處 示 顯 程 0 流 示之 顯理 面處 畫成 之製 Bt .r1 理件 處郵 示中 顯理 程處 行示 之顯 圔信 5 ? 1 收 第之 藉圖 示 9 表第 是是 圔圖 訂 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 圖示 程顯 流面 之畫 理之 處理 成處 製成 件製 郵件 後郵 _ _ ο 2 3 第第 繼繼 是是 _ _ 1 2 2 2 第第 ml*- 理 處 〇 成 圖 製 程 件 流 郵 之 程 理 行 處 中 成 理 Z 製 處 件 示 郵 顯 程 信 行 收 後 之 _ __ 3 圖 2 9 第 第 繼 是 。是 圖圖圖 3 4 2 程 2 第流第 之 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(p ) 第25圔是表示第23圖的行程郵件製成處理之畫面顯示。 第2 6圖是第20圔之郵件製成處理中位址指定處理之流 程圖。 第27圔表示藉第26圖位址指定處理之畫面顯示。 第28圖是第10画收信顯示處理中開封處理之流程画。 第29_表示藉第28圖通常郵件場合之開封處理之畫面 顯示。 第3G圖表示藉第28圖行程郵件場合之開封處理之畫面顯示。 第3 1圖是第1 3圖位址列表顯示處理中位址追加處理之 流程画。 第32圖表示藉笫3 1.圔位址追加處理之畫面顯示。 第3 3_是藉第13圔位址列表顯示處理中位址詳細顯示 處理之流程圖。 第34圔表示藉第3 3_位址詳細顯示處理之畫面顯示。 第35圖是第17圖之行程顯示處理中行程登錄處理之流 程圖。 第36圖表示藉第35圖行程登錄處理之畫面顯示。 第37圖是第35画之警告畫面顯示處理之流程圔。 第38圖表示藉第37圖之警告畫面顯示處理之畫面顯示。 第33画是第17圖行程顯示處理中行程詳細顯示處理之 流程圔。 第40圖是繼第39圖後行程詳細顯示處理之流程画。 第41_表示藉第39圖行程詳細顯示處理之畫面顯示。 -1 4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) (讀先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(β ) 第42圖是第18圖之下個月顯示處理之流程圖。 第43圖是第18圖之上個月顯示處理之流程圖。 第44圖是第1實施形態中收信處理之流程圖。 •第4 5圔是繼第4 4圖後收信處理之流程圔。 第4 6画是繼第45圖後收信處理之流程圖。 第47_是繼第44圖後收信處理之流程画。 第4 8圖表示第1實施形態中定形郵件A之内容。 第49圖表示第1實施形態中定形郵件B之内容。 第50圖表示第1賁施形態中定形郵件C之内容。 第51圖表示第1實施形態中定形郵件D之内容。 第52圖表示第7圖中待命郵件消除處理之流程圔。 第53圖表示使其記錄電子郵件程式而以電腦可讀取之 記錄媒體之實例。 第54圖是第2實施形態中行程登錄處理之流程圔。 第55圖是繼第54圖後行程登錄處理之流程圖。 第5 6圖是繼第5 4圖後行程登錄處理之流程圔。 第57圖表示藉第54圖行程登錄處理之畫面顯示。 第58画是第2實施形態中定形郵件A之内容。 第5 9圔是第2實施形態中行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。 第60画是繼第59圖後行程詳細顯示處理之流程圖。 第G 1圖是繼第6 0圖後行程詳細顯示處理之流程圖。 第62圔是繼第61圖後行程詳細顯示處理之流程圖。 第63_表示第2實施形態中行程詳細顯示畫面(1)。 第64圖表示第2實施形態中行程詳細顯示畫面(2)。 -1 5- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (") [Background of the Invention] 1. Field of Invention The present invention relates to an electronic mail device for sending and receiving emails, and related records for sending and receiving emails The recording medium of the required e-mail handler. 2. Explanation of related technologies E-mail is a powerful tool to improve productivity, and it has been introduced to most companies, and it is rapidly spreading. For example, when a meeting is to be held, the meeting organizer must notify the person who requested the meeting of the meeting reservations. E-mail has been widely used as a means of such notification. At this time, the operation may follow the following process. First, the host sends an email with the date and venue of the meeting to those who are asked to attend the meeting. The recipient of the e-mail should notify the organizer of the e-mail indicating whether or not to attend the meeting. If he wants to attend the meeting, he will make his own schedule management and carry out the registration operation. On the itinerary. However, the schedule for implementing such management was previously written in a notebook with a writing tool, etc. However, recently, itinerary software has been used to register, delete, and change itineraries on the personal computer's itinerary schedule. In addition, mobile information terminals such as mobile computers, which are called mobile computers in the market, which have both travel functions and e-mail functions, have been sold in large quantities. Even if it is a machine with both travel function and e-mail function, which is a known technology, because the functions of both parties are not linked, for example, the above paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) ) --------- <wei— (Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page) Order the A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs V. Description of Invention (&gt;) Even if the e-mails such as notifications are received, even if the e-mails that indicate the new scheduled registration of the itinerary need to be received, the users of the machine must confirm the e-mail content, confirm the itinerary content, and notify the electronic attendees. Replying to the mail and entering a new reservation into one of the schedules are coherent operations, which makes it very cumbersome to combine email processing and schedule management. One method that can be considered is to simply register the item reservation in the itinerary by linking the itinerary function with the e-mail function when a scheduled e-mail containing an event is received. However, in this way, because the itinerary that has been registered on the itinerary is not taken into account, the problem of repeatedly registering a new project reservation may occur at the time when the project is scheduled. The object of the present invention is to automatically adjust the schedule when the items recorded in the received e-mail are repeated with the registered schedule. In addition, when it is necessary to link the processing of e-mail with the schedule management, the processing can be simplified to reduce the burden on users. [Summary of the Invention] An object of the present invention is to provide an electronic mail device that can automatically adjust a schedule when an item recorded in a received email is scheduled to repeat a registered schedule. In addition, an e-mail device is provided to simplify the process when the e-mail processing and schedule management are to be linked to reduce the burden on the user. In addition, the present invention can provide a recording medium for recording such email processing programs. (1) That is, if according to the first form of the electronic mail device of the present invention -4-this paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) (please read the precautions for f. Fill out this J) -s A7 B7 V. Invention Description (Today) The providers include: E-mail receiving means for receiving e-mail; Itinerary data recording means for recording 100 million itinerary data; Means for identifying travel itinerary, It is used to identify whether the email received by the above email receiving means is an itinerary mail containing itinerary information; the itinerary data comparison means shall be identified as the above email receiving means by the above itinerary mail identification means. When the received e-mail is an itinerary email, it is used to compare the itinerary data contained in the above itinerary email with the itinerary data recorded in the above hundred million means of the itinerary data recording, so as to detect whether there is a duplication between the two itinerary data; The trip data recording control method is used when the comparison of the above trip data comparison means detects that there is no overlap between the above two trip data. Record the itinerary information contained in the above itinerary emails in the above itinerary information; print it by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (read the precautions on the reverse side and fill out this page) for automatic email sending Automatic e-mail sending means; The first automatic e-mail sending control means is used to automatically send the above e-mail when a duplication between the above two itinerary data is detected through the comparison of the above-mentioned itinerary data comparison means. Letter means, automatically send e-mails with relevant information to avoid repeating itinerary changes to the sender of the above itinerary; and change the itinerary data memory control means, send After e-mail of the information, the above-mentioned repeated notifications can be avoided due to the e-mail with the information. The above paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) 8-4 specification (210X 297 mm). The Consumers Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Print A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (4) Itinerary information included in the itinerary email It is expected that when the above-mentioned e-mail receiving means receives the e-mail of the change notification, the itinerary information contained in the above itinerary email changed according to the listing information will be recorded in the above itinerary data. (2) According to the second aspect of the electronic mail device of the present invention, the provider includes: mail receiving means for receiving e-mails; travel memory means for recording billion travel data; and means for changing the travel recording means. The change method and automatic transmission method of the content recorded in billions are used to automatically send an e-mail corresponding to the changed content to a specific target when the change is made by the change method. (3) The providers according to the third aspect of the electronic mail device of the present invention include:, means for receiving mails for receiving e-mails; means for recording 100 million trips to record travel data; and means for distinguishing, Whether the e-mail received by the above mail receiving means is an itinerary mail containing itinerary information; a comparison means, when it is determined as an itinerary mail by the discriminating means, it is used for the itinerary data included in the itinerary mail and the above The travel data recorded by the travel recorder of 100 million are compared; the record travel control method is used to memorize the travel data of the travel e-mails received when it is detected that the two travel records do not overlap by the comparison method. The above means of counting hundreds of millions of trips; and the method of automatic letter sending, when the above two paper sizes are detected by the above-mentioned comparison means, the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) is applied ---------- ------ Order ------ .. VI (Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page) V. Description of the invention , 0 hours The reply mail has a fixed material delivery date and is sent from the source or the person's confession. The fourth piece of installation mail, telegraphic mail, this photo is in accordance with the enclosing section, and the hand-to-hand letter is received. The postage information of the postage sub-program is accepted by the bank to use the OU 0 letter receipt; the postage information of the postal receipt of the piece of hand postal receipt shall be borrowed by the bank to determine whether it is included or not. , It is the paragraph used by the handpiece to identify the telegraph. The handpiece is recorded as the postal process, which is identified by the bank and the material section. The postal process is included in the package, and the postal section is compared. The ratio is compared in the future. The ratio is based on borrowing and adding materials, and the hand-held system of controlling the billions of records to the letter receipt. In the future, the time will be doubled. Whether the test post inspection process section is handed or not can be described. The post was mailed to the test test section to the hand letter for comparison. The reason for borrowing is to distinguish it from the borrowing. Recalling the time record, the re-trip section repeats the process. Write a note on the piece of process memory (please read first Please fill in this page before filling in this page) Duan Tshou full can be dy 0 Identifying the segment hand and identifying the strips The new definition of the loan and the current paragraph refers to the full memory of the Central Consumers Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs, the Consumers Cooperatives The system uses the time rule to refer to the previous paragraph to hand and billion, to record the process of the information in the process of re-remembering the material in the process of re-remembering the section of the process, the process of the process, including the description of the last article in the post recall process Describes the package holder's confession, the fifth form of the installation post, the telegraphic mail, and the copy of this photo, which is based on the paragraph hand-letter 7 to receive-the postal mail received to use this paper size to apply China National Standards (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297mm) V. Description of the invention (b A7 B7 Post 33 to the letter receiving section; There is a line for the itinerary. It contains 100 million paragraphs. It is worth noting whether to use it to identify whether it is a piece or not. When it ’s hundreds of thousands, it ’s a post. TWI-ΙΑ- The description of the line is to distinguish between the above and the identification section. By Borrow House Pieces, the post section is better than the future; the comparison is based on borrowing and adding material, and the section of the process section -1 is controlled by billions of records, and the two lines are-«U 0 test section A piece of postage of 1 / i, a post of postage of 1 // 1, the letter was received; the paragraphs will be handed over 100 million yuan, the timetable will not be repeated in the restatement, and the account of 100 million yuan will be borrowed (please read the first Note: Please fill in this page again.) ····················································································· Coming back with a heavy hand, remember that there is a paragraph recorder, the time is more temporary, the time is changed, the time is changed, and the period is changed. The loan should be borrowed, and the process is changed. Cheng Baixing An empty Chengfu variable heavy material section Cheng Shou Xing Yi ’s repetition is recounted temporarily. The note is recorded on the Shou Yi Shou Shou Ji ^ will be recorded in the process, and the combination Shou Shou Yi Shou is recorded ^ nu to the transfer. The writer's confession is in Form 1 and the body media record clearly publishes this photo. If the Ministry of Economic Affairs Bureau of Standards employees consumer cooperatives printed letter sudden step. Receiving the mail of the sub-mail of the sub-mail of the sub-email, the sub-message, and the telegram of the sub-receipt will be used for the receipt of the step letter *, the post of the sub-step e-mail will be recorded on the basis of the material identification process. Steps to identify hundreds of millions of items in the mail. Incoming flights. Use steps to identify the post. Steps to identify the materials in the mail. Postings have been removed. Λ4 · ywl It is stated that the reason is to borrow or not. The electricity is expected to arrive at the credit information bank. 8 This paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (7) Do not receive the letter you received in the above email receiving steps When the e-mail is an itinerary email, the itinerary data contained in the above itinerary email is compared with the itinerary data stored in the above itinerary data storage step, so as to detect whether there is a duplication between the two itinerary data; the itinerary data is recorded in 100 million control steps. Based on the comparison of the above-mentioned itinerary data comparison steps, when it is detected that there is no overlap between the two itinerary data, it is used to collect the itinerary information included in the above itinerary email. Steps to record hundreds of millions of trip data. Steps to automatically send e-mails to automatically send e-mails. Steps to control the automatic transmission of first e-mails. When the above two steps are compared through the comparison of the itinerary data, the above two steps are detected. When there is overlap between the itinerary data, the automatic email sending step will be launched on the e-mail, and the e-mail with relevant information to avoid the above itinerary change will be automatically sent to the sender of the above itinerary; and the Ministry of Economic Affairs Central Printed by the Consumer Bureau of the Standards Bureau (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) Change the itinerary and record the control steps. After sending the email with the above information through the automatic email sending step on the list, you should have The e-mail of this information will avoid the above-mentioned repeated changes to the itinerary data contained in the itinerary email, and when the e-mail notifying the change is received through the above email receiving step, the above-mentioned information will be changed according to the above information. The itinerary information contained in the itinerary email is recorded in the steps of the above itinerary.(7) According to the second aspect of the recording medium of the present invention, a recording medium that records a program read by a computer is characterized in that it can record the steps of implementing each of the following e-mail processing programs: Electronic for receiving e-mail Steps for receiving mail; This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of the invention Steps to record billions; Steps to change the itinerary data of the itinerary; and an automatic e-mail transmission step to send an email corresponding to the contents of the changes when the itinerary is changed by the itinerary change step. Automatically send letters to specific people. (8) According to the third aspect of the recording medium of the present invention, a recording medium for recording a program read by a computer is characterized in that it can record each step of implementing the following e-mail processing program: Electronic for receiving e-mail Mail receiving step; Itinerary data identification step, used to identify whether the received e-mail is an itinerary mail containing itinerary data; Itinerary data comparison step, when it is identified as itinerary mail by the itinerary data identification step, The itinerary data contained in the itinerary email is compared with the itinerary data recorded in 100 million; The itinerary data recording control step is used to record 100 million receipts when it is detected that the two itinerary data are not duplicated by the itinerary data comparison step. The itinerary information of the itinerary emails; and the automatic data sending step of the itinerary data. When the above two itinerary data are detected to be duplicated by the above itinerary data comparison step, it is used to automatically send the source of the itinerary emails received Send a fixed mail. (9) The fourth form of the recording medium according to the present invention is a recording medium for recording a program read by a computer, which is characterized in that it can record each step of implementing the following e-mail processing program: for receiving e-mail Steps for receiving emails; -1 0-This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) Order A7 B7 Staff of the Central Bureau of Standards, Ministry of Economic Affairs Printed by the consumer cooperative. 5. Description of the invention (9) 1 1 Itinerary data identification step 9 is used to identify whether the email you believe is 1 1 is an itinerary mail containing itinerary data 1 1 Itinerary data tb More steps &gt; When using this Steps to identify the travel data -S 谙 1 1 When the first 1 is the travel e-mail 9 It is used to read the travel data included in the travel e-mail and read 1 1 The travel data recorded in billions is fcb Back 1 I 1 I Data recording control step 9 When using the travel data bb to pay attention to the steps 1 1 event 1 when the two travel data are detected and not duplicated. 5 used to record the received items 1 billion travel data Fill in the conditions of this mail. Step 9: When the above itinerary data fcb is used to check the page 1 1 when the above two itinerary data are detected to be duplicated, it is used to identify the doubled trip I 1 whether the mail can meet the specified conditions and 1 1 Step 9 for controlling the record of the travel data. When using the mail condition identification step 1 to determine that the specified conditions can be satisfied, the itinerary data used to delete the duplicated 1 and the travel data 1 used to record the travel information included in the above travel mail 1 1 料 〇1 I (1 The fifth form of the recording medium according to the present invention is used for recording 1 A recording medium of a program read by a computer. Its characteristics are: »Recordable I Perform the following steps of an e-mail processing program; 1 | E-mail receiving steps for receiving e-mails are used to store itinerary data in itinerary memory Means of itinerary data storage 1 Step 1 I Itinerary data identification step 9 It is used to identify whether the received mail is a package 1 1 Itinerary mail containing itinerary data 1 I Itinerary data tb Compared with step 9 When it is identified by the itinerary data identification step 1 1 1 -1 1-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs V. Invention Description (V. ) 1 1 is the itinerary mail 9 It is used to compare the itinerary data contained in the itinerary mail with 1 1 I the itinerary data recorded in the above 100 million stroke counting method 1 1 Itinerary data recorded in the control step 9 When using the itinerary Steps for data comparison: 1 1 When it is detected that the two itinerary data are not duplicated, it is used to record the itinerary information of the 1 1 trip mail received in the mail. 9 When uploading the itinerary data fcb, note 1 thing 1 when the above two itinerary data are detected to be duplicated. 1 It is used to temporarily record another 100 million yuan. The email of the itinerary received. Τ transcript. \ Itinerary data change Steps &gt; It is used to change the itinerary of 100 million pages recorded in Shanghai. — ^ 1 | Means of travel information and 1 I Itinerary data transfer step &gt; When I 1 is changed by this itinerary data changing step ♦ When the itinerary of the itinerary recorded in the above-mentioned itinerary is recorded in 100 million yuan 1 When the order becomes blank 9 is used to temporarily store the above Repeated itinerary 1 1 Data is transferred to the above itinerary memory means 0 1 1 C Brief description with pictures C3D Early description] 1 1 Below is a description of the preferred embodiment of the present invention through the reference drawings 9 1 1 The present invention must be understood Other giant and special emblems are easier to understand. 〇 In the drawings, 1 I, the first figure shows the% system of the electronic mail device of each embodiment of the present invention. I structure, 〇1 | ν, and the second 圔 represents the first embodiment. Memory of billions of RAM. 1 I Figure 3 shows the details of the incoming mail area shown in Figure 2 (a). 0 1 1 Figure 4 shows the details of the address list area shown in Figure 2 (a). 0 1 1 Figure 5 shows Details of the itinerary area shown in Section 2 (a) _ 〇 1 I -1 2-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X 297 mm) 5. Description of the invention (A7 B7 Chapter Figure 6 shows the details of the itinerary data for each day shown in Figure 5 (c). The implementation of the UPC configuration of the flow master 11- No. 7 No. 7 8 C-. The first is to draw the picture. 1 CC 9 1 1 The 0th display of the 0th display of the flow chart. Il 311 shows the display of the letter after receiving the letter. _10 05 The first succession table is shown in the figure 1TM1. The display of the trri 1 address is shown in the figure. 9 The first is. The 12th step is shown in the flow. The flow is shown in the flow. The processing display shows the address of the display list address. Figure: 2 Next 1 Figure No. 2 1 The following table is borrowed. Figure 3 4 1X 11 No. -------- '' (Read the notes on the back and then fill out this page) Ym.1 of the flow shows the display of the process of the display of the display of the message 9 of the display is shown in Figure 5 1 0 The map of the flow of the flow of the flow of the flow of the flow rtRt mc3 of the flow of flow The display process of the display process is one by one. YvT if κι After the back 圔 圔 圔 5 6 7 li 1x 1X The 0th 0 0 0 ηΜΜ Yes Yes _ Figure_ The display process at the display process 0 Printed system Bt.r1 Printed in the mail at the management office. The letter shown in the management process is displayed. 5? 1 The borrowed chart 9 is shown in the table. It is printed by the staff consumer cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. Illustrate the processing principle of Cheng Xianliu's painting process and post it into a piece of mail and post it _ ο ο 2 3 The first successor is _ _ 1 2 2 2nd ml *-Administrative process Cheng Lixing Office Cheng Chengli Z system shows the post received by Cheng Xinxing _ __ 3 Figure 2 9 The first is. Figures Figure 3 4 2 Process 2 The best paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (p) 25 圔 is a screen display showing the schedule mail creation process of FIG. 23. Fig. 26 is a flowchart of the address designation processing in the 20th mail creation process. Figure 27 shows the screen display of the address designation processing shown in Figure 26. FIG. 28 is a flowchart of the unsealing process in the tenth picture receiving display process. Fig. 29_ shows the screen display of the unpacking process in the case of ordinary mail as shown in Fig. 28. Fig. 3G shows the screen display of the unsealing process in the case of the postal mail shown in Fig. 28. Fig. 31 is a flowchart of the address addition processing in the address list display processing of Fig. 13; Fig. 32 shows the screen display of borrowing address adding process. The 3rd 3_ is the flowchart of the detailed address processing in the 13th address list display processing. The 34th display indicates the screen display of the detailed display processing by the 3 3_ address. Fig. 35 is a flowchart of the itinerary registration process in the itinerary display process of Fig. 17. FIG. 36 shows a screen display of the itinerary registration process by using FIG. 35. Fig. 37 is a flowchart of the warning screen display process of the 35th picture. Fig. 38 shows a screen display by the warning screen display processing of Fig. 37. Fig. 33 is a flow chart of the detailed stroke display processing in the stroke display processing of Fig. 17. Fig. 40 is a flow chart showing the detailed process of the stroke following Fig. 39. Figure 41_ shows the screen display of the detailed display processing of the itinerary according to Figure 39. -1 4-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 × 297 mm) (read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) Order printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Invention Explanation (β) FIG. 42 is a flowchart of the display processing of the next month in FIG. 18. Fig. 43 is a flowchart of the month display process shown in Fig. 18. Fig. 44 is a flowchart of a reception process in the first embodiment. • The 4th 5th line is the process of receiving mail after the 4th 4th line. Picture 46 is a flowchart of the receiving process following figure 45. Figure 47_ is the flow chart of the receiving process following Figure 44. Fig. 48 shows the contents of the fixed mail A in the first embodiment. Fig. 49 shows the contents of the fixed mail B in the first embodiment. Fig. 50 shows the contents of the fixed mail C in the first application form. Fig. 51 shows the contents of the fixed mail D in the first embodiment. FIG. 52 shows the flow of the standby mail elimination processing in FIG. 7. Fig. 53 shows an example of a computer-readable recording medium for recording an e-mail program. Fig. 54 is a flowchart 圔 of itinerary registration processing in the second embodiment. Fig. 55 is a flowchart of the stroke registration process following Fig. 54. Fig. 56 is a flowchart of the stroke registration process following Fig. 54. Fig. 57 shows a screen display of the itinerary registration processing by borrowing from Fig. 54. Picture 58 shows the contents of the fixed mail A in the second embodiment. The 5th and 9th flowchart is a flow chart of the detailed stroke display processing in the second embodiment. Picture 60 is a flowchart of the detailed display process of the stroke following figure 59. Fig. G1 is a flowchart showing the detailed stroke process following Fig. 60. Fig. 62 is a flowchart showing the detailed stroke display process following Fig. 61. Number 63_ shows a detailed trip display screen (1) in the second embodiment. Fig. 64 shows a detailed stroke display screen (2) in the second embodiment. -1 5- This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page)

經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(4 ) 第65圖表示第2實施形態中定形郵件B之内容。 第(56_表示第2實施形態中收信處理之流程圖。 第67圖表示第3實施形態中行程登錄處理之流程圖。 第68圔是第3實施形態中收信處理之流程圖。 第69_表示第4實施形態中RAM之記億内容。 第7 Q I«是第4實施形態中收信處理之流程圖。 第7 1圖是繼第7 〇圖後收信處理之.流程 第72_表示第5實施形態中RAM之記億内容。 第73圖表示第5實施形態中CPU之主流程圖。 第74_表示第5實施形態中行程詳細顯示處理之流程 圖。 第75圖是繼第74圖之行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。 第76圖是繼第75圔之行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。 第77圖是繼第75圔之行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。 第78圖是繼第77圖之行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。 第?9圖是第78_行程詳細顯示處理之刪除處理之流程 _ 〇 第80圖是第78圖行程詳細顯示處理之訂正處理之流程圔。 第8 1圖表示第5實施形態中行程詳細顯示畫面(1 )。 第8 2圖表示第5實施形態中行程詳細顯示畫面(2 )。 第83圖表示第5實施形態中定形郵件A之内容。 第84圖表示第5實施形態中定形郵件B之内容。 第85圖表示第5實施形態中收信處理之流程圖。 第86圖表示第5實施形態中暫時登錄刪除處理之流程 -16- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (4) Figure 65 shows the contents of the fixed mail B in the second embodiment. (56_ shows a flowchart of the reception process in the second embodiment. FIG. 67 shows a flowchart of the itinerary registration process in the third embodiment. 68th is a flowchart of the reception process in the third embodiment. 69_ indicates the contents of the RAM in the fourth embodiment. The seventh QI «is a flowchart of the receiving process in the fourth embodiment. Figure 71 is a flowchart of the receiving process following the figure 70. Flow 72 _ Shows the memory contents of RAM in the fifth embodiment. FIG. 73 shows the main flowchart of the CPU in the fifth embodiment. 74_ shows the flowchart of the detailed display process of the stroke in the fifth embodiment. Figure 74 shows the detailed process flow of the process 圔. Figure 76 shows the detailed process flow of the process following the 75th process. Figure 77 shows the flow process of the detailed display process after the 75th process. Figure 78 is The flow of the detailed display processing following the figure 77 is shown in Figure 圔. Figure 9 is the flow of the deletion processing of the detailed display of the stroke 78_ Figure 80 Figure 80 is the flow of the correction processing of the detailed display of the stroke 78. Figure 81 shows the detailed trip display screen in the fifth embodiment. 1) Figure 8-2 shows the detailed itinerary display screen (2) in the fifth embodiment. Figure 83 shows the contents of the fixed mail A in the fifth embodiment. Figure 84 shows the contents of the fixed mail B in the fifth embodiment. Figure 85 shows the flow chart of the receiving process in the fifth embodiment. Figure 86 shows the flow of the temporary registration deletion process in the fifth embodiment. -16- This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297). Li) (Read the notes on the back before filling in this page)

A7 B7 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印裝 五、發明説明 ( tr ) 1 圖 〇 1 1 [ 具 體 例 之 詳 細 説 明 ] 1 1 下 而 將 根 據 圖 面 用 來 說 明 本 發 明 之 實 施 形 態 〇 ,—· 請 ! Γ 先 1 本 實 施 形 態 偽 以 舉 辦 曰 議 為 例 加 以 説 明 〇 本 發 明 之 電 閱 1 子 郵 件 裝 置 當 接 受 到 議 行 程 登 錄 用 之 電 子 郵 件 時 9 首 背 1 I 之 1 I 先 5 確 認 在 行 程 表 上 已 登 錄 過 之 行 程 〇 其 中 對 於 主 辦 注 意 1 I 事 1 議 之 時 間 帶 假 如 在 行 程 有 空 白 時 ,. 就 將 該 議 之 開 預 項 苒 1 定 登 錄 在 行 程 表 〇 假 如 舉 辦 開 之 時 間 帶 與 登 錄 過 之 行 填 寫 本 jv 程 重 複 時 9 就 通 知 與 該 議 同 一 曰 之 行 程 上 有 空 白 之 其 Sw^ I 他 時 間 帶 的 同 時 &gt; 將 詢 問 是 否 可 將 舉 辦 曰 議 變 更 到 該 空 1 [ 1 白 的 時 間 帶 之 電 子 郵 件 發 信 給 議 行 程 登 錄 用 之 電 子 郵 1 1 件 之 發 信 源 〇 妖 後 &gt; 對 於 該 被 發 信 之 電 子 郵 件 5 假 如 收 1 訂 到 回 信 電 子 郵 件 表 示 接 受 將 舉 辦 曰 時 間 帶 變 更 為 該 空 1 白 的 時 間 帶 時 9 就 將 該 變 更 後 之 舉 辦 曰 議 時 間 帶 登 錄 在 1 1 行 程 表 〇 此 為 本 發 明 之 一 大 特 徵 9 藉 此 特 徵 9 電 子 郵 件 1 I 裝 置 之 使 用 者 就 不 需 任 何 麻 煩 可 製 成 調 整 過 之 行 程 0 1 1 第 1 圖 表 示 本 發 明 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 之 硬 體 構 造 Ο 在 該 圔 έ Υ 中 , 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 2 1 A、 2 1 B 2 1 C, • • · .具有同樣之内 1 I 部 構 造 &gt; 為 連 接 到 LAN (L 0 C a 1 A r e a N e t W 0 Γ k) 5 的 顧 客 1 (C ]1 e η t)電 腦 0 電 子 郵 件 服 務 部 1 1 A是被設置在LAN 5上 1 1 * 以 施 行 電 子 郵 件 服 務 〇 該 電 子 郵 件 服 務 部 11 A被連接 1 I 到 WAN ( Wi d e A r e a N e t W 0 Γ k) 1 5 〇 在 WAN 1 5 更 連 接 有 其 他 1 1 多 數 電 子 郵 件 服 務 部 11 B, 1 1 C 9 1 1 D . * * • 〇 1 1 下 面 將 説 明 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 2 1 A 〇 在電子郵件裝置2 1A具 1 I -1 7 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7五、發明説明() 備有輸入部2 2、輸出部2 3、主控制部2 4、記億部2 5、通 信控制部2 6之各功能塊。 輸入部22用來取得來自電子郵件裝置21A的操作者之 輸入〇乃由猾鼠3 1或鍵盤3 2等所謂輸入手段,和控制這 些之輸入控制部3 3所構成。亦可使用追蹤球等指示手段 來代替滑鼠3 1 , g外,亦得以觸摸板等來代替鍵盤3 2。 輸出部2 3用來向電子郵件裝置2 U之使用者提示其輸 出,其構成包含有:CRT(影像管)或液晶顯示器等顯示 手段4 2 ,用來進行畫而顯示;和輸出控制部4 1,用來控 制顯示手段4 2。 主控制部24用來綜合控制電子郵件裝置21A全體,以 C Ρ ϋ (中央處理裝置)5 ].構成。 記億部2 5用來記億以C P U 5 1實行之處理程式和處理所 需要之資料等,和用來記億電子郵件和電子郵件位址等 。記憶部25之構成包含有:RAM61 ,用來收納構成信箱 之電子郵件,和施行資料之暫時記億等;和R0M62,用 來記億程式。另外,視其所處理之程式,R A Μ 6 1亦被使 用作為C P U 5 1實行處理之作業區域。 介 之 5 0 AN信 L通 ο 、ί ί f A 行 21進 置段 裝手 件他 郵其 子之 15 A 行.L 進在 來接 用連 26與 部以 制可 控’ 信合 通接 而 第 a 明 2 説第 將如 而 C 下容 内 圖 示 所 _ 億收 記為 之分 61大 Μ I Α 可 R 域 R f t區 納 i 纟憶 收 5 按 会口 被之 示J 6 表 Μ _RA 該 , 域 , 區域 成區 製命 件待 郵件 、郵 域和 區域 程區 行成 、製 域程 區行 表 , 列域 址區 位存 、儲 域件 區郵 件形 郵定 信 、 (請先聞讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (tr) 1 Figure 〇 1 1 [Detailed description of specific examples] 1 1 The following will be used to explain the implementation of the present invention based on the drawing. — · Please! Γ First 1 This embodiment will be described by taking a conference as an example. The electronic reading device 1 of the present invention will receive an e-mail for registration of a conference schedule. 9 Head 1 1 1 1 5 Confirm the itinerary that has been registered on the itinerary. Among them, please note that the time for the organizer will be 1 I. If there is a gap in the itinerary, then the meeting plan will be registered in the itinerary. When the time zone is the same as the registered trip, the jv process is repeated. 9 It is notified that there is a blank on the itinerary of the same day as the meeting. Sw ^ I At the same time as the time zone &gt; I will ask if it is possible to change the schedule to the empty 1 [1 white time zone email to the email source for the schedule registration email 11 1 source. Houhou> For the sent e-mail 5 If you receive 1 and receive a reply e-mail indicating acceptance of changing the time zone to the empty 1 time zone 9 you will register the changed time zone In the 1 1 schedule table, this is a major feature of the present invention. 9 By this feature, 9 email 1 I users of the device can make an adjusted schedule without any trouble. 0 1 1 Figure 1 shows the email of the present invention Device hardware structure 0 In this example, the e-mail devices 2 1 A, 2 1 B 2 1 C, • • ·. Have the same structure as the 1 I part &gt; for connection to the LAN (L 0 C a 1 A rea N et W 0 Γ k) of 5 Customer 1 (C) 1 e η t Computer 0 E-mail service department 1 1 A is set on LAN 5 1 1 * To perform e-mail service 〇 The e-mail service department 11 A is connected 1 I to WAN (Wi de Area N et W 0 Γ k) 1 5 〇 There are other 1 connected to WAN 1 5 Most e-mail service department 11 B, 1 1 C 9 1 1 D. * * • 〇 1 1 The e-mail will be explained below Device 2 1 A 〇E-mail device 2 1A with 1 I -1 7-1 1 1 1 This paper size is applicable to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297mm) Printed by A7, Consumer Cooperative of Central Standards Bureau, Ministry of Economic Affairs B7 V. Description of the invention () There are input function blocks 2 2, output section 2 3, main control section 2 4, recorder section 25, and communication control section 26. The input unit 22 is used to obtain input from the operator of the e-mail device 21A. The input unit 22 is composed of a so-called input means such as a mouse 31 or a keyboard 32, and an input control unit 33 that controls these. It is also possible to use pointing means such as a trackball instead of the mouse 3 1, g, or a touch pad instead of the keyboard 3 2. The output section 23 is used to prompt the output of the user of the e-mail device 2 U, and its structure includes: a display means 4 2 such as a CRT (Image Tube) or a liquid crystal display, which is used for drawing and displaying; and an output control section 4 1 Used to control the display means 4 2. The main control unit 24 is used to comprehensively control the entire electronic mail device 21A, and is composed of CP (central processing unit) 5]. Billion Department 25 is used to record the processing procedures and data required for processing implemented by C P U 51, and is used to record 100 million emails and e-mail addresses. The structure of the memory section 25 includes: RAM61, which is used to store e-mails constituting the mailbox, and temporary records of the execution data, etc .; and ROM62, which is used to record the billion programs. In addition, depending on the program it processes, RAM 6 1 is also used as the work area where C P U 5 1 performs processing.介 之 5 0 AN Letter L 通 ο, ί ί f A Line 21 into the section to install the hand piece he post his son 15 A line. L into the connection with the 26 and the Ministry to control the control of the letter And the first a, the second, and the second, the first will be described as follows. The following is shown in the figure below. The billions are recorded as 61 million, M, I, A, R, R, R, and ft. Μ _RA This, the domain, the regional system to prepare the mail, the mail domain and the regional process area, the regional process schedule, the domain address location storage, the storage domain mail area mail letter, (please listen first (Read the notes on the back and fill out this page)

本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7_ 五、發明説明() 各資料乃被收納在所對應之區域。其中,在定形郵件儲 存區域,如第2(b)圖所示,收納有預先從R0M62讀出之 4個定形郵件A〜D。後而將說明定形郵件之細節。 第3圖表示第2(a)画所示之收信郵件區域之細節。第 3 ( a )圖表示收信郵件區域是用以收納收信到的電子郵件 之區域,為具有收信郵箱功能之區域。在第3 ( b )圖中, 在該區域可以收納從M A I L ( 1 )到M A IL ( N)之N件郵件。 在本實施形態中,電子郵件裝置2 1 A所收信到之電子 郵件存在有2種,亦即,通常之郵件和要求行程登錄之 行程郵件(舉辦會議通知郵件)。第3 ( c )圖表示收信到該 兩件郵件時之收信郵件區域内之記億内容,圔中例示在 M A I U 1 )收納通常郵件,和在M A I L ( N )收納行程郵件。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (请先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在第3圖之實例中,被收納在MAIL(l)之通常郵件包含 有:用來表示郵件種類的旗標SCF;郵件發出人之郵件 位址;郵件之收信者之郵件位址;郵件之件名(名稱), 郵件本文;旗標KAIFU,用來表示該郵件是否被開封過 ;和該郵件之收信時日。其中,在旗標S C F收納” Ο n用來 表示是為通常郵件。另外,旗標KAIFU收納&quot;0”時表示該 郵件未開封,另一方面,假如收納”1”時表示該郵件已 開封過。 在第3圖之實例,被收納在M A I L ( N )之行程郵件收納 有:旗標SCF,收納”1&quot;而表示為行程郵件,郵件之發出 人之郵件位址;郵件收信者之郵件位址,會議之名稱; 會議之開始時刻和終了時刻;會議之舉行場所;會議之 -1 9 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 一- _ — — 五、發明説明(ιΟ 參加者名單;與會議有關之待別記事(例如會議之討論 事項等);與通常郵件相同的旗標KAIFU;和該郵件之收 信時日。 第4圖表示第2 ( a )圖所示之位址列表區域之細節。位 址列表區域是用來收納被登錄的郵件位址之區域。當詳 細觀察位址列表區域時,在第4(b)圖之實例中,可以登 錄從AD I) ( 1 )到A D D ( N )之N個郵件位址資料。在各郵件位 址資料即如第4 ( c )圔所示,包含有姓名、郵件位址、和 郵件塑式(例如,網際網路中之MIME(Multipurpose internet Mail Extensions)之販本等所謂表示對方司 利用之電子郵件之協議規格者)。 第5圖表示第2(a)圖所示之行程區域之細節。在行程 區域收納有以行程表功能使用之行程資料β當詳細觀察 行程區域時,在第5(b}圖之實例中,可以登錄從MONTH(l) 到ΜΟΝΤΗ(Μ)之Μ値月份之郵件位址資料。似此,行程資 料乃桉月被總括記億著,更如第5 ( c )圔所示,每個月之 資料傜由每一曰之資料所構成。 第6 _表示第5(c)圔所示之一天行程資料之細節。在 第6(b)圖之實例中,可以登錄從SCD(l)到SCD(L)之L件 行程資料·如第5(c)圆所示,在各行程資料收納有會議之 名稱,會議之開始時刻和結束時刻,舉行會議場所*會 議之參加者,和與會議有關之特別記事事項、 下面將說明電子郵件裝置21 A之内部動作。 在第1 _所示之電子郵件裝置21A中,與電子郵件有 -2 0 - 本纸張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先聞讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) I n ^ (w- ir - - I n -訂-H - n -- 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(,?) 關之各功能和與行程表有關之各功能,全部以CPU51可 實行之處理程式被預先記億在R0M62, CPU 51邊讀出兩 邊實行該等程式,上述與電子郵件有關之功能包含郵件 之收信,收信郵件列表之顯示,郵件之開封,收納郵件 之消除等本發明所説明之功能,上述與行程表有關之各 功能包含行程之登錄,顯示等本發明所説明之功能。下面 擬邊適當的參照第]圖來説明該等.程式之流程圖。 1 .基本處理 第7圖是主流程圖,用來表示電子郵件裝置21A之CPU 51 所實行之基本處理。 首先,在步驟10 1,藉由電子郵件裝置21 A所具備之圔 中未顯示之時鐘,以取得現在之時曰。 其次,在步驟]〇 2實行收倍處理。但是,該收信處理並 不是通常例行之處理,而是因應每隔一定時間所産生之 計時器中斷所實行之處理。收信處理之細節將於後面之 1 5。描述。 在步驟103,檢查鍵盤之待定之開關是否為0N,假如 是〇 N時就在步驟1 0 4將&quot;1 ”代入到被記憶在C Ρ ϋ 5 1内之暫 存器或RAM61之旗標0NF,然後前進到步驟105。另一方 而,假如開關未被〇 Ν時就直接前進到步驟1 0 5。該鍵盤 上之開關傜由電子郵件裝置2 Α之使用者用來起動後面之 2 。所述之收信顯示處理。 在步驟1 0 5 ,檢査旗標0 N F是否為” 1 ”,假如為” 1 ”時, 就在步驟.1 0 (5實行收倍顯示處理後前進到步驟1 (Π。另一 -21- (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) ,k. 訂 本紙張又度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 Μ Β7五、發明説明(% )方而,假如旗標〇 N F並非” 1 ”時,就不做任何事而前進到 步驟1 0 7。至於收信顯示處理之細節擬於後面之2 .描述。 在步驟1 0 7實行待命郵件消除處理,然後,回到步驟1 〇 1 重複進行上述之處理。待命郵件消除處理之細節擬於後 而之1 fi .描述。C P U 5 1在電子郵件裝置2 1 A進行通常動作之期間,經常 重複實行上述之基本處理程式。2 .收信顯示處理 第 理 處 示 顯 信 收 之 1.行 明實 說所 將&gt; 而 下 驟 步 之 中 画 程 流 作 勖 之 tnc 理 處 本 基 之 圖 同成 的製 表件 覽郵 一 子 之電 件 , 郵除 子刪 電件 的郵 到信 信收 收 , 示封 顯開 乃件 理郵 處示 示指 顯來 信用 收 , 時 示之 顯面 表後 列照 址依 位 , l· 、 夕 成另 製 〇 件求 郵要 程行 行實 、之 處 別 値 等 示 顯 程 行 圖第 。 3(1 1 4 理 第20處 C0 驟示 16步顯 驟之信 步中收 之圖行 中程實 画流來 程之擇 流理選 之處之 理示者 處顯用 示程使 位 4 之及 述 , 顯 表 行 之 述 所 圖 應 因 都 亦 圖 程 流 之 rtE 理 處 示 顯 信 收 是 圖 ο 第 和 _ 9 第 、 雨 8 第 而 畫 之 2 4 置 裝 示 顯 在 示 顯 被 rtE 理 處 示 顯 此 以 籍 示 表 圖 11 ii 第 程 流 之 圖 ο 11 第 和 圖 9 第 f 圖 8 第 於 對 圖 1 11 ο 第明 照說 参以 邊加 而擬 下圖 其 ,表 面列 畫繪 示描 顯之 之框 在的 現表 除列 清件 ,郵 111之 圖 示 顯 字 文 之 曰 時 信 收 驟 步'^ls 之罾件 ^ 17f _彳, 進、 8 人 第 2 出 在11發 ,驟之 先步行 首在上' 次最 而 進 iw衣IT. (讀先閔讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(d ) 藉由滑鼠之喀嚅聲來進行畫面上部之郵件製成,行程郵 件製成,刪除、開封、結束等功能選擇所需的圖符顯示 之描繪。 從步驟Π 3到步驟1 2 1之處理是將被收納在第3圖所示 之RAMG1内之收信郵件區域之各個郵件顯示在第11圔之 郵件列表的顯示框内之處理。 在步驟1 1 3將1代入變敫η。 在步驟1 1 4,檢查被收納在R A Μ 6 1内之收信郵件區域的 «411(1〇之旗標3€?是否為「1」,亦即,假如^^11;(11)為 行程郵件時就前進到步驟1 1 5。另一方面,假如S C F並非 「1」,亦即M A I L ( η )為通常之郵件時就前進到步驟1 1 7。 在步驟U 5,參照被收納在收信郵件儲存區域之M A I L ( η ) ,將郵件之發出人之郵件位址,會議之名稱,郵件之收 信時日等顯示於如第11圖所示的一覽表之1列。另外, 當郵件之發信者位址被收納在第4 _之位址列表區域時 ,亦可從位址列表儲存區域讀出對應之姓名,以代替郵 件位址而顯示,第1 1圖之顯示就是進行此種處理者。另 外,將會議之名稱顯示在第11圔之件名列。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閎讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟11G,顯示在第11圖的件名列之左端之郵件為 行程郵件,並以” S ”記號表示,然後前進到步驟1 1 8。 在步驟1 I 7 ,參照被收納在收信郵件儲存區域之M A I L ( η ) ,將郵件發出人之郵件位址、件名、郵件之收信時日顯 示於第Η _所示的一覽表之1列。另外,當郵件之發信 人位址被收納在第4圖之位址列表儲存區域時,亦可從 -23&quot; 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(&gt;/) 位址列表儲存區域讀出對廳之姓名,以代替郵件位址顯 之。 在步驟ί】8中,將M A I L ( η )之旗標K A I F U和” 0 &quot;加以比較 ,假如開卦旗標為” 0 ”,亦即表示未開封時,就前進到 步驟].]9,在第1 1圖之收信郵件之列表顯示行的左端列 顯示雙重圓圈之記號,用來表示未開封,然後前進到步 驟〗2 0。另一方而,當開封旗標為&quot;1 &quot;,亦即表示已開封 過時,就不做新的顯示直接前進到步驟1 2 0。 在步驟1 2 0使變數η只進1。 在步驟1 2 1,檢查步驟1 1 3進行之第1 1 _所示之郵件列 表之收信郵件之顯示數η是否超過在1個畫而可顯示之 數目Ν,假如超過Ν時就前進到步驟122。另一方面,假 如η未超過Ν時,就回到步驟1 1 4 ,重複進行^^11(1〇的 郵件列表之顯示處理。 自]22以至126之處理是完成第11圖所示之顯示畫面, 為顯示滑鼠游標之處理。 首先,在步驟1 2 2將1代入變數A,在步驟1 2 3施行所 謂反轉顯示,用來使MAIL(A),亦即MAIL(l)之顯示行之 文字顯示色和表之背景色之色彩反轉。另外,在第11圔 中亦得以斜線顯示其行,以代替反轉顯示。 在步驟1 2 4和步驟1 2 5 ,如第1 1圖之郵件列表左劍所示 ,藉以滑鼠喀嚒磬進行位址列表顯示和行程顯示等功能 選擇所需的圖符顯示之描繪。 步驟1 2 fi中,在顯示畫面上之任意位置顯示滑鼠用游 -2 4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先閣讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7_ V. Description of the invention () All materials are stored in the corresponding area. Among them, in the fixed mail storage area, as shown in FIG. 2 (b), four fixed mails A to D read in advance from the ROM 62 are stored. Details of the shaped mail will be explained later. Figure 3 shows the details of the incoming mail area shown in Figure 2 (a). Fig. 3 (a) shows that the receiving mail area is an area for receiving received e-mails, and is an area having a receiving mailbox function. In FIG. 3 (b), N mails from M A I L (1) to M A IL (N) can be stored in this area. In this embodiment, there are two types of e-mails received by the e-mail device 21A, that is, ordinary mails and itineraries (registration mails) that require itinerary registration. Fig. 3 (c) shows the contents of the billions in the receiving mail area when the two mails are received. The example below shows M A I U 1) for storing normal mail and M A I L (N) for storing travel mail. Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page). In the example in Figure 3, the normal mail contained in MAIL (l) contains: Flag SCF; email address of the sender of the message; email address of the recipient of the message; the name (name) of the message, the body of the message; the flag KAIFU, which indicates whether the message has been opened; and the receipt of the message Letter time. Among them, the flag "SCF" is used to indicate that it is a normal mail. In addition, when the flag "KAIFU" is "0", it means that the mail is unopened. On the other hand, when "1" is stored, it means that the mail is unopened. Too. In the example in Figure 3, the travel emails stored in MAIL (N) are stored as: flag SCF, "1", which is indicated as the travel email, the mail address of the sender of the mail, and the mail address of the recipient of the mail , The name of the meeting; the start and end times of the meeting; the place where the meeting is held; the meeting's-19-this paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 X 297 mm) staff consumption of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Cooperative prints A7 B7 I-_--V. Description of invention (ιΟ Participant list; To-do notes related to the meeting (such as meeting discussions, etc.); The same flag KAIFU as usual mail; and the receipt of the mail The date of the letter. Figure 4 shows the details of the address list area shown in Figure 2 (a). The address list area is used to store the registered mail addresses. When you look at the address list area in detail, In the example in Fig. 4 (b), N mail address data from AD I) (1) to ADD (N) can be registered. In each mail address data, as shown in Fig. 4 (c) 圔, Contains name, email address, and email address (For example, MIME (Multipurpose internet Mail Extensions), etc., which is a so-called protocol specification of the e-mail used by the counterparty, etc.). Figure 5 shows the travel area shown in Figure 2 (a). Details. The itinerary data used in the itinerary function is stored in the itinerary area. Β When observing the itinerary area in detail, in the example in Figure 5 (b), you can register the month MONT from MONTH (l) to MOΝΤΗ (Μ). Email address data. It seems that the itinerary data is recorded in a lump sum, as shown in Section 5 (c) 圔. The data of each month is composed of the data of each day. Section 6 _ means Details of the one-day itinerary data shown in Figure 5 (c) (i). In the example in Figure 6 (b), it is possible to register the L-item data from SCD (l) to SCD (L). As shown in the circle, the name of the meeting, the start and end times of the meeting, the meeting place *, the participants of the meeting, and special notes related to the meeting are stored in the information of each itinerary. The internal contents of the email device 21 A will be described below. In the electronic mail device 21A shown in the first _, and the electronic There are -2 0-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) (Please read the notes on the back before filling this page) I n ^ (w- ir--I n- Order -H-n-printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of the function (,?) The functions related to the schedule and the functions related to the schedule are all processed by the CPU51 Billion in advance is implemented on both sides of ROM62, CPU 51 while reading. The above-mentioned functions related to e-mail include receiving mails, displaying the mailing list, opening mails, and eliminating the storage of mails. The functions, the above-mentioned functions related to the itinerary include the registration and display of the itinerary and other functions described in the present invention. The following figure illustrates the flow chart of these programs with appropriate reference to the figure below. 1. Basic Processing Fig. 7 is a main flowchart showing the basic processing performed by the CPU 51 of the electronic mail device 21A. First, in step 101, the present time is obtained by using a clock not shown in the frame provided in the e-mail device 21A. Next, in step 2), a double-reduction process is performed. However, the reception process is not a routine process, but a process performed in response to a timer interrupt that is generated at regular intervals. Receipt processing details will be discussed in the next 15. description. In step 103, check whether the pending switch of the keyboard is 0N. If it is 0N, substitute &quot; 1 "into the register or RAM61 flag stored in C PF 5 1 in step 104. 0NF, and then proceed to step 105. On the other hand, if the switch is not ON, proceed directly to step 105. The switch 傜 on the keyboard is used by the user of the e-mail device 2 A to activate the latter 2. In the received message display process, in step 105, check whether the flag 0 NF is "1". If it is "1", then proceed to step .1 0 (5 and then proceed to step 1) (Π. Another -21- (please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page), k. The bound paper is again applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) Employees of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Cooperative printed M B7. V. Invention Description (%). If the flag 0NF is not "1", then do nothing and proceed to step 107. As for the details of the display process of the receipt, it is intended to be described later. 2. Description: The standby mail elimination processing is performed in step 107, and then, the process returns to step 1 〇1 Repeat the above-mentioned processing. The details of the standby mail elimination processing will be described later. 1 CPU. 1 During the normal operation of the email device 2 1 A, the above-mentioned basic processing routine is often repeated. 2 .Receiving and display processing the first display of the display of the letter of receipt 1. The clear and realistic statement will be> and in the next step, the process flow of the tnc office is the same as the basic chart of the tabulation of the post The electronic mail of a child, the postal mail of the deleted electronic mail, and the receipt of the letter, and the opening and closing of the letter are displayed at the post office to indicate the receipt of the credit. , Xi Cheng made another 0 pieces of postal instructions to show the actual process, the location, etc. to display the process map. 3 (1 1 4 4th 20th C0 shows the 16 steps of the steps shown in the steps in the picture. The flow of the choice of the flow of the reason to choose the place where the display is used to show the use of the display of the bit 4, the manifestation of the description of the map should be based on the flow of the rtE management of the display of the letter is shown. And _ 9th, rain 8th No. 2 4 The display of the display is displayed by the rtE. This is shown in Figure 11 ii Figure of the process flow ο 11 and Figure 9 F f Figure 8 is based on Figure 1 11 ο In addition, the following figure is drawn. The surface of the picture shows the frame on which the picture is displayed, except for the clear list. The post on the icon of the post 111 shows the step of receiving the letter. 17f _ 17f _ Alas, 8 people entered the second round in 11 rounds, and the first step was to walk first in the last time and then enter the iw clothing IT. (Read the precautions on the back and then fill out this page) This paper size applies Chinese national standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (d) Use the click of the mouse to create the mail on the upper part of the screen, create the mail for the itinerary, delete, open, close, etc. Desired icon display. The processing from step III to step 121 is a process of displaying each mail stored in the mail receiving area in RAMG1 shown in FIG. 3 in the display frame of the mail list of the 11th. Substitute 1 into 敫 η in step 1 1 3. In step 1 1 4, it is checked whether the «411 (10 flag of 3 €? 3"? Is "1", which is stored in the receiving mail area of the RA Μ 61, ie, if ^^ 11; (11) is When travelling by mail, proceed to step 1 1 5. On the other hand, if SCF is not "1", that is, if MAIL (η) is a normal mail, proceed to step 1 1 7. At step U 5, the reference is stored in The MAIL (η) of the received mail storage area displays the mail address of the sender of the mail, the name of the meeting, and the date and time of the mail received in the first column of the list shown in Figure 11. In addition, when the mail When the sender's address is stored in the address list area of the 4th _, the corresponding name can also be read out from the address list storage area to be displayed instead of the mail address. The display in Figure 11 shows this. The name of the meeting is displayed on the 11th list. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) At step 11G, it will be displayed on the 11th The mail at the left end of the list in the figure is the travel mail, and it is indicated by "S" , And then proceed to step 1 1 8. In step 1 I 7, referring to the MAIL (η) stored in the receiving mail storage area, the mail address, name, and date of receipt of the mail sender are displayed on the first列 _ column 1 of the list shown. In addition, when the sender address of the mail is stored in the address list storage area in Figure 4, you can also use the Chinese national standard (CNS) Α4 from this paper size. Specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (/) The address list storage area reads the name of the hall instead of displaying the mail address. In step ί ] In 8, the flag KAIFU of MAIL (η) is compared with “0 &quot; If the Kai Gua flag is“ 0 ”, which means that it is unopened, proceed to step].] 9, in the first The left end column of the list display line of the received mail in Figure 1 displays a double circle mark to indicate that it is unopened, and then proceeds to step 〖2 0. On the other hand, when the open seal flag is &quot; 1 &quot;, that is, Indicate that it is out of date, and do not make a new display directly before Go to step 1 2 0. In step 1 2 0, make the variable η enter only 1. In step 1 21, check whether the display number η of the received mail of the mailing list shown in step 1 1 3 of step 1 1 3 is η If it exceeds the number N that can be displayed in one painting, if it exceeds N, proceed to step 122. On the other hand, if η does not exceed N, go back to step 1 1 4 and repeat ^^ 11 (1〇 的The display processing of the mailing list. The processing from [22] to 126 is to complete the display screen shown in FIG. 11 for the processing of displaying the mouse cursor. First, substitute 1 into the variable A in step 1 2 2 and perform the so-called reverse display in step 1 2 3 to make MAIL (A), that is, the text display color of the display line of MAIL (l) and the background color of the table The colors are reversed. In addition, the lines can be displayed diagonally in line 11 instead of reversed display. In steps 1 2 4 and 1 2 5, as shown in the left sword of the mailing list in Figure 11, click the mouse to perform address list display and itinerary display and other functions. Select the required icon display. In step 1 2 fi, the mouse cursor is displayed at any position on the display screen. 2 4-This paper size is applicable to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) (please read the precautions on the back before filling out) (This page)

A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ) 1 1 標 〇 1 1 1 從 步 驟 1 2 7到步驟1 29之處 理為 進 行依 照滑鼠 3 1操作之 1 1 滑 鼠 用 游 標 之 移 動顯 示和滑 鼠3 1 之 喀喔 磬操作 之撿測。 /-—V 請 1 先 1 在 步 驟 1 2 7撿測滑鼠3 1是否移勤, 假如檢測到有滑鼠 閲 讀 1 1 之 移 動 時 就 在 步驟 1 2 8 ,以對應滑鼠. 之移動方向和移 背 面 1 I 之 1 動 距 離 般 &gt; 使 m 鼠用 游標移 動然 後 前進 到步驟 1 29 (第 9 7主 意 1 事 1 圖 )〇 另- -方面, 假如並未檢測到滑鼠 3 1之移動時就前 項 再 1 1 進 到 步 驟 1 2 9 ( 第 9画 )〇 填 寫 本 玆 移 到第 9 圖, 在步驟 129 上, 判斷滑鼠3 1是否加 頁 I 有 喀 m 磬 操 作 9 若有 喀櫪聲 操作 時 就前 進到步 驟 130。 1 1 〇 一 方 面 並 無 喀喔 磬操作 時就 回 到步 驟 127 ( 第8圖) 1 1 t 電 複 進 行 滑 3 1的 操作狀 況之 監 視。 1 訂 白 步 驟 1 3 〇以至第1 0画之步驟1 4 4之處 理是自 檢測到滑 1 鼠 喀 m 聲 時 之 滑 鼠游 標之位 置起 , 識別 電子郵 件裝置2 1Α 1 1 所 旦 有 之 各 種 功 能之 選擇者 〇 1 I 首 先 從 步 驟 1 3 0到步驟1 3 2之 處 理是 如第1 1 圖所示, 1 1 被 顯 示 在 顯 示 裝 置42 之郵件 列表 中 ,設 定做為 進行以後 處 理 對 象 的 郵 件 之處 理。 1 I 在 步 驟 1 a ϋ中, 檢查滑鼠3 1被施加喀1 歷聲操作時之滑鼠 1 1 V 用 游 標 的 顯 示 書 而上 之位置 ,假 如 滑鼠 用游標 位於郵件 1 1r 列 表 中 時 就 前 進 到步 驟13U 另- -方而 ,假如滑鼠用游標 1 | 存 在 於 其 他 位 置 時就 前進到 步驟 1 3 3〇 1 1 在 步 驟 1 3 1中, 取得對應滑鼠用游標 听位置的顯示行之 1 1 郵 件 號 碼 9 將 其 值代 入變數 A,接著在 步驟132 ,反轉顯 1 -2 5- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 五、發明説明(4 Μ 示 之顯 應轉 對反 Α 他 數其 變使 與並在 示 , 中 3 3 11 驟 步 査 檢 A7 B7 時 同 之 的 時 色 作 景 操 背 聲 和 _ 字 lrcoB§ 文I加 β ^ Μ Ι7Ϊ常 1 7Γ通 3 顯 fm A)D 滑 ( 回 IL行.當 左游 面用 畫鼠 示滑 顯如 圏假 T 5 第果 於結 位其 否 。 是置 置位 位一 面任 畫中 示 示 顯顯 的符 標圖 游痼 用 2 鼠之 滑部 驟l· 步“, 在 時 就 SO 置 ,13位 時驟之 置步示 位到顯 之進 j. 示前表 顯,列 後址 程然位 1 了 Γ r .理於 於處位 位示標 標顯游 實如 34假 驟 步 在 就A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention () 1 1 Bid 0 1 1 1 The processing from step 1 2 7 to step 1 29 is performed in accordance with mouse 3 1 1 1 for mouse Cursor movement display and mouse 3 1 click operation check. / -— V Please 1 first 1 step 1 2 7 to check whether the mouse 3 1 is moving. If a movement of the mouse reading 1 1 is detected, go to step 1 2 8 to correspond to the movement direction of the mouse. Move the back surface 1 I to 1 with a moving distance &gt; Make the m mouse move with the cursor and then proceed to step 1 29 (9th idea 1 thing 1 picture) 〇 In addition, if the mouse 3 1 is not detected When moving, go to the previous item and then go to step 1 2 9 (Paint 9). Fill in the book and move to the 9th picture. At step 129, determine whether the mouse 3 1 is added to the page. When clicking, the operation proceeds to step 130. 1 1 〇 When there is no click, go back to step 127 (Figure 8) 1 1 t to monitor the operating status of the slide 3 1 operation. 1 Whitening step 1 3 0 to 10th step 1 4 4 The process is to identify the email device 2 1Α 1 1 from the position of the mouse cursor when a mouse click is detected. Selector of various functions 〇1 I First, the processing from step 130 to step 13 2 is as shown in Fig. 11. 1 1 is displayed in the mailing list of the display device 42 and is set as a target for subsequent processing. Processing of mail. 1 I In step 1 a, check the mouse 3 1 when the mouse is clicked. 1 1 V The position of the mouse 1 1 V is displayed with the cursor. If the mouse cursor is in the mail 1 1r list, Proceed to step 13U. Otherwise, if mouse cursor 1 | exists in other positions, proceed to step 1 3 3〇1 1 In step 1 31, obtain the display corresponding to the mouse cursor position Line 1 1 Mail number 9 Substitute its value into variable A, and then in step 132, reverse display 1 -2 5- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) 5. Description of the invention (4 Μ shown in the display should be reversed and reversed Α other changes and shown in the 3, 11 step by step check A7 B7 same time scene scenery back and forth and _ word lrcoB§ Text I Add β ^ Μ Ι 7Ϊ often 1 7 Γ 3 3 fm A) D slip (back to the IL line. When the left swimming surface is shown with a mouse, it will appear as if the false T 5 is the result. Whether it is set or not Symbols shown in the picture You use the 2 mouse slide step l · step ", set SO at the moment, set the step to 13 when the step is displayed to the display of the j. Show the front display, the position after the column is 1 Γ r .The reason is that the display of the mark at the place is like 34 false steps.

程用實 行鼠35 行滑I 時 置 位 60之 3 1 1 同 驟不 步示 到顯 進符 前 _ 後個 然兩 ,該 理與 處於 示位 顯標 表游 列用 址鼠 位 0 行如 此 在 假 就 位 5 D明 β 說 節 細 3 之和 311 理 · 4» 處之 示面 顯後 程 於 行IJr 6 分 13將 驟節 步細 到之 •v·-- 進理 前處 地示 動顯 作表 圧5 V 翻:?1 毫址 中 假 之 面 畫 示 顯 13的 驟標 步游 在用 鼠 滑 之 時 作 操 聲 _ 喀 有 加 被 1X 3 鼠 滑 之 部 上 而 畫 示 顯 _ 1A ii 第 在 是 置 --------——{kl-I (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) -訂 時 1 份驟 部 步 示 到 顯進Jr 成後 製之 件理 郵處 Γ 成 驟 步 行 實 在 就 另 方 製游 件用 郵鼠 之滑 37如 L假 驟 步 到 進 前 地 5· 動.之 作而 無後 毫於 就將 *節 時細 置之 位理 他處 其成 於製 位件 標郵 就 ''!4'η· 逑 描 以 Π 力 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 驟之 步標 在游 用 鼠 滑 之 時 作 操 喀 加 施 被 iA 3 鼠 滑 如 假 中 I1 yll 厂 之 部 上 面 畫 示 顯 圖 11. ii 第 在 是 置 位 面 叢 示 程 , 行面 之方 9 一 3 I 1X I 另 驟 步 } 行圖 實10 在第 就 ο 4 , 1i 時驟 份步 β. rtu 之進 示前 顯後 tn 二 J 理 成處 製成 件製 郵件 程郵 步 到 進 前 地 動 作 無 毫 就 時 置 位 他 其 於 位 標)o 游画 ο 用 1 鼠第 滑0{ 4 如 1 假驟 而 後 於 將 節 細 之 m 二 理 處 成 製 件 郵 程 I7 y/1 就 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(J ) 之6 .描逑。 移到第1 〇圖,從步驟1 4 0到步驟1 4 2之處理是刪除所 保持的收信郵件之處理。 在步驟]4 fl中,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀壢操作時之滑鼠 用游標之顯示畫而位置是在第11画顯示畫面上部之「刪 除」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟1 4 1,另一方面,假 如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就前進·到步驟1 4 3。 在步驟141中,將藉由步驟132(第9圖)之處理所反轉 顯示的MAIL(A)之内容(第3(c)圖所示之各記億内容)從 R A Μ 6 1中刪除。 在步驟1 4 2中,就第3 ( b )圖所示之R A Μ 6 1之收信郵件儲 存區域所記億之收信郵件之記憶内容,將被刪除之M A I L (A)以後的號碼做逐一處理,接著為顯示被更新之記億内 容而回到步驟111(第8圖)。 在步驟1 4 3中,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀壢操作時之滑鼠 用游標之顯示畫面位置是在第11圖顯示畫面上部之「開 封」顯示之部份時,就在實行步驟1 4 4之開封處理後, 前進到步驟145。另一方面,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位 置時,就毫無作動地前進到步驟145。就開封處理之細 節將於後面之8.描述。 從步驟1 4 5到步驟1 4 7之處理是使收信顯示處理結束之 處理。Cheng Yong sets the mouse to 3 when the slider is 35. I set it to 60 3 1 1 at the same time. In the false seat 5 D Ming β said the sum of the details 3 311 reason · 4 »shows the display later in line IJr 6 minutes 13 will be the details of the steps to v •-move forward before the reason Shown as a table : 5 V turn:? 1 milligrams of fake face painting display 13 steps in the footsteps when the mouse slides _ Car Youjia was shown on the 1X 3 mouse slide _ 1A ii The first place is ------------ (kl-I (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page)-When ordering, 1 step will be shown in step-by-step. The post office Γ Cheng Xing walks on the other side of the tour, using the slide of the post mouse 37, such as L to step forward to the front of the site. 5. If there is no later, set the * time carefully The reason is that it is completed by the labeling of the position piece. ``! 4'η · Describe the steps printed on the mouse by the consumer consumer cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. At the time, the operation of Kagashi was performed by the iA 3 mouse, as shown in the figure on the top of the I1 yll plant. 11. ii The position of the set surface is shown, and the side of the surface is 9-3 I 1X I Another step Step} The real picture 10 at the moment ο 4, 1i step β. Rtu's presentation before the display tn two J formation into a piece of mail mail step to the front without any action Place it on the mark) o Painting ο use 1 mouse slide 0 {4 as 1 false step, and then process the details of the m into a post I7 y / 1 Applies Chinese national standards for this paper size (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (J) 6. Moving to FIG. 10, the process from step 140 to step 14 2 is a process of deleting the held incoming mail. In the step] 4 fl, if the mouse 3 1 is displayed with the mouse cursor when the click operation is performed, and the position is the part of the "Delete" display at the top of the 11th screen display screen, proceed to step 1 4 1. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is in another position, proceed to step 1 4 3. In step 141, the contents of the MAIL (A) (the contents of the billions shown in FIG. 3 (c)), which are reversely displayed by the processing in step 132 (FIG. 9), are deleted from the RA M 61. . In step 14 2, the memory content of the received mails recorded in the received mail storage area of RA Μ 61 shown in Figure 3 (b) will be the number after MAIL (A) deleted Process one by one, and then return to step 111 (Figure 8) in order to display the updated billion content. In step 1 4 3, if the position of the display screen of the mouse cursor when the mouse 3 1 is clicked is the part of the "opening" display in the upper part of the display screen of Fig. 11, step 1 is performed. After the unsealing process of 4 4, the process proceeds to step 145. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is at another position, it proceeds to step 145 without any action. The details of the unsealing process will be described in 8. The processing from step 1 4 5 to step 1 4 7 is processing for terminating the reception display processing.

在步驟].4 5,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫面位置是在第11圔顯示畫面上部之「結束J -2 7 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) ----------ιίβ L------訂 (請先閩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 B7 經濟部中央標率局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( λ ) 1 1 顯 示 之 部 份 時 9 就 前 進 到 步 驟 14 6〇 另— -方面, 假如滑 1 1 鼠 用 游 標 在 其 他 位 置 時 » 就 判 斷 為 在 步 驟 12 9 ( 第 9 圖) 1 1 所 檢 測 到 之 此 次 滑 鼠 喀 喔 並 Μ Λξ»' 義 9 回 到 步 驟 12 7 ( 第8 ^-V 請 1 先 1 圖 ), 重複進行滑鼠3 1的操作狀況之監視。 聞 讀 1 I 在 步 驟 14 G清除所有收信顯示處理之顯示畫面, 在步 背 面 1 I 之 1 驟 14 7將旗標〇 N F 設 定 為 Η 0 &quot;用來起動聯合1 9 基 本 處 理之 注 意 1 # 1 項 —*· 併 所 說 明 之 收 信 顯 不 處 理 » · 以 結 束 此 次 之 收 信顯 項 再 寫 丄 示 處 理 〇 本 h 3 . 1 i t列表顯示處理 頁 1 I 下 而 將 說 明 2 . 之收信顯示處理之流程圖中第9 画之 1 1 步 驟 13 5所實行之位址列表顯示處理。 位址列表顯示處 1 1 理 可 顯 示 被 記 億 在 第 4 _ 所 示 之 位 址 列 表 區 域 中 登 錄過 1 訂 之 郵 件 位 址 列 表 的 同 時 &gt; 並 可 指 示 郵 件 位 址 追 加 登 錄, 1 郵 件 位 址 登 錄 刪 除 郵 件 位 址 登 綠 内 容 詳 細 顯 示 9 收信 1 1 郵 件 列 表 顯 示 &gt; 行 程 顯 示 的 各 種 處 理 之 實 行 要 求 〇 另外 1 位 址 列 表 顯 示 處 理 亦 可 以 因 應 使 用 者 之 選 擇 在 4 . 後 1 1 / 述 之 行 程 顯 示 處 理 之 流 程 圖 中 步 驟 20 3 ( 第 1 7 圖 )中實行。 ( | 第 1 2 _ 和 第 1 3 圖 是 收 信 顯 示 處 理 之 流 程 圖 〇 另 外 ,第 1 I ]4 圖 表 示 藉 該 處 理 顯 示 在 顯 示 裝 置 4 2之 畫 面 〇 下 面 將邊 1 | f 参 眧 第 1 4 圖 邊 對 第 1 2 圖 和 第 1 3 圖 之 流 程 圖 加 以 説 明 〇 ιΓ 首 先 在 第 1 2 圖 之 步 驟 1 5 ]即藉以滑鼠之喀喔操作實行 1 1 1 為 選 擇 第 1 4 圖 之 位 址 列 表 框 之 描 繪 或 列 表 最 上 行 之 姓名 1 1 &gt; 郵 件 位 址 等 文 字 顯 示 進 而 9 畫 面 上 部 之 郵 件 位 址追 1 I 加 9 郵 件 位 址 刪 除 9 登 錄 郵 件 位 址 詳 細 顯 示 &gt; 結 束 等功 1 1 -2 8- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(&lt;) 能所需的圖符顯示的描繪。 從步驟1 5 2到步驟1 5 5之處理是將被收納在第4圔所示 之R. A Μ 61内的位址列表區域之郵件位址列表顯示在第1 4 圖所示之郵件位址列表顯示框内之處理。 在步驟1 5 2將1代入變數η。 在步驟1 5 3,參照被收納在位址列表區域之A D D ( η ), 而將姓名和對應之郵件位址顯示在一覽表之].列。 在步驟1. 5 4使變數η只増加1 。 在步驟1 5 5,檢査藉步驟]5 3向位址列表之登錄郵件位 址之顯示數η是否超過1橱書而可顯示之數目Μ,假如 超過Μ時就前進到步驟1 5 6。另一方面,假如η未超過Μ 時就回到步驟1 5 3 ,重複進行向A D D ( η )的位址列表之顯 不處理。 從]5 6到6 0之處理是完成第1 4 _所示之顯示畫面,顯 示滑鼠游標之處理。 首先,在步驟1 5 6和步驟1 5 7施行為第1 4圖之位址列表 左側所示之收信郵件列表顯示和行程顯示等所謂藉滑鼠 喀糖操作而選擇功能所需的圖符顯示之描繪。 在步驟1 5 8將1代入變數A,在步驟1 5 9進行反轉顯示 ,亦卽,使M A I U A )(亦即Μ Λ I L U )〉顯示行之文字顯示色和 表之背景色之色彩反轉顯示。另外,在第1 4 _中亦可以 斜線顯示替代反轉顯示。 在步驟1 G 0 ,將滑鼠用游檫顯示在顯示畫而上任意之 位置。 -29- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意Ϋ項再填寫本頁) L衣. '1Τ 五、發明説明( 步 之 圔 3 1 第 到 A7 B7 鼠之 滑作 照操 依, 行喀 施之 是31 理鼠 處滑 之和 63示 11顯 肋 ΤΠΗΠ 移 之 標 游 用 鼠 β 1 滑 驟之 步作 從操 3 檢 滑離 到距 測動 檢移 如向 假方 ,動 動移 移之 被鼠 否滑 是與 31能 鼠62 滑.1 驟 檢ί. 在 1,就 ]6時 驟勳 步移 在之 鼠 I驟 假 用 步 鼠肖到 rtliitt: bh 使 Μ 一 $ ,另&quot; 般 仍 應)ο地 對圖動 移 標 游 未 如 驟 步 rtu- 至 進 前13 . &amp;£ 〇 後 I } 滑 然U _ 0 3® 2 s 第 作 無 毫 就 時 動 移 之 鼠 滑 斷 判 驟 步 到 進 前 6 1 就 驟時 步作 在操 ,pi 圖喀 3 -1 有 第當 到 , 移作 操 0 , 瞎而 加方 施一 被另 否 0 是 6 ---------— (請先鬩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 驟 步 。 到視 回監 就之 時況 作狀 操作 0 操 喀的 無31 #.鼠 若滑 1了 Λ1 進 複 重 圖 2 第 作 操 喔 喀 鼠 2 滑置 到裝 測件 檢郵 從子 是電 理擇 處選 之 , 173起 L置 位 之 標 1G游 驟鼠 步滑 從之 時 驟 步 至 有 具 所 從 示 所 圖 4 1A 第 如 m 二 理 處 ,之 6 6 lx 驟 步 到 4 6 IX 驟 〇 步 能從 功 , 種先 各首 之 1 了 施 為 作 定 設 中 表 列 t h 位 件 C 郵址 之位 42件 置郵 裝之 示象 顯對 在理 示處 顯下 被以 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 鼠 滑 杳 檢 置 位 之 上 而 4, 畫 Π 1 示 驟顯 步的 在標 游 用 鼠 滑 之 時 作 操 櫪 喀 Π 力 施 被 5 /1 件 郢 於 位 標 游 用 鼠 滑 如 假 另 鼠 滑 如 假 , ο 而67 方Ϊ 步 到 50進 61r 驟就 步時 到置 進位 前他 就其 ,於 時在 中存 表檫 列游 址用 對數 所變 行入 示代 顯值 之其 置將 位 , 所η} 檫之 游中 用η) 鼠 D 滑An /V 曰守 y/1 S 取酮 號 丨之 1fi位 驟件 步郵 在的 應 中 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(2丨0'乂297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 (· &gt;9 ) 1 1 A 接 著 在 步 驟 1 G 6, 反轉顯示對應變數Α的ADD ( A) 顯 1 1 示 行 之 文 字 和 背 景 色 的 同 時 &gt; 並使 其他之反轉顯示行回 1 1 到 通 常 之 顯 示 〇 ^—V. 請 1 先 1 在 步 驟 16 7 , 檢查滑鼠3 1被施加喀喔操作時之滑 鼠 用 閲 % 1 1 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 面 位 置 是 否 在 於 第14 圔之顯示畫面左部之 背 1 I 之 1 2 锢 圖 符 顯 示 中 之 任 一 位 置 〇 其結 果,假如滑鼠用游標 注 意 1 I 事 1 在 於 厂 收 信 郵 件 J _ 符 之 位 置 時, 就在步驟1 G 8實 行 2 . 項 I 所 説 明 之 收 信 顯 示 處 理 &gt; 然 後 ,.w. , 刖 進到步驟1 7 0。 在 此, % 本 k 假 如 滑 鼠 用 游 標 位 於 與 該 兩 個 圖符 不同之位置時, 就毫 頁 I 不 作 動 地 仍 然 前 進 到 步 驟 1 7 0〇 就行程顯示處理之 細 節 1 1 將 於 後 而 之 4 . 項描逑。 1 1 在 步 驟 17 〇中, 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之 滑 鼠 1 訂 用 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 置 在 於 第 1 4圖 顯示畫商上部之 「追 1 加 J 顯 示 的 部 份 時 就 在 實 行 步驟 1 7 1之位址追加 處 理 1 1 後 9 前 進 到 步 驟 17 2 0 另- -方面,假如滑鼠用游標 位 置 1 I 在 其 他 位 置 時 9 就 毫 -fm* Μ 作 動 地 仍然 前進到步驟1 7 2 〇 就 1 1 位 址 追 加 處 理 之 細 節 將 於 後 面 之9 . 項描述。 T 在 步 驟 17 2, 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀櫪操作時之滑 鼠 用 1 | 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 商 位 置 在 第 14 圖 顯示 畫面上部之「詳細j 1 1 顯 示 之 部 份 時 , 就 在 實 施 步 驟 1 7 3之位址詳細顯示 處 理 1 1 之 後 刖 進 到 步 驟 1 7 4 〇 另- -方而, 假如滑鼠用游 个示 在 1 | 於 其 他 位 置 時 就 毫 不 作 動 地 仍然 前進至步驟1 7 4 〇 位 1 1 址 詳 細 就 顯 示 處 理 之 細 節 將 於 後面 之1 〇 .項描述。 1 I 從 步 驟 1 7 4到步驟1 7 7 之 處 理 是刪 除登錄it»件位址之 1 I -3 1 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(2丨OX 297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(W ) 處理。 在步驟1 7 4中,假如潸鼠3〗被施加喀櫪操作時之滑鼠 用游標之顯示書而位置在第14_顯示畫而上部之「刪除」 顯示之部扮時,就前進到步驟1 7 5 ,另一方而,假如滑 鼠用游標在於其他位置時就前進到步驟1 7 8。 在步驟1 7 5從R. A M fi]中刪除藉由步驟1 (5 6之處理所反轉 顯示之ADDU)之内容(第4(C)_所示之各記億内容)。 在步驟1 7 6,就第4 ( b )圖所示之R. A Μ 6 1的位址列表區域 所記憶之收信郵件之記億内容,將被刪除之A D D ( A)以後 之號碼施行逐一順推之處理,接著,在步驟177消除規在 所顯示的畫而後,為顯示被更新之記億内容所需,而回 到步驟3 5](第1 2圖)。 (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 處 示 顯 表 列 h H=r- 位 束 結 要 是 trr: 理 處 之 9 7 ii 驟 步 i 8 7 1 ο 驟理 步處 從之 理 鼠 滑 如 假 中 第 於 在 是 置 位 而 畫 示 17顯 驟之 步標 在游 用 鼠 滑 之 時 作 橾 壢 喀 Π 力 施 被 之 部 上 而 畫 示 顯 圖 另 面 方 驟 步 在 為 9 斷 7 _, 1&quot;. 驟就 步 , 到時 進置 前位 就他 ,其 時於 份在 部標 之游 示用 顯鼠 J 滑 束如 結假 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 驟 步 〇 到視 回監 使之 ,況 義狀 意作 無操 並的 _31 喀鼠 鼠滑 猾行 的進 次複 此重 之), 到丨 測 檢 所 第 圖 trt: 理 處 示 顯 表 列 址 位 9,之 17次 驟此 步 束 在結 面 畫 示 顯 有 所 之 311 理 處 示 顯 表 列 址 位 藉 除 清 mu 理 處 示 顯 程 1了 Λ1 4 驟 步 之 中 _ 程 流 之 理 處 示 顯 信 收 之 2 明 説 將 而 下 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X29&quot;/公釐) A7 B7 經濟.部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( &gt;t 1 ) 1 1 (第9 圖)和 項之位址列表顯示處理之流程圖中的步 1 1 I 驟 1 0 9 { 第 1 a 圖 )所實行之行程顯示處理。 1 1 行 程 顯 示 處 理 是 按 每 橱月顯示被記億 在 第 5圖 所示 之 ^ 請 1 1 先 1 RA Mfi 1内的行程區域已登錄過之行程的同時, 號可指示要 閲 1 I 求 實 行 行 程 迫 加 登 錄 S 行程登錄内容詳 細 顯 示、 上個 月 背 之 1 1 之 行 程 顯 示 、 下 個 月 之 行程顯示、收信 郵 件 列表 顯示 注 意 1 I 事 1 位 址 列 表 顯 示 等 各 項 處 理。 項 再 1 U 第 1 5 圖 &gt; 第 1 6 画 9 第 1 7 _和第1 8圖是 收 信 顯示 處理 之 填 寫 本 流 程 圖 〇 另 外 , 第 1 9 圖 表示藉該處理顯 示 在 顯示 裝置 4 2 頁 ----- | 之 面 〇 下 而 , 擬 邊 參 照第1 9圖而就第 1 5 圖 、第 1 6圔 S 1 | 第 17 圖 » 和 第 18 圖 之 流 程圖加予説明^ 1 1 首 先 從 第 1 5 圖 之 步 驟18 1到步驟187 之 處 理是 顯示 第 1 訂 1 1 1 9 圖 所 示 之 該 B 有 •fnr m 行 程的曰曆(以下稱為行程日曆) &gt; 和 顯 示 其 周 圍 部 份 之 各 圖符。 1 1 首 先 &gt; 在 第 1 5 圖 之 步 驟1 8 i清除現在所顯示的畫而, 1 I 接 著 9 在 步 驟 1 8 2實行, 第19圖之行程日暦框之fi S繪、 1 1 或 B 曆 框 上 部 之 &quot;年” 或 ”月''等所謂文字 顯 示 ,進 而, 畫 ί :!_ 而 上 部 之 行 程 登 錄 行 程詳細顯示、上 傾 月 之行 程顯 示 1 I &gt; 下 個 月 之 行 程 顯 示 結束等所謂為藉 以 滑 鼠的 喀喔 操 1 作 而 選 擇 功 能 所 需 的 W 符顯示之描繪, 在 步 驟18 3,施 i I V. 行 第 1 9 _ 之 行 程 R 暦 之 左御所示之收信 郵 件 顯示 和位 址 1 I 列 表 顯 示 之 圖 符 顯 示 之 描繪。 1 1 在 步 驟 J 8 4 中, 將1 項之基本處理的流程画中之步驟 1 I 1 Π 1 ( 第 7 圖 )之時刻計測處理所取得之現在年月設定為 1 I -3 3 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(》) 栺定年月,將其收納在CPU51内之暫存器或RAM61。 在步驟].8 5 ,將指定年月顯示在第1 9圖之日暦框上部 之年月顯示部份,其次,在步驟186將指定年月之一個 月份日期在日屑框内分別對應一星期之各日而顯示之。 在步驟187實行,將現在日期之顯示欄反轉顔示為文 字顯示色和欄之背景色的色彩之反轉顯示。另外,在第 1 9圖中亦得以斜線顯示,以代替反.轉顯示。 從步驟]8 8到第1 6 _步驟1 9 3之處理是施加預約標記的 處理,用來表示在第19圖行程日曆之日期欄登錄有行程。 首先,步驟1 8 8中,在第5圖所示RAM 6 1.内之行程匾域 ,在收納有與指定年月對應之一個月份的行程資料之區 域開頭,設定指標B。 移到第〗G圖,在步驟189將1代入變數η。 步驟1 9 0中,在第5画所示之行程區域内,檢査在 Μ 0 N T fi ( Β )内之η日區域是否收納有行程資料,假如有收 納時,就前進到步驟1 9 1,在第1 9圖之行程日暦所該當 的曰期欄之左上角顯示預約檫記Γ R”記號),以示在該 R存在有登錄過之行程,然後前進到步驟1 9 2。 在步驟1 9 2使變數η只進1。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟1 9 3檢測η俏是否超過Μ Ο Μ Τ Η ( Β )之最終日,假 如超過時就前進到步驟1 9 4。另一方而,假如η價未超 過Μ Ο Ν Τ Η ( Β )之最終日時,就回到步驟1 9 0,重複進行預 約標記之顯示處理。 在步驟194,將第】9圖所示之行程日暦之月初(1日) -3 4 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明( ) 1 1 1 欄 變 更 為 與 其 他 聽 俩 不 同 顔 色而顯 示之。另外, 在第19圖 1 1 I 中 將 月 初 欄 之 顯 示 色 以 網 狀顯示 ,其顔色與其他欄不同。 1 1 從 步 驟 19 6到步驟1 98 之 處理是 用來施行依照滑鼠31操 請 先 1 1 作 之 滑 鼠 用 游 標 之 移 動 顯 示,及 滑鼠31之喀喔操作之檢 閱 讀 1 背 1 測 Ο 面 之 1 注 I 在 步 驟 19 6, 檢查滑鼠3 1是否被移動,例如 檢測 到滑鼠 意 1 之 移 動 時 就 在 步 驟 197, 能與滑鼠之移動方向 移動 距離 項 再 1 / 對 應 般 移 動 滑 鼠 用 游 標 ,然後 前進到步驟1 980 另一 寫 本 V 方 而 , 假 如 未 檢 測 出 滑 鼠 3 1之移 動時就毫不作動地仍然 頁 '—- 1 V /, 刖 進 到 步 驟 198。 1 I 在 步 驟 198, 判斷滑鼠3 1.是否加有喀暱操作 ,假 如有 1 1 喀 操 作 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 1 99 (第 1 7圖)。另一 方面 ,假 1 訂 如 並 無 喀 m 操 作 時 9 就 回 到步驟 196,重複進 行滑 鼠3 1 1 I 的 操 作 狀 況 之 監 視 Ο 1 1 移 到 第 17 圖 9 從 步 驟 1 9 9到步驟2 1 2之處理是從檢測到 | 滑 鼠 有 喀 喔 時 之 滑 鼠 游 標 位置起 ,實行電子郵件裝置21A 1 所 具 有 之 各 種 功 能 的 選 擇 Ο V 首 先 , 從 步 驟 1 9 9到步驟2 G 1之 處理是在被顯示之行程 1 I 曰 歴 中 ί 設 定 成 為 進 行 以 後處理 之對象日期。 1* I 在 步 驟 1 9 9 , 檢查滑鼠3 1被施加喀喔操作時 之滑 鼠用 1 L 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 上 位 置 &gt; 假如滑 鼠用游標位於行程日暦中 1 I 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 2(1 0〇 另- -方而, 假如滑鼠用 游標 存在於 1 1 其 他 位 置 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 2 0 2 e 1 1 在 步 驟 2 0 〇 , 取得與滑鼠用游標所位置之欄 對應 的曰 1 I _ 2 5- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( h^r ) 1 1 期 , 將 該 曰 期 代 入 指 標 A, 然後在步驟2 Q 1,將與指標A 1 1 對 應 之 Β 期 的 顯 示 趣 側 •fa» 變 更 為同於步驟1 9 4所使用之 月 初 1 1 欄 之 變 更 色 的 同 時 ·» 並使被顔色變更之其他日期 欄 恢 /·—v 請 ! 先 1 復 原 來 的 顔 色 〇 閱 ft 1 1 在 步 驟 20 2 , 檢杳滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒操作時之滑 鼠 用 背 面 1 I 之 1 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 置 是 否 在於第19圔顯示畫面左部之2 注 意 1 # 1 锢 圖 符 顯 示 位 置 中 之 0 其結果,.假如滑鼠用游標是在 項 再 1 於 厂 位 址 列 表 J 圔 符 之 位 置時,就在步驟2 0 3實行 3 項 % 寫 i 本 所 説 明 之 位 址 列 表 顯 示 處 理,然後,前進到步驟2 0 5 〇 頁 1 I 另 外 9 假 如 滑 m 用 游 標 在 於「收信郵件J圖符之位置時 1 1 &gt; 就 在 步 驟 2 0 4實行2 項所説明之收信顯示處理, 妷 後 1 1 刖 進 到 步 驟 20 5 〇 另外, 假如滑鼠用游標位於與 該 兩 1 訂 値 圔 符 不 同 之 位 置 時 9 就 毫無作動地連接前進到步驟 1 20 5 〇 1 I 在 步 驟 20 5 , 假如滑鼠3 ]被施加喀噘操作時之滑 鼠 用 1 I 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 置 是 在 於第19圖顯示畫面上部之 厂登 1 ,丄 錄 J 顯 示 之 部 份 時 &gt; 就 實 行步驟2 0 6之行程登錄處 理 之 I 後 ϊ 前 進 到 步 驟 20 7〇 另- -方面,假如滑鼠用游標 在 於 1 | 其 他 位 置 時 就 毫 不 作 動 地 直接前進到步驟2 0 7。就 行 程 1 » 登 錄 處 理 之 細 節 將 於 後 面 之11.描述。 1 步 驟 2(1 7 , 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀暱橾作時之滑 鼠 用 1 1 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 置 是 在 於第19圖顯示畫面上部之 1 1 厂 詳 細 J 顯 示 之 部 份 時 * 就在實行步驟2 0 8之行程 詳 細 1 I 顯 示 處 理 後 1 前 進 到 步 驟 2 0 9 (第18圖)。另一方面 假 1 1 -? 6-(下接第3 8頁) 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(4 ) 如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就毫無作動地直接前進到步 驟2 β 9(第ί 8圖)。就行程詳細顯示處理之細節將於後而 之1 3 .描述。 移到第〗8 在步驟2 0 9 ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操 作時之滑鼠用游標顯示畫而位置是在於第19画顯示畫面 上部之「上個月」顯示之部份時,就在實行步驟2 1 0之 上個月顯示處理後,回到步驟1 8 5 .(第1 5圖)。另一方面 ,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就毫無作動地直接前進 到步驟2 1〗。牵於上個月顯示處理之細節將於後面之1 4 . 描述。 在步驟2 Π,假如滑鼠3 ]被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示書而位置是在於第19圖顯示畫而上部之「下 個月」顯示之部份時,就實行步驟2 1 2之前個月顯示處 理後,回到步驟1 8 5 (第1 5圖)。另一方而,假如滑鼠用 游標在其他位置時,就毫無作動地育接前進到步驟2 1 3 。就下個月顯示處理之細節將於後面之14.描述。 從步驟2〗3到步驟2】4之處理是結束行程顯示處理者。 在步驟2 1 3 ,假如滑鼠:Π被施加喀櫪操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫而位置是在於第19圖顯示畫而上部之「結 束..I顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 1 4。另一方面,假 如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時,就判斷為在步驟1 9 8 (第1 6 圖)所檢測到的此次之滑鼠喀曠並無意義,便回到步驟 ]S (5 (第1 β _),電複進行滑鼠3 1的操作狀況之監視。 在步驟2 1 4,清除行程顯示處理所顯示的所有畫而, -3 8 -(上接第3 6頁) 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印裝 A7 B7 五、發明説明() 結束此次之收信顯示處理。 5.郵件製成處理 下而將説明2.之收信顯示處理之流程圖中的步驟137 &lt;第9圖)所實行之郵件製成處理。郵件製成處理是製成 通常郵件而加以發信的處理。 第20圖和第21_是郵件製成處理之流程圔。另外,第 22圖表示藉由此種處理顯示在顯示裝置42之畫面。下面 將邊參照第22画用來説明第20和第21圖之流程圖。 從步驟2 2 1到步驟2 2 2之處理是製成第2 2 _之畫面顯示 之處理。 首先,在步驟221將第22圖所示之郵件製成畫面的各 攔之顯示框描繪和收件人、件名、發信、取消、位址指 定等所謂文字,加以顯示。 步驟2 2 2中,在收件人輸入區域(第22圔之收件人攔) 顯示用以表示文字輸入位置之文字用游標。 在步驟2 2 3,在分別藉由第2 2圖之郵件製成處理圖面 所對應的欄,將被收納在第2(a)圖所示之RAM61内的郵 件製成區域之郵件收件人、件名、本文等各資料加以顯 7K 〇 在步驟2 2 4 ,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上之任意 位置。 從步驟2 2 5到第2〗圖之步驟2 3 7之處理乃是藉由滑鼠3 1 之操作,文字用游標之移動,和來自收件人輸入之位址 列表之指定、郵件發信、或郵件製成之取消(中止)之各 -3 9 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)In step] .4 5, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the display position of the mouse cursor at the time of operation is "End J -2 7-" on the upper part of the 11th display screen.-This paper size applies Chinese national standards (CNS) Α4 specification (210X297 mm) ---------- ιίβ L ------ Order (please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) A7 B7 Central standard rate of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Printed by the Bureau ’s Consumer Cooperatives V. Invention Description (λ) 1 1 When the displayed part 9 goes to step 14 6〇 In addition, if you slide 1 1 mouse cursor in other position »it is judged to be in step 12 9 (Figure 9) 1 1 This time the mouse was clicked and this time Μ Λξ »'Meaning 9 Return to step 12 7 (8 ^ -V please 1 first 1 picture), repeat the mouse 3 1 Monitor the operating conditions. Read 1 I in step 14 G to clear all the display screens of the reception display processing, in the back of the step 1 I 1 step 14 7 Set the flag 〇NF to Η 0 &quot; used to start the joint 1 9 base Note of processing 1 # 1 item— * · And the received message display is not processed »· To end the received message display item and rewrite the indication processing 〇 this h 3. 1 it list display processing page 1 I down and A description will be given of the address display process of the 9th drawing in the flowchart of the reception display process of 2. The address list display processing performed in step 1 5 is performed in the address list display area. When you have registered 1 mail address list in the address list area, you can also indicate additional mail address registration, 1 mail address registration, delete mail address, and green content display in detail. 9 Receive 1 1 mail list display &gt; Implementation requirements for various processes of itinerary display 〇 In addition, 1 address list display processing can also be performed according to the user's choice. It is executed in step 20 3 (Fig. 17) in the process chart. (| Figures 1 2 _ and 13 are flowcharts of the reception display process. In addition, Figure 1 I] 4 shows that this process is displayed on the screen of the display device 4 2. The edge 1 | f 1 4 illustrates the flow chart of Figure 12 and Figure 13 at the edge of the figure. First, in step 15 of Figure 1 2], use the mouse to perform the operation 1 1 1 to select Figure 1 4 The description of the address list box or the name on the top line of the list 1 1 &gt; Email address and other text display and then 9 Email address in the upper part of the screen chase 1 I plus 9 Email address delete 9 Login email address detailed display &gt; End Equal power 1 1 -2 8- 1 1 1 1 This paper size is applicable to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X 297 mm) A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (&lt;) A picture that can display the required icon. The processing from step 1 5 2 to step 1 5 5 will be stored in R. A Μ 61 shown in the 4th step. The mail address list in the address list area is displayed in the mail address list display box shown in Figure 14. The processing is performed in step 1 5 2 by substituting 1 into the variable η. In step 1 5 3, refer to the stored information. In the address list area of ADD (η), the name and corresponding mail address are displayed in the list.] Column. In step 1. 5 4 the variable η is only incremented by 1. In step 1 5 5, check the borrow step ] 5 Is the number of registered mail addresses displayed in the 3-way address list η more than the number M that can be displayed in one book? If it exceeds Μ, proceed to step 1 5 6. On the other hand, if η does not exceed Μ Then return to step 1 5 3, and repeat the process of displaying the address list to ADD (η). The processing from] 5 6 to 60 is to complete the display screen shown in 1 4 _ and display the mouse cursor. First, in steps 15 6 and 15 7 perform the so-called mailing list display and itinerary display shown on the left side of the address list in Figure 14 to select the functions required by mouse click operation. The drawing of the icon display. Substitute 1 into variable A in step 1 5 8 and perform reverse display in step 1 5 9 Calipering the M A I U A) (i.e. Μ Λ I L U)> lines of display text color and the background color of the color table is displayed in reverse. In addition, you can use diagonal display instead of reverse display in 1 4 _. In step 1 G 0, the mouse cursor is displayed at any position on the display screen. -29- This paper size is in accordance with Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 × 297 mm) (Please read the note on the back before filling this page) L-clothing. '1Τ V. Description of the invention (Step 3) Chapter 1 Go to the slide of A7 B7 mouse, follow the instructions, and click on it. The sum of 31 slides and 63 slides are shown. The 11 is shown. The step of moving the mouse β 1 is from step 3 to slide to distance. If the movement test moves to the false side, the movement of the mouse is whether it slides with the 31 energy rat or 62. 1 check ί. At 1, then] at 6 o'clock. Mouse to rtliitt: bh makes M a $, and "should still be the same." The movement of the cursor on the map is not as fast as the step rtu- to advance 13. &Amp; £ 〇 I} slippery U _ 0 3 ® 2 s The first move without a momentary movement of the mouse is judged to move forward to the front 6 1 The first move is to perform the exercise in an instant, pi Tuka 3 -1 has the first move, the operation is 0, blind and add Fang Shiyi was rejected by another 0 Yes 6 ---------— (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) Steps. When the time comes to watch the prison, the operation will be performed. 0 操 卡 的 无 31 # .Rat if slipped 1 Λ1 into the double figure Figure 2 The first operation Owl 2 Slip to install the test piece and check the post Choose from the 173, 1G L-marked 1G mouse steps from time to time from the time you have shown in Figure 4 1A, as shown in the second example, 6 6 lx step to 4 6 IX Step 0 can be done successfully. The first step is to set the list of th position C, the address of the postal address, 42 pieces of postal display, and the order is set to show the economy. The Ministry of Standards and Staff ’s Consumer Cooperatives printed the mouse slide check position, while drawing 4, drawing Π 1 shows a step-by-step operation when the mouse cursor slides on the cursor. 力 力 被 5/1 件The cursor moves with the mouse as if the other mouse slides, and the 67 square Ϊ steps from 50 to 61r. When he steps to the position, he adjusts it, and then the logarithm of the queue in the table is changed by the logarithm. Enter the position of the display value, so η} 游) in the tour η) Mouse D Slide An / V Yue Shou y / 1 S Take the 1fi position of the ketone number 丨 the postal paper size should be in accordance with the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (2 丨 0 '乂 297 mm) A7 B7 Employees of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Cooperative cooperative printing V. Description of the invention (· &gt; 9) 1 1 A Then in step 1 G 6, reverse the display of the ADD (A) to the strain number A while displaying the text and background color of the line 1 &gt; and The other reversed display lines return to 1 1 to the normal display. ^ -V. Please 1 first 1 in step 16 7, check the mouse 3 1 when the mouse is clicked.% 1 1 Display of the cursor Whether the position is at the back of the left part of the display screen on the 14th display 1 I 1 2 锢 Any position in the icon display. As a result, if the mouse is used to notice 1 I, the matter 1 lies in the factory received mail J _ Fu Zhi Position, the steps 1 to 8 are performed. 2. The reception display process described in item I. &gt; Then, .w., 刖Go to step 1 7 0. Here, if the cursor for the mouse is located at a different position from the two icons, the page will move to step 1 without moving to step 1 7 00. Details of the stroke display processing 1 1 will be later No. 4. Item description. 1 1 In step 17, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the mouse 1 at the time of the operation 1 is used to display the cursor, and the position is at the top of the picture. At that time, the address addition processing of step 1 7 1 is performed 1 1 and then 9 proceeds to step 17 2 0. In addition, if the mouse cursor position 1 I is in other positions, 9 will still be f-m * Μ. Proceed to step 1720. The details of the 11 additional address processing will be described in item 9 .. T In step 172, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the mouse will be used for 1 | cursor. When the position of the dealer is displayed in the upper part of the display screen of Figure 14, "Detailed j 1 1 display part, the address detailed display processing 1 1 of step 17 3 is implemented, and then proceed to step 1 7 4 〇 Another-- On the other hand, if the mouse is displayed at 1 | in other positions, it will continue to move to step 1740. Position 1 1 The details of the detailed display processing will be described in the next 1 item. 1 I The processing from step 1 7 4 to step 1 7 7 is to delete the registered it »1 of the file address I -3 1-1 1 1 1 This Paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (2 丨 OX 297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of invention (W) processing. In step 1 7 4 if Mole 3 is slipped when it is clicked When the mouse cursor is used to display the book and the position is on the 14th display, and the upper part is the "Delete" display part, proceed to step 17.5. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is at another position, proceed to Steps 1 7 8. In step 1 7 5 from R. A M fi] delete the contents of the ADDU displayed by step 1 (the processing of 5 6 is reversed) (the contents of the billions shown in 4 (C) _). In step 176, the contents of the received mail stored in the address list area of R. A Μ 61 shown in Fig. 4 (b) will be deleted after the ADD (A) number The processing is sequentially performed one by one. Then, in step 177, the displayed picture is eliminated, and then it is necessary to display the updated content of the billion, and then return to step 3 5] (Figure 12). (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page.) Display the table h H = r- if the trb is trr: 9 7 ii step i 8 7 1 ο In the slide, the 17th step is set when the position is set. When the mouse is slided, the step is performed on the quilt and the display is displayed on the other side. The step is 9 Break 7 _, 1 &quot;. Step by step, then put him in the front position at that time, and then use the mouse J to slide the beam in the ministry's standard show, such as the fake printing of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Central Standards Bureau Consumer Consumption Cooperative. Step 〇 Go back to the supervisor to make it, and the situation is meaningless. _31 The squirrel and rattle go repeatedly, and then go to the figure of the test and inspection institute. Address 9, 17 times This step is shown at the end of the picture. There are 311 logically displayed. The address is deducted from the clear Mu logically and displayed. 1 Λ1 4 Among the steps _ Chengliu's rationale The display of the letter of acceptance 2 stated that the following paper standards will apply Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 Specifications (210X29 &quot; / mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Central Consumers Bureau of the Ministry of Economy. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the V. Invention Description (&gt; t 1) 1 1 (Figure 9) and the process of displaying the address list of items Step 1 1 I Step 1 0 9 (Fig. 1a) The stroke display processing performed. 1 1 Itinerary display processing is shown in Figure 5 every month, as shown in Figure 5. ^ Please 1 1 First 1 RA Mfi At the same time as the registered itinerary in the itinerary area, the number can indicate to read 1 I request Itinerary registration is required. S Itinerary registration details are displayed, 1 1 is displayed on the back of last month, 1 month is displayed on the itinerary, and the mail list is displayed. Note 1 I 1 Address list is displayed. Item 1 U Picture 1 5 &gt; Picture 1 6 Picture 9 Picture 1 7 _ and Picture 18 are filling out the flowchart of the reception display process. In addition, Picture 19 shows the display on the display device 4 by this process. Page 2 ----- | On the other hand, I will explain the flow chart of Figure 15 and 16 圔 S 1 | Figure 17 »and Figure 18 with reference to Figure 19 ^ 1 1 First, the processing from step 18 1 to step 187 in FIG. 1 is to display the first order 1 1 1 9 The figure shows that the B has a • fnr m schedule (hereinafter referred to as the schedule calendar) &gt; and The icons around it are displayed. 1 1 First> Clear the currently displayed picture in step 1 8 i in Fig. 15 and 1 I then 9 in step 1 8 2 to execute the fi S drawing of the date frame in Fig. 19, 1 1 or B The so-called text display such as &quot; year &quot; or &quot; month &quot; in the upper part of the calendar frame, and then, draw ί:! _ While the upper part of the itinerary registration itinerary is displayed in detail, and the upward stroke of the month is displayed 1 I &gt; the next month's itinerary The display of the so-called W symbol display required to select a function for the click operation of the mouse, such as the end of the display, is shown in step 18 3, i I V. line 1 9 _ stroke R 暦 之左 御Receiving mail display and address 1 I list display graphical display. 1 1 In step J 8 4, the flow of basic processing of item 1 is shown in step 1 I 1 Π 1 (Figure 7). The current year and month obtained by the time measurement processing is set to 1 I -3 3-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (>>) Set the date and month, and store it in the register or RAM61 in the CPU51. In step] .8 5, the specified year and month are displayed in the year and month display part on the upper part of the date frame in Figure 19, and secondly, in step 186, the month and day of the specified year and month are respectively corresponding to one in the sun chip frame. The day of the week is displayed. In step 187, the inverted display of the current date display column is displayed as the inverted display of the text display color and the background color of the column. In addition, diagonal lines are also displayed in Figure 19 to replace the reverse display. From step 8 to step 1 6 _ step 1 9 3 is a process of applying a reservation mark to indicate that an itinerary is registered in the date column of the itinerary of Fig. 19. First, in step 18.8, in the stroke plaque area in RAM 61 shown in FIG. 5, the index B is set at the beginning of the area where the stroke data of the month corresponding to the specified year and month is stored. Move to the G diagram and substitute 1 into the variable η in step 189. In step 190, in the travel area shown in the fifth drawing, check whether the travel data is stored in the n-day area in Μ0 NT fi (B). If there is storage, proceed to step 191, In the upper left corner of the due date column on the itinerary of the trip shown in Figure 19, the reservation mark Γ R "is displayed) to indicate that there is a registered trip in the R, and then proceed to step 192. At step 1 9 2 Make the variable η enter only 1. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (read the precautions on the back and then fill out this page). In step 1 3, check whether η is more than Μ Ο Μ Τ Η (Β ) On the last day, if it exceeds, proceed to step 194. On the other hand, if the η value does not exceed the last day of Μ Ν Τ Η (Β), return to step 190, and repeat the reservation mark Display processing. In step 194, the travel date shown in Figure 9 is at the beginning of the month (1st) -3 4-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 × 297 mm) A7 B7 Central Ministry of Economic Affairs Printed by the Consumer Bureau of Standards Bureau V. Invention Description () 1 1 1 column Change it to display a different color from the other listeners. In addition, in Figure 1 1 I, the display color of the beginning of the month column is displayed in a mesh, and its color is different from the other columns. 1 1 From step 19 6 to step 1 98 The processing is used to perform the movement display of the cursor used by the mouse according to the 31 operation of the mouse 31, and the operation of the 31 mouse 31. Read 1 Back 1 Test 0 Side 1 Note I In step 19 6 Check whether the mouse 3 1 is moved. For example, if the movement of mouse 1 is detected, it is in step 197. You can move the mouse cursor by 1 / corresponding to the moving direction of the mouse, and then move to step 1 980 In another script V, if the movement of the mouse 3 1 is not detected, the page will remain motionless without any movement '—- 1 V /, go to step 198. 1 I In step 198, judge the mouse 3 1. Whether click operation is added, if there is 1 1 click operation, proceed to step 1 99 ( (Figure 1 7). On the other hand, if the order is false and there is no operation, 9 returns to step 196, and the monitoring of the operation status of the mouse 3 1 1 I is repeated. 0 1 1 moves to the 17th figure 9 from The processing from step 1 9 to step 2 1 2 is from the detection of the mouse cursor position when the mouse is clicked, and the selection of various functions of the email device 21A 1 is performed. 0 V First, from step 1 9 The process from 9 to step 2 G 1 is to set the date to be processed in the displayed itinerary 1 I (歴). 1 * I In step 199, check the mouse 3 1 When the mouse is clicked, the mouse is drawn up with the display of the 1 L cursor &gt; If the mouse cursor is on the travel date, 1 I will go forward Go to step 2 (100)-If the cursor for mouse exists at other positions, proceed to step 2 2 e 1 1 At step 2 0, obtain the position with the position of the cursor for mouse The corresponding column is 1 I _ 2 5- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (h ^ r) 1 1 period, substitute the date into indicator A, and then in step 2 Q 1 change the interesting side of phase B corresponding to indicator A 1 1 • fa »to the same as the beginning of the month used in step 1 9 4 1 While changing the color of the column 1 », and restore the other date columns that were changed by the color / ... —v Please! First restore the color 〇 Read ft 1 1 In step 20 2, check Mouse 3 1 When the mouse click is applied, the back of the mouse 1 I 1 The cursor is displayed on the left side of the 19th display screen 2 Note 1 # 1 0 0 in the icon display position If the cursor for the mouse is at the position where the item 1 is in the address of the factory address list J, perform 3 items in step 203. Write the address list display processing described in this document, and then proceed to Step 2 0 5 〇 Page 1 I In addition, 9 If the cursor is at "the position of the J icon of the received mail 1 1 &gt; In step 2 0 4 the reception display process described in item 2 is performed, and then 1 1 Go to step 20 5 〇 In addition, if the mouse cursor is located at a different position from the two 1 tags, 9 will be connected without movement and proceed to step 1 20 5 〇 I at step 20 5, if Mouse 3] When the mouse click is applied, the mouse uses the 1 I cursor to display the picture and the position is When the factory display 1 in the upper part of the picture 19 is displayed, and the part displayed by J is recorded &gt; I of step 2 of the registration process of step 2 is performed. Then proceed to step 20 7〇 In addition, if the mouse cursor is used In 1 | other positions, proceed directly to step 2 0 7 without any action. For the first step »The details of the registration process will be described later in 11. 1 Step 2 (1 7) If the mouse 3 1 is displayed with the mouse 1 1 cursor, and the position is in the upper part of the display screen of Fig. 19, the 1 part of the factory detail J is displayed. * Just execute step 2 0 8 of the trip details 1 I After displaying the process 1 Proceed to step 2 9 (Figure 18). On the other hand, leave 1 1-? 6- (continued on page 3 8) 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210 X 297 mm). Printed by the Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. A7 B7. 5. Description of the invention (4) If the mouse cursor is in other positions, it is not necessary. Directly move to step 2 β 9 (Figure 8) without action. The details of the detailed display and processing of the trip will be described later. 1. Description. Move to step 8 in step 2 0 9, if the mouse 3 1 When the mouse is pressed, the cursor is used to display the picture and the position is the part of the "last month" displayed on the upper part of the 19th picture display screen. Go back to step 1 8 5 (Figure 15). On the other hand, false When the mouse cursor is in other positions, it moves directly to step 2 1 without any action. The details of the display processing involved in the previous month will be described later in 1 4. In step 2 Π, if the mouse 3] is When the click is applied, when the mouse cursor is used to display the book and the position is in the part shown in Figure 19 and the "Next Month" display in the upper part, go to step 2 1 2 and display the previous month. Go to step 18.5 (Fig. 15). On the other hand, if the mouse is in another position, it will move forward to step 2 1 3 without further action. The details of the display processing next month will be 14. Description later. The processing from step 2 to step 3 to step 2] 4 is the end-of-stroke display processor. In step 2 1 3, if the mouse: Π is clicked when the mouse click operation is performed, the cursor is used to display the picture. And the position is in the picture shown in Figure 19 and the "End..I" part of the upper part is displayed, then proceed to step 2 1 4. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is at another position, it is judged to be in step 1 9 8 (Fig. 16) This time the mouse cursor is meaningless, so it returns to step ] S (5 (the first β _), monitor the operation status of the mouse 3 1 in the electrical complex. In step 2 1 4, clear all the pictures displayed in the stroke display process, and -3 8-(continued from the third 6 pages) This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 × 297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) Order printed by the Consumers Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of the invention () End the reception display process. 5. Mail making process The mail making process performed in step 137 in the flowchart of the reception display process of 2. (Fig. 9) will be described below. The mail creation process is a process of creating a normal mail and sending a letter. Figures 20 and 21_ show the flow of mail creation processing. Fig. 22 shows a screen displayed on the display device 42 by such processing. The flowcharts of Figures 20 and 21 will be described below with reference to Figure 22. The process from step 2 2 1 to step 2 2 2 is the process of making the screen display of 2 2 _. First, in step 221, the display frame drawing of each block of the mail creation screen shown in FIG. 22 and so-called characters such as the recipient, file name, sending, cancellation, and address designation are displayed. In step 2 2 2, a cursor for the character indicating the position of the character input is displayed in the recipient input area (the recipient block of the 22nd). In steps 2 2 3, in the columns corresponding to the processing surface of the mail creation process shown in FIG. 22, respectively, the mail received in the mail preparation area stored in the RAM 61 shown in FIG. 2 (a) is received. Individual information such as person, file name, and text are displayed in 7K. At step 2 2 4, the cursor for the mouse is displayed at any position on the display screen. The processing from step 2 2 5 to step 2 3 7 of the figure 2 is the operation of the mouse 3 1, the movement of the cursor with the text, the designation of the address list input from the recipient, and the sending of the mail , Or each of the cancellation (suspend) made by mail-3 9-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page)

經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(以) 種處理;加以選擇而實行之。 在步驟2 2 5 ,檢查滑鼠3 1是否已經移動,假如檢測到 滑鼠移動時,就在步驟2 2 6 ,能與滑鼠之移動方向、移 動距離對應般使滑鼠用游標移動,而前進到步驟2 2 7。 另一方而,假如未檢測到滑鼠3〗之移動時,就毫無作動 地直接前進到步驟2 2 7。 在步驟2 2 7 ,檢杳滑鼠31是否被施加喀_操作,有喀 嚒橾作時就前進到步驟2 2 8 ,並無喀櫪操作時就前進到 步驟2 3 8 在步驟2 2 8,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒操作時之滑鼠用 游標顯示畫面位置是在於第22圖顯示畫面的文字輸入區 域(第2 2圖之收件人、件名、本文之各櫥)時,就前進到 步驟2 2 9 ,使文字用游標移動到滑鼠用游標目前所位置 之區域,而前進到步驟2 3 G (第2 1圏)。另一方面,假如 滑鼠用游標在其他位置時,就毫無作動地直接前進到步 驟 2 3 0 (第 2 1 _ )。 移到第2 1圖,在步驟2 3 G ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀曠操 作時之滑鼠用游標之顯示畫而位置在於第22圖顯示畫面 右部之「發信」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 3 1,另 一方而,假如滑鼠用游標在其他之位置時就前進到步驟 2 3 3 〇 在步驟2 31,除了被顯示在第2 2圖所示之顯示畫面之 收件人、件名、本文外,將電子郵件(收納有電子郵件 裝置2 ] A之使用者之郵件位址作為發信人)從通信控制部 -4 0 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) ----^-------------訂 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 B7 五、發明説明(巧) 2 fi經由L A N 5發信到電子郵件服務部1 1 A。另外,使用者 之郵件位址是由使用者從鍵盤32輸入,被預先收纳在 R. A Μ 6丨的其他區域。 在步驟2 3 2,消除藉由郵件製成處理之所有顯示畫面 ,結束此次之郵件製成處理,然後回到收信顯示處理。 在步驟2 3 3 ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒橾作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫面位置是在於第22圖.顯示畫面右上部之 「取消」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 3 4,另一方面 ,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就前進到步驟2 3 6。 在步驟2 3 4 ,消除郵件製成區域之記億内容,接著在 步驟2 3 5 ,消除藉由郵件製成處理之所有顯示畫面,結 束此次之郵件製成處理,然後回到收信顯示處理。 在步驟2 3 C5 ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示棗而位置是在於第22圖顯示書面右上部之 「位址指定」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 3 7 ,俟實 行位址指定處理之後,回到步驟2 2 3 (第2 0圖)。另一方 (請先鬩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 假 第 圖 2 __. 2il 驟回 步而 在, 為義 斷意 判無 就並 ,嚒 時喀 置.鼠 位滑 他之 其次 在此 標的 游到 用測 鼠檢 滑所 如丨 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製Printed by the Employees' Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of invention (in) Treatment; Select to implement. In step 2 2 5, check whether the mouse 3 1 has moved. If the mouse movement is detected, then in step 2 2 6, the mouse can be moved with the cursor corresponding to the movement direction and distance of the mouse, and Proceed to step 2 2 7. On the other hand, if the movement of mouse 3 is not detected, it proceeds to step 2 2 7 without any action. In step 2 2 7, check whether the mouse 31 has been clicked. If there is a click, proceed to step 2 2 8. If there is no click, proceed to step 2 3 8 in step 2 2 8 If the position of the mouse cursor display screen when the mouse 31 is clicked is in the text input area of the display screen in Figure 22 (recipients, file names, and cabinets in Figure 22), Proceed to step 2 2 9 to move the cursor for text to the area where the cursor for the mouse is currently located, and proceed to step 2 3 G (21st). On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is in another position, it moves directly to step 2 3 0 (No. 2 1 _) without any action. Move to Figure 21, in step 2 3 G, if mouse 3 1 is used to display the cursor when the mouse cursor is applied, and the position is the part of the "Send" display on the right of the display screen in Figure 22 For the copy, proceed to step 2 3 1 and the other side, if the mouse cursor is at other positions, proceed to step 2 3 3 〇 At step 2 31, except for the display shown in Figure 2 2 The recipient of the screen, the name of the screen, and the content of the text, the email address of the user who contains the email device 2] A as the sender is from the Communication Control Department-40-This paper standard applies Chinese national standards ( CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) ---- ^ ------------- Order (please read the notes on the back before filling this page) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (clever) 2 fi sends a letter to the email service department 1 1 A via LAN 5. In addition, the user's e-mail address is entered by the user from the keyboard 32 and is stored in advance in other areas of R. AM 6 丨. In step 2 3 2, all the display screens processed by the mail creation process are eliminated, the mail creation process is ended, and the process returns to the reception display process. In step 2 3 3, if the position of the display screen of the mouse cursor when the mouse 31 is clicked is shown in Fig. 22, when the "Cancel" part of the upper right of the display screen is displayed, proceed to Steps 2 3 4 and on the other hand, if the mouse is in another position, proceed to step 2 3 6. In step 2 3 4, delete the contents of the mail creation area, and then in step 2 3 5, delete all the display screens processed by mail creation, end the mail creation process, and then return to the display of the message. deal with. In step 2 3 C5, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the mouse cursor is used to display the date and the position is in the part of the "address designation" displayed on the upper right of the display in Figure 22, and then go forward. Go to step 2 3 7. After performing the address designation process, return to step 2 2 3 (Fig. 20). The other party (please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) False Figure 2 __. 2il step back in time, for the sake of righteousness judgments, and immediately put it on hold. The next to the mouse is here The target swimming test station is printed by the labor consumption cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs.

進 複 I S 面 後 於 將 節 ),細 圖之 20理 第處 5 定 22指 驟址 步位 步 在 圖 ο 2 第 到 回 鼠 滑 第 盤 鍵 自 來 0 是 11 理 處 之 之 _ 於 至 0 視 監 之 作。 操述 的描 到 8 3 2 ο 驟件 步郵 從成 ,製 後而 之入 丨輸 之 就步 時到 入回 輸就 有時 如入 假輸 ,無 入並 輸如 之假 2 3 , 盤而 鍵方 對一 測另 檢 , 9 ί 3 8 2 3 2 驟 驟步 步到 在進 前 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) 五、發明説明(4 ) A7 B7 顯 在 示 .顯 字 文 。之 視應 監對 之入 作輸 操之 J 2 ^ 3 3 盤 鼠鍵 滑與 行將 進’ 複 3 8 2 章.驟 5 步· 2 2 在 驟 料過 資加 字施 文已 將應 ,對 ο /IV 24域 驟區 步之 在域 著區 接成 ,製 上件 BUM. 撟 .¾ 之之 標lii 游a) _ /1¾. 用 2 字第 文在 有納 示收 驟 步 到 回理 而處 &gt; 成 M)·製 欄件 示程 字彳 文 6 ml-- 理 處 示 顯 信 收 之 第 trr: 理 處 成 製 件 郵 程 行 之 2 行 明實 將丨 而 下 圖 驟 步 之 中 圖 程 流 處 成 製 件 郵 S3 程 一了 外 另 ο 圔 C程 者流 理之 處理 之處 信成 發製 以件 予郵 而程 件行 郵是 程圖 行24 成第 製和 以 _ ! 3 用 2 是第 flE 理 面明 下説 〇以 面加 畫圖 之程 2 4 流 置之 裝圖 示24 顯第 在和 示圖 顯23 理第 處將 該邊 藉圖 5 示 2 表第 圖照 25参 第邊 ,將 驗 步 在 先 首 第 除 清 先 前 理 處 之 後 以 1T 進 在 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)After the IS face is restored, I will be at the knot section), the 20th place of the detailed picture, the 5th place, the 22th step, the step position, and the 2nd step to the back of the mouse. The dial key comes from 0, which is the 11th place. 0 Watch the work. The description of the description is 8 3 2 ο step by step post from success, after the system is entered, when the input is lost, when the input is returned, there is sometimes a false input, if there is no input and lost, it is false 2 3 The key side is tested separately for another test. 9 ί 3 8 2 3 2 Step by step until the paper size is in accordance with the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 × 297 mm) V. Description of the invention (4) A7 B7 Show. Show text. J2 ^ 3 3 with the mouse to enter and lose the way to judge the input of the 2 and 3 of the keyboard and mouse's going forward 3 8 2 chapter. Step 5 step · 2 2 in the material has been added to the text, the text has been answered, right ο / IV 24 steps in the field are connected in the field, and the piece BUM. 挢 .¾ is the standard lii swim a) _ / 1¾. Use the two-character essay to receive the step and return to the receipt. And the process &gt; Cheng M) · The process of displaying the process word 6ml-the first trr of the process to show the message received: The process of the process of the postage line of the process will be clear in the next step. The process flow is made into a piece of postal mail. S3 The process is out of order. 圔 C The process is handled by the letter. The letter is sent to the post and the postal mail is made in the process chart. Use 2 to be the first flE to explain the process. Add the drawing with the face. 2 4 The flow of the installation icon. 24 The first and the second display. 23 The second place is borrowed from Figure 5. The second table is shown in Figure 25. See the side, the test step will be cleared by 1T first after the first step (please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page)

At步 R 勺到 的 2 0 示24者 所驟示 _ 步顯 a)從面 /fv 容 内 域 區 成 製 件 郵 之 之 示 所 圖 5 2 第 成 製 以 用 是 mt 一 理 處 之 3 4 2 驟 0 將 件 收 和 2’繪 4 ί 2 描 驟之 步框 在示 ,顯 先欄 首各 之 面 畫 成 製 件 郵 程 一了 之 示 所 圔 始 開 、 稱 名 議 會 束 結 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 所 等 定 指 址 位 r 消 取 ' 信 發 項 事 記 〇 特示 ,顯 者以 π Π 力 力 參 , 、.字 所文 場謂 第(? 晦 2 IIP第 &gt; 在 ΐ7#] 在收 h被 中 3 示 24顯 驟 , 步欄 之 應成 對製 面件 畫郵 成的 製内 件61 郵AM Tt. 程 行 之 圖 之 示 所 圖 、料 刻資 時種 束各 結等 / 事 刻記 時別 始特 開之 、 關 稱有 名議 議會 會與 r f 人者 信加 收參 件 郵所 之場 域行 區舉 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 , B7 五、發明説明(41 ) 在步驟2 4 4,將用以表示文字輸入位置之文字用游標 顯示在收信人輸入區域(第2 5圔所示之畫面顯示之收信 人攔)。 在步驟2 4 5 ,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上之任意 位置。 從步驟2 4 6到第2 4的步驟2 5 8之處理是根據電子郵件裝 置21A之使用者之選擇,藉由滑鼠81之操作,賁行文字 用游標之移動,來自收信人輸入之位址列表之指定,郵 件發信,或行程郵件製成之取消(中止)等各種處理。 在步驟2 4 6,檢查滑鼠3 1是否已經移動,在檢測到滑 鼠移動時,就在步驟2 4 7能與滑鼠之移動方向、移動距 離對應般使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到步驟2 4 8。另 一方而,假如未檢測到滑鼠3 1之移動時毫就不作動地直 接前進到步驟2 4 8。 在步驟2 4 8 ,檢査在滑鼠3 1有否加有喀曠操作,若有 喀壢操作時就前進到步驟2 4 9,若無喀喔操作時就前進 到步驟2 5 9 (第2 4圖)。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 -.--------ί'ν,'-- (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟249,假如滑鼠31被施加喀喔操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫面位置是在於第25圖顯示畫面文字輸入之 區域(第2 5圖之收信人、會議名稱、開始、結束、場所、 參加者,特別記事等各欄)時,就前進到步驟2 5 Q ,使文 字用游標移動到滑鼠用游標之現在所位置之欄,而前 進到步驟2 5 li另一方而,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置 時就毫不作勳地直接前進到步驟2 5 1。 -43-本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(〇 ) 在步驟251,假如滑鼠31被施加喀喔操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫面位置是在於第25圔顯示畫面右部之「發 信」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 5 2 ,另一方面,假 如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就前進到步驟254(第24圖)。 在步驟252,除了被顯示在第25圔所示之行程郵件製成 畫面之收件、會議名稱、開始、結束、場所、參加者, 特別記事外,亦將行程郵件t收納有電子郵件裝置2 1 A之 使用者的郵件位址作為收信人)從通信控制部26經由LAN 5 發信給電子郵件服務部11A。另外,如上所述,使用者 之郵件位址是由使用者從鍵盤32輸入,預先收納在RAM (Π之其他區域。 在步驟2 5 3 ,消除藉行程郵件製成處理之所有顯示畫 面,而結束此次之行程郵件製成處理,然後回到收信顯 7TC處理。 移到第2 4 在步驟2 5 4,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀喔操 作時之滑鼠用游標之顯示畫面位置是在於第25圔顯示畫 面右上部之「取消」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 5 5 ,另一方面,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時,就前進到 步驟2 5 7。 第步驟2 5 5,消除郵件製成區域之記憶内容,接著在 步驟2 5 6消除藉行程郵件製成處理之所有顯示畫面,結束 此次之行程郵件製成處理,然後回到收信顯示處理。 在步驟2 5 7,假如潜鼠3 1被施加喀壢操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示盡而位置是在第25圖顯示書面右上部之「位 址指定」顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟2 5 8 ,在實行位 -4 4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) —---------Vi (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 五、發明説明 驟 步 到 回 後 之 RE 理 處 定 指 址 A7 B7 而 方 一 另 0 圖 3 2 第 驟 步 為 斷 判 就 時 置 位 他 其 在 標 游 用 鼠 滑 S 一F; 假 圖 第 驟 步 到 回 而 義 意 無 並 0 喀 鼠 滑 之 次 此 之 到 測 檢 定 指 址 位 '•i b 就 0 視 監 之 作 操 的 C 3 述 鼠描 滑· 一17 彳而 隹一 - 複 )«將 _ 節 3 } 2 細 第之 0(理 24處 後ΡΛ, _ 輸 3 . 2 之 第 3 1 盤 25鍵 驟自 步來 在藉 是 驟 步 從 fm - 理 處 之 IX 6 2 驟 〇 步者 u rF 至件 59郵 程 行 成 製 而 2 驟 _ 驟步 2 步到第 在進6{ 前24 如 假 入 輸 之 2 3 盤 建 銨 對 入視 輸監 無之 並作 如操 假31 ,鼠 面滑 方行 一 進 測另複 檢。重 驟 就步 時到 入回 輸就 有時 (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) k. 時 同 的 機 之 標 0,游 C 2 用 驟字 步文 在有 示 盤 鍵 與 將 應 對 入 輸 之 驟 步 在 並 .料 顯資 在字 示文 顯將 字 , 文 6 之 第丨 2 圖 應 2 對第 #6 該24 與驟 在步 fal -πυ .收画 域 區 之 域 區 成 製 件 郵 調 訂 理 處 定 指 址 驟 步 之 中 画 程 流 的 理 處 成 製 件 郢 之 項 « 5 明 說 - 1Χ 將 2 面第 /V 下 7 驟 步 c U 圖 P * 禾 4 \ir 2 圖第 之 中 圖 程 流 的 tn: 理 處 成 製 件 郵 程 I7 /»1 之 項 之 行 實 處 定 指 址 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 列擇 址選 位中 之表 示列 所該 圔從 4 口\ 第 * 在表 憶列 記址 被位 示件 顯郵 是的 理過 處錄 定登 指已 址之 位域 該區 表 2E件 第郵 或子 圔電 22少 第減 在以 納可 收是 址果 位效 件之 郵得 將獲 ,所 人理 信處 收 , 件欄 郵人 之信 成收 製之 所 _ 之 t 位 件 郵 的 象 對 信 發 入 輸 2 3 盤 鍵 從 者 用 使 之。 C度 21程 置雜 裝煩 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(4 ) 第2 fi圖是位址指定處理之流程画。另外,第27圖表示 藉此處理顯示在顯示裝置42之畫面。下面將邊參照第27 圖而邊就第2 fi圖之流程圖加予說明。 首先,第2 (5圖中,在步驟2 7 1實行描繪,乃藉以滑鼠 之喀櫪施行第2 7圖之位址列表框或畫面右上部之取消, 結束等,為功能選擇的顯示。 從步驟2 7 2到步驟2 7 5之處理是將郵件位址到表實際的 顯示在第2 7所示的位址列表欄内。 在步驟2 7 2將1代入到變數η。 在步驟273,參照被收納在第4圖所示之RAM61内的位 址列表區域之ADD (η),而將所對應之姓名和郵件位址顯 示在列表之1列。 在步驟2 7 4使變數τι只進1。 在步驟2 7 5 ,檢查位址列表之顯示位址數τι是否超過 1個畫而可顯示之位址數目Μ,假如η超過Μ時就前進 到步驟2 7 6。另一方面,假如η並未超過Μ時,就回到 步驟2 7 2 ),重複進行位址列表之顯示處理。 從步驟2 7 6到步驟2 9 1之處理是藉由滑鼠3 1之操作,從 列表之郵件位址中選擇郵件發送對象,用來將被選擇之 郵件位址複印到第2 2圖或第2 5圖所示之收信人稱。 在步驟2 7 (5 ,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上之任意 位置。 在步驟2 7 7 ,檢查滑鼠3〗是否已經移動,假如檢測到 滑Ε移動時,就在步驟278能與滑鼠之移動方向、移勳 距離對應般,使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到步驟2 7 9 -4 G - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 (4Γ ) 1 1 〇 另 一 方 面 &gt; 假 如 並 未檢 測到 滑鼠3 1之移動時 就毫不作 1 1 1 動 地 直 接 刖 進 到 步 驟 2 7 9 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 2 7 9, 檢查滑鼠3 1是否加有喀喔操作, 假如有 /-—s 請 1 I 先 1 被 喀 m 橾 作 時 就 刖 進 到步 驟280,另一方面,假如並未 閱 1 | 被 喀 m 操 作 時 就 回 到 步驟 2 7 7, 重複進行滑鼠3 1的操作 背 面 1 I 之 1 之 監 視 〇 注 意 1 1 事 1 在 步 驟 28 〇, 假如滑鼠3 1被喀_操作時之滑鼠用游標 項 再 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 逆 是 在 於第 2 7圖 顯示畫面的郵件 位址列表 寫 w 本 上 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 28 1, 另- -方面,假如猾鼠用游標 頁 1 I 在 其 他 位 置 時 就 前 進 到步 驟28 3〇 1 1 在 步 驟 28 1, 取得與滑鼠用游標位置之顯示行對應之 1 1 郵 件 位 址 號 碼, 而 代 入 變數 A ,接著在步驟2 8 2 , 反轉顯示 1 訂 與 變 數 A 對 應 之 ADD ( A)之 顯示 行文字和背景色 〇 1 在 步 驟 28 3, 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀賴:操作時之滑鼠用 1 1 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 而 位 置 是在 於第 27圖顯7TC畫面右 上部之 1 I 厂 取 消 J 顯 示 之 部 份 時, 就前 進到步驟2 8 4 ,用來消除 1 μ 第 27 圖 所 示 之 所 有 顯 示畫 而, 以結束此次之位 址指定處 i 1 理 回 到 原 來 之 郵 件 製成 處理 或行程郵件製成 處理。在 1 I 該 步 驟 當 結 束 位 址 指 定處 理之 場合就不施行對 郵件位址 1 1, 之 收 信 人 欄 的 複 印 Ο 另一 方面 ,假如滑鼠用游 標在其他 1 1 * 位 址 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 2 8 5 〇 1 I 在 步 驟 28 5, 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 1 1 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 面 位 置 是在 於第 27圖顯7K畫而右 上部之 1 I 厂 結 束 J 顯 示 之 部 份 時, 就則 進到步驟2 8 6。另一方面 1 1 1 -4 7 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS〉A4規格(210'〆297公釐) 五、發明説明(4 A7 B7 驟驟 步步 在到 為回 斷而 判 , 就義 ,意 時無 置並 位 _ 他喀 其鼠 在滑 標之 游次 用此 鼠的 滑到 如測 假檢 ,所 滑 J7, 行2828 進驟驟 複步步 重在在 視 監 之 作 橾 的 LL 位 件 .郵 的 面 畫 示 顯 之 η 示 數所 變圖 人27 代.第 }W 將藉 顯 轉 反 被 否 是 行 示 〇〇 顯28 之驟 η 步 /1- D 在 AD就 杳時 檢示 ,顯 表轉 列反 第 納 收 在 被 是 如 假 示 件 郵 之 示 所 圔 0 毫 址就 位 , 件時 郵示 之顯 η)轉 D(反 AD被 納未 收行 ,示 域顯 區之 之η) /V 人 D 信AD 收如 之假 内 , 域而 區方 成一 製另 驟 步 至 進 前 接9, -. 8 首 2 地驟 動 步 作在 不 數 變 使 進 只 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) ο 的 9 庚 2 穿 驟列 步址 在位 之 奄 檢 示時 所 Ν 画過 27超 第 η 在如 示假 顯 , 被&lt; 過 超 否 是 俏 巨 數 址 位 之 面 畫 値 回印 就複 時的 fc N h. 過位 超件 未郵 η 之 如表 假列 ,址 商位 方自 一 來 另行 C 進 9]複 2 Β 驟窜 步 7 到28 進驟 前步 就到 處{F 複 , 電合 。 此場度 以的稈 ί錯件雜 ο 郵煩 理一之 處同入 ΤΤΜ— 理 輸 送社 發位 而件 人郵 信輕 收減 數可 多亦 定丨 設 使 即 件 郵 報 同 謂 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 在位 Μ 次 件 CC. 而 畫 示 顯 有 所 之 示 所 圖 7 2 第 除 消 此 束 結 郵 Λ3 程 一了 Λ1 或 fm- S 處 成 製 件 郢 之 來 原 ΠΜ- 至 回 而 理 1,處 C 29定理 驟指處 步址成 HE 理 處 封 開 驟信 步收 中將 圖是 程理 流處 之封 理開 處該 示 C 顯理 倍處 收封 之開 項之 .行 U實: 擬圖 Π , ii 而第 i3/V 默 4 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(47 ) 顯示處理所選擇的郵件之本文,顯示在顯示裝置42之處 理者。 第28圖是開封處理之流程画。另外,第29圖和第30圖 表示藉該處理顯示於顯示裝置42之畫面。在此,第29圖 是通常郵件之開封畫面顯示,而且,第3 0圖是行程郵件 之開封書面顯示。下面將同時參照第3 9圖和第3 0圖用來 說明第28圖之流程_。 首先,從步驟3 01到步驟3 (1 3之處理為,用於識別所顯 示之郵件究竟是通常郵件或是行程郵件,而施加因應之 _面顯示者。 首先,步驟3 1)1就在收信顯示處理中,在實行此次之 開封處理前檢査被反轉顯示之Μ AI L ( A )所具有之旗標S C F ,假如S C F為” 1 ”,亦卽表示M A I L ( A )為行程郵件時,就 前進到步驟3 0 2,施行第3 0圖所示之行程郵件用之顯示 框或會議名稱、時間、場所、參加者、特記事項等文字, (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) k. 訂 需 所 束 結 I 理 處 封 開 擇 選 4 為30 嚒驟 喀步 鼠到 潸進 之前 部而 上 , 右畫 面描 畫等 由示 0 顯 或的 如 假 而 方 1 另 驟 步 到 進 前 就 時 il •ILL τη' 常 通 之 示 所 圖 9 2 第 一7 /Ji 施 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 右畫 面描 畫等 由示 藉顯 或的 ,需 字所 文束 等結 名理 件處 、封 人開 出擇 寄選 或為 框* 示喀 顯鼠 之滑 用之 件部 郵上 郵 示 表 和 示 顯 之 件 郵 倍 一1 /11 進 是 5 Q 3 0 驟 4 . Π 步 3 二 步30 到驟 進步 前從 而 理之 處内 之61 作AM ί 操 的 標4’ 旗 3 之驟 封步 開在 件 將 別 分 料 資 各 之 納 收 所 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 Μ Β7 五、發明説明(4/ ) 顯示在第2 9圖或第30圖所對應之欄。 在步驟3 0 5 ,將”1 ”代入到M A I L ( A )之旗標K A I F ϋ ,用來 表示Μ A Τ L ( A )進行過至少1次以上之開封處理。 從步驟3 0 到步驟3 1 1之處理是藉由滑鼠3 1之操作,使 其選擇郵件開封處理之結束者^ 首先,在步驟3 f) ,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上 之任意位置。 在步驟3 (Π,檢査滑鼠31是否已被移動,假如檢測到 有滑鼠之移動時,就在步驟3 0 8能與滑鼠之移動方向、 移動距離對應般,俾使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到步 驟3 Q 9。另一方而,例如未檢測到滑鼠3 1之移動時,就毫 不作動地直接前進到步驟3 0 9。 在步驟3 (1 9 ,檢査滑鼠3 1是否被施加喀操作,當被 喀晞操作時就前進到步驟3 1 G ,當未被喀_操作時就回 到步驟3 0 7 ,重複進行滑鼠3 1的橾作狀況之監視。 在步驟3 1 Π ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之猾鼠用 游檫之顯示書而位置是在第29圖或第30圖之顯示畫而 右上部之「結束j顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟3 1 1。 另一方而,假如滑E用游標在其他之位置時就回到步驟 3 0 7 ,重複進行潸鼠3 1的操作狀況之監視。 在步驟3 1 1,消除藉開封處理之所有畫面顯示,結束 此次之開封處理,回到收信顯示處理。 9 .位址追加處理 繼而,擬説明3 .項之位址列表顯示處理之流程圖中 -5 0 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) —.11 — - 1 I I n - I - I ~~ 訂 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 明説 明發五 加 迫 址 位 該 ο m: 理 處 加 追 址 位 之 1Ί //1 實 所 址 位 件 郵 錄 登 加 追 域 區 表 列 址 位 之 示 C 所者 圖圖納 134 收 第第以 U在加 17是而 驟理料 步處資 示參 表時 fii同 32將 第商 , 下 外 〇 另而 〇 畫 圖之 2 程 4 流置 之裝 理示 處顯 加在 追示 址 顯 位而 是理 _ 處 3 該 第由 藉 圖 程 流 之 圖 ϋ· 3 第 明 説 來 1 用32 圖驟 32步 第在 照 在 納 收 料 資 址 位 件 郵 的 新 將 可 否 有 査 檢 之 驟驟 步步 -Hu du 至 至 進進 前前 就就 時時 足留 不殘 示域域 所區區 圖白白 4 空空 第如有 假如 ,假 域 , 區面 白方 空一 之另 域 C 區22 2J 表 列 址 位 的 内 示 顯 告 警 行 進 間 時 定 1 以 2 4 置 裝 示 顯 在 料 資 址 位 件 郵 的 新 納 收 再 能 不 域 區 表 列 址 2’位 32在 驟示 步表 在來 用 示為 顯定 表設 列應 址但 位 到定 回設 ,意 理任 處可 D 隹 力 皆 追間 址時 位示 之顯 次之 此示 束顯 結告 ,警 後 C 然理 ,處 度驟 長步 分在 充 意 ΐ » VI 起 喚 便 以 名 姓 或 繪 描 之 框 的 欄 各 之 圖 2 3 第 加 施 登示 之顯 部的 下擇 右選 面能 畫功 及為 以而 ,作 示操 顯嚅 之喀 字鼠 文滑 謂以 所藉 等謂 式所 型等 、消 址取 位 、錄 ---------c^.— (請先鬩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 驟 步 到 之 2 3 盤 鍵 和 〇 31者 鼠錄 滑登 由和 藉入 是輸 理之 處料 之資 7 t 3 h 3J 位 件 郵 一了 二 驟來 步用 從作 操 中 域 區 入 輸 名 姓 在 標 游 用 字 文 的 置 位 入 2 i 3 輸 驟字 步文 示 標 游 用 鼠 滑 示 顯 置 位 J 意32 仟驟 之步 上 在 而 滑 杳: 檢 表畫 示 示 顯顯们在 # 名 5 姓32 圖驟 2 . 3 漆 第在 到 測 檢 如 假, 61^. 33 移 被 已 否 是 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( r。 ) 1 1 有 溃 之 移 動 時 ,就 在 步 驟 3 2 7 ,能與滑鼠 之移動 方 向 1 1 移 動 m 離 對 陣 巧CJi' 般, 俾 使 滑 鼠用游標移動, 然後, 前進 1 1 到 步 驟 3 2 8 , 另- -方商, 假如未檢測到滑鼠 3 1之移 動 時 /·—V 請 1 先 1 , 就 毫 不 作 動 地 宦接 A./» 刖 進 到 步驟3 2 8。 閎 讀 1 1 在 步 驟 32 8 , 檢査滑鼠3 1是否被施加喀賴 操作, 若 有 背 &amp; I I 之 I 1 喀 喔 操 作 時 就 刖 進到 步 驟 3 2 9 ,另一方面, 若無喀 喔 操 注 意 1 I 作 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟33 6〇 事 項 再 1 1 在 步 驟 3 2 9 , 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀操作 時之滑 鼠 用 填 寫 本 / 一 | 游 標 之 顯 示 畫 面 位置 是 在 第 3 2圖顯示畫面的各輸入欄時 頁 I 9 就 刖 進 到 步 驟 3 3 0 , 使文字游標移動到滑 鼠用游 檫 所 1 1 位 置 之 欄 &gt; 妷 後 m 到 步 驟 3 3 1。另一方而 ,假如 滑 鼠 1 用 游 標 在 其 他 位 置時 就 毫 不 作動地直接前進到步驟3 3 1 〇 1 訂 在 步 驟 331 -&gt; 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作 時之滑 鼠 用 1 游 標 之 顯 示 m 面 位置 是 在 第 3 2_顯示畫面右下部之 「取消」 1 1 顯 示 之 部 份 時 &gt; 就前 進 到 步 驟332,另一方 面,假 如 滑鼠 /. 1 | 用 游 標 在 其 他 位 置時 就 Α Υ·_ 刖 進 到步驟3 3 3。 I 1 在 步 驟 3 3 2 , 消除藉位址追加處理之所有 畫商顯 示 &gt; 1 結 束 此 次 之 位 址 迫加 處 理 ♦ 回到位址列表顯示處理。 1 I 在 步 驟 3 3 3 , 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀壢橾作 時之滑 鼠 用 1 1 游 標 之 顯 示 蛋 而 位置 是 在 第 32圖顯示畫而右下部之 「登 1 錄 J 顯 示 之 部 份 時, 就 ·&gt; J. 刖 進 到步驟3 3 4。另 一方面 9 假 1 I 如 滑 鼠 用 游 標 在 其他 位 置 時 ,就判斷為步驟3 2 8所 撿 測 1 1 到 之 此 次 滑 m 喀 無 思 義 ,而回到步驟3 2 6,電 複 進 1 I 行 滑 鼠 3 1 的 橾 作 狀況 之 監 視 〇 1 1 I -f) 2- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(θ ) 在步驟334,將被顯示在第32圖之顯示畫面之各欄之 姓名、郵件位址、郵件型式等各資料收納在第4圏之位 址列表區域的空白區域,其次,在步驟3 3 5消除藉位址 谄加處理之所有棗面顯示,結束此次之位址追加處理, 回到位址列表顯示處理。 另一方面,在繼步驟3 2 8後之步驟3 3 6,檢測對鍵盤3 2 之輸入,假如有輸入時就前進到步驟3 3 7,另一方面, 假如並無輪入時就回到步驟3 2 6 ,重複進行滑鼠3 1的操 作之監視。 在步驟3 37 ,將與鍵盤3 2之輸入對應之文字顯示在文 字用游檫被顯示之欄,接箸回到步驟3 2 6 ,重複進行滑 鼠3 1的操作之監視。 10.位址詳細顯τρί處理 下而將說明3 .項之位址列表列顯示處理之流程画中 步驟1 7 3 (第1 3圖)所實行之位址詳細顯示處理。位址詳 細顯示處理是用來顯示被登錄在第4圖所示之位址列表 區域之郵件位址之各資料的細節之處理。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (讀先鬩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 第3 3圖是位址詳細顯示處理之流程_。另外,第34圖 表示藉該處理顯示在顯示裝置42之書而。下而將同時參 照第:Η圖用來說明第3 3之流程圖 在步驟3 4 1 ,施行第3 4圖所示之各顯示框或姓名、位 址、型式等文字,或藉由畫面右下部之滑鼠喀嚒而為選 擇位址詳細顯示處理結束的顯示等描畫。 在步驟3 4 2 ,將R A Μ 6 1之位址列表區域内之A D I) ( A )所收 -5 3 — 本纸張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 五、發明説明(^ ) A7 B7 使 ο , 欄作 之操 應之 對 3 所鼠 面滑 書由 0 示藉者 所是束 圖理結 34處之 第之理 在48處 示驟.示 0,^0 別;細 分:^詳 料 cc 址 資驟位 各步擇 之從選 納能 鼠 滑 示 顯. 置 位 意 任 之 上 面 棗 示 顯 在. 中 3 4 3 驟 步 , C 先標 首游 用 時般 4 動應 34移對 驟之離 步鼠距 在滑動 有移 滑 查 檢 驟鼠 步滑 在使 就俥 πυ 至 / 測向 檢方 如動 假移 ,之 動鼠 移 滑 被與 已能 否45 是; 步 Ηυ 妾 進 前 後 然 移 標 游 用 另 直 地 動 60作 34不 驟毫 方 就 時 els^ 33 移 之 1± 3 鼠 滑 到 測 檢 未 如 假 驟 步 至 進 前 接 前 β 就 4- 3 時 驟作 步橾 在賴 喀 鼠 滑 查 檢 驟 步 到 進 有操 若喔 ,喀 作無 操若 喔 , 喀面 加方 施一 被另 否 〇 是47 ----------— (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 驟 步 到 回 就 時 C 作視 監 之 況 狀 作 操 的 1 3 鼠 滑 一了 /#1 進 複 重 鼠 滑 如 假 訂 第 在 是 置 位 而 7,畫 34示 驟顯 步之 在標 游 用 鼠 滑 之 時 作 操 櫪 喀 加 施 被 結 Γ 之 部 下 右 而 書 示 顯 圖 假進 ,複 而重 方 , 1 4 | 4 3 另 .驟 8 步 34到 驟回 步.就 到 , 進時 前置 就位 ,他 時其 份在 部標 之游 示用 顯鼠 J 滑 束如 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 視 監 之 況 狀 作 操8, 的34 3 驟 鼠步 滑在-Τ y/1 顯 面 畫 有 所 之 理 處 示 顯 細 詳 士 位 藉 除 消 表 列 LL 位 到. 回 後 然 理 處 示 顯 細 詳 址 位 之 次 此 0 束理 結處 , 示 示顯 驟 步 中 圖 程 流 之 3 二 理 處 示 顯 程 一了 &gt;./1 之 I項 處4. 錄明 登説 程將 行面 . 下 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ) 1 1 (第1 7圖)所 實 行 之 行 程 登 錄處 理。該 行 程 登錄處理 是用 1 1 | 來 登 錄 新 的 r=r 議 預 定 等 行 程者 〇 1 1 第 3 5 圖 是 行 程 登 錄 處 理 之流 程_ 〇 另 外 ,第36圖 表示 /—V 讀 1 I 先 1 t- 該 處 理 而 被 顯 示 在 顯 示 裝置 4 2之畫 面 〇 下而將同 時參 聞 讀 1 I 昭 /、、» 第 3 6 圖 用 來 説 明 第 3 5 圖 之流 程画。 背 面 1 I 之 1 I 首 先 在 步 驟 3 5 1 , 先於以後之處理, 清除第2 (a)圖 注 意 1 1 事 1 所 示 之 R A Μ 6 1的行程製成區域内容。 項 再 1 人 從 步 驟 3 5 2到步驟3 5 3之 處理 是用以 製 成 第3 8 _之 畫而 填 寫 ί表 本 顯 示 者 〇 頁 '---^ I 首 先 , 在 步 驟 3 5 2 , 顯示第3 6圖所示之行程登錄畫ffi 1 I 之 各 欄 的 顯 示 框 之 描 WFI 和 念議 名稱、 時 間 、場所、 參加 1 1 dbi. S 特 別 記 事 &gt; 取 消 登 錄等 文字。 1 訂 在 步 驟 3 5 3 , 將被收納在第2 (a)圔所示的RAM61内 之郵 1 件 製 成 區 域 之 會 議 名 稱 &gt; 開始 時刻、 結 束 時刻、開 會場 1 1 所 &gt; 參 加 者 9 和 議 有 關 之特 別記事 等 各 項資料, 分別 1 I 顯 示 在 與 第 3 6 _ 所 示 之 行 程登 錄畫而 對 應 之 〇 1 i /:-一 \ 在 步 驟 3 5 4, 將用以表示女字輸入位置之文字用游標 L·:! \ 顯 示 在 宵 議 名 稱 輸 入 區 域 (第3 6画之會議名稱欄)。 1 1 在 步 驟 3 5 5, 將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上之任意 1 位 置 〇 1 從步驟3 5 6 到 步 驟 3 7 〇之處理是藉由滑鼠2 1之操作, 以 1 1 選 擇 文 字 用 游 標 之 移 動 ? 來自 收信人 輸 入 之位址列 表之 1 I 指 定 5 郵 件 寄 信 9 或 行 程 郵件 製成之 取 消 (中ih )等 各種 1 I 處 理 實 行 之 〇 1 1 I _ C 5 - I 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A 7 B7 五、發明説明(以) 在步驟3 5 fi,檢杳滑鼠3 1是否己被移動,假如檢測到 有滑鼠之移動時,就在步驟3 5 7,能與滑鼠之移動方向 、移動距離對應般,俥使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到 步驟3 5 8。另一方而,假如未檢測到滑鼠3 1之移動時就 毫不作動地直接前進到步驟3 5 3。 在步驟3 5 8,檢査滑鼠3 1是否被施加有喀嚒操作,若 有喀喔橾作時就前進到步驟359,另一方面,若無喀喔 操作時就前進到步驟3 7 1。 在步驟3 5 9 ,假如滑鼠3 1.被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游檫之顯示畫而位置是在第3 6圖顯示棗面文字輸入之區 域(第所示之書商顯示之會議名稱、時間、場所、 參加者、特別記事等各欄)時,就前進到步驟3 6 0 ,俾使 文字用游標移動到滑鼠用游標在所位置之區域,然後前 進到步驟3 fi 1。另一方而,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置 時,就毫不作動地肓接前進到步驟3 6 1。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閎讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟3 R】,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示書面位置是在第36顯示畫面右上部之「取消」 顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟3 6 2,另一方面,例如滑 鼠用游標在其他位置時就前進到步驟3 6 4。 在步驟3 6 2,消除行稈製成區域之記億内容,接著在 Φ·驟;3消除藉行程登錄處理之所有顯示畫而,結束此 次之行程登錄處理,然後回到行程顯示處理„ 在步驟3 (5 4 ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒操作時之滑鼠用 游檫之顯示叢而位置是在第3 6圖顯示書面右上部之「登 -5 6 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(β ) 錄j顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟3 (5 5。另一方面,例 如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時,就判斷為在步驟3 5 8所檢 潮到之此次的滑鼠喀嚅並無意義,回到步驟3 5 6 ,重複 進行滑鼠3 1的操作之監視。 在步驟3 fi 5,在上逑行程顯示處理時,從R A Μ 6 1内之行 程區域柚出顯示欄顔色被變更之日期行程資料。 在步驟3 fi (5,將前步驟所抽出之行程資料之開始時刻 和結束時刻,以及行程製成區域内之開始時刻和結束時 刻加以比較,而檢查時間帶有否重複,若無重複時就前 進到步驟3 fi 8 ,另一方面,時間帶若有重複時,就前進 到步驟3ί; 實行警告畫商顯示處理,然後回到步驟3 5 2 至於警告畫而顯示處理之細節將於後面之12.項描述。 在步驟3 fi 8,對於在步驟3 6 5抽出之全部行程資料,檢 査是否實行過步驟3 6 6之時間帶的有無重複之判斷處理, 假如對全部之行程資料均已實行過判斷處理時,就前進 到步驟3 6 9。另一方面,假如殘留有尚未實行判斷處理 之行程資料時,就回到步驟3 6 6重複進行判斷處理。 步驟3 (5 9偽將行程製成區域之記憶内容收納在R A Μ 6 1之 行程區域内之領域,收納在行程顯示處理上顯示欄之顔 色被變更之曰期區域接箸,在步驟3 7 0消除藉行程登錄 處理之所有顯示畫而,結束此次之行程登錄處理,然後 回到行程顯示處理。 另一方而,在繼步驟3 5 8後之步驟:m,檢測對鍵盤3 2 之輸入,假如有輸入時前進到步驟3 7 2 ,另一方面,若 -5 7 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210'乂297公釐) (請先鬩讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) ,w_ 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 (- rt ) 1 1 無 輸 入 時 就 回 到 步 驟 3 5 6 , 重複進行滑鼠3 1的操作之監 1 1 視 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 3 7 2, 將與鍵盤3 2輸入對應之文字顯示在顯示 /·-V 請 ! 先 1 有 文 字 用 游 標 之 欄 1 同時 並 在 步驟 3 7 3將文字資料收 閲 讀 1 1 納 在 與 該 欄 對 應 之 第 2(a) 圖 之 行 程製 成 區 域 之 領 域, 然 背 面 1 I 之 1 後 到 步 驟 3 5 β〇 '/主 意 1 1 事 1 1 2 * 告 畫 商 顯 示 處 理 項 再 1 下 商 將 説 明 11 - 項 之行 程 登 錄 處理 之 流 程 圖 中 步驟 3 67 填 寫 本 I (第3 5圖)所 賁 行 之 警 告畫 而 顯 示 處理 0 頁 &gt; I 警 告 畫 而 顯 1 示 處 理 是用 來 表 示 在行 程 登 錄 處 理 時新 .輸 1 1 入 之 行 程 和 已 登 錄 過 之行 稈 在 時 間帶 上 重 複 9 令 使用 者 1 1 選 擇 是 否 維 持 該 兩 者 之行 程 1 同 時, 對 於 未 被 選 擇之 行 1 訂 程 可 變 更 其 内 容 者 〇 1 第 37 圖 是 警 告 畫 而 顯示 處 理 之 流程 圖 〇 另 外 &gt; 第38 圖 1 1 表 示 藉 該 處 理 而 顯 示 在顯 示 手 段 42之 畫 而 〇 下 面 將邊 參 1 I 照 tsir 38 圖 邊 説 明 第 37 圖之 流 程 m 〇 I 1 首 先 9 在 歩 驟 3 8 1先於以後之處理, 消除對現在顯示 裝 置 4 2之 畫 而 顯 示 〇 1 I 在 步 驟 38 2 , 施行第3 8 _所示之各顯示框或畫而上部 1 I 之 文 字 , 進 而 議 名 稱、 時 刻 等 文字 或 藉 由 滑 麗喀 喔 1 I 而 為 選 擇 畫 而 左 下 部 之輸 入 行 程 變更 &gt; 登 錄 行 程 變更 等 1 功 能 的 顯 示 等 描 繪 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 38 3 , 在第3 8圖所對應之欐分別顯示, 藉由行 1 I 稈 登 錄 處 理 之 步 驟 3 6 Μ第 3 5 _ )的判斷處理所判定為時 1 1 -58- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(β ) 間帶有重複而在R A Μ 6 1行程區域内已登錄過之行程資料 内容。 從步驟3 8 4到步驟3 9 3之處理是藉由滑鼠3之操作,用 來麓擇要維持新輸入之行程與已登錄之行程中任何一方 ,同時,並使未被選擇之行程内容變更者。 首先,在步驟3 8 4,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫面上 之任意位置。 . 在步驟3 8 5,檢杳滑鼠3 1是否已被移動,當檢測到有 滑鼠之移動時,就在步驟38 G能與滑鼠之移動方向、移動 距離對應般,俾使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到步驟3 8 7 。另一方而,在未檢測到滑鼠31之移動時就毫不作動地 直接前進到步驟3 8 7。 在步驟387,檢查滑鼠31是否被施加喀喔操作,若有 被喀嚒操作時就前進到步驟3 8 8,另一方商,若無喀嚅 操作時就回到步驟3 8 5 ,重複進行滑鼠3 1的橾作狀況之 監視。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (詩先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟3 8 3,假如滑鼠3 ]被施加喀_操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫而位置是在第38_之顯示書面左下部之 「輸入行程變更」顯示之部粉時,就前進到步驟3 8 9方 另一方而,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時就前進到步驟 3 9 0 „ 在步驟3 8 9 ,維持已登錄過之行程,為變更新輸入之 行程所需,消除藉警告畫而顯示處理之所有畫面顯示, 而結束此次之警告畫而顯示處理,然後回到行程登錄處 -5 9 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(以) 理。 在步驟3 9 ϋ,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒操作時之滑鼠用 游標之顯示畫面位置是在第38圖顯示畫面左下部之「登 錄行程變更J顯示之部份時,就前進到步驟3 9 1。另一 方面,假如滑鼠用游標在其他位置時,就判斷為在步驟 3 8 7所檢測到之此次之滑鼠喀_並無意義,而回到步驟 3 8 5,重複進行滑鼠3 1的橾作狀況之監視。 從步驟3 ίΠ到步驟3 9 3之處理是登錄新輸入之行程,藉 以變更已登錄過之行程者。 在步驟391,將行稈製成區域之記憶内容收納在R A Μ 6 1 之行程區域内之領域,被收容在行程顯示處理上將顯示 欄顔色被變更的日期之區域。 在步驟3 9 2 由行程登錄處理之步驟3 6 6 (第3 5圔)之 判斷處理判定為時間帶有重複,而將登錄在RAM61行程 區域内之行程資料内容複印到行程製成區域,然後,刪 除被收納在行稈區域内的行程資料之記億。 在步驟3 9 3 ,消除藉警告畫面顯示處理之所有畫面顯 示,結束此次之警告畫而顯示處理,然後回到行程登錄 處理。 經濟、部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閎讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 】3 .行程詳細顯示處理 下而將説明4 .項之行程顯示處理之流程圖中步驟2 0 8 (第]7 _)所實行之行程詳細顯示處理。該行程詳細顯示 處理是用來顯示第β圖所示已登錄過之行程資料的詳細 内容。 -6 0 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明() 第3 9圖和第4 0圖是行程詳細顯示處理之流程圔。另外 ,第4〗圖表示藉該處理在顯示裝置42所顯示之畫面。下 商將同時參照第4 1圖來説明第39圖和第40圖之流程圖。 在步驟4 (Π施行如第4 1圖所示之各顯示框或收信人、 會議名稱、開始、結束、場所、参加者、特種記事等文 字,或藉由滑鼠喀_為選擇畫而右上部之結束,畫而下 部之前後行程等各種功能的顯示等描繪。 在步驟4 0 2,將1代入變數η。 在步驟4 fl 3 ,根據行程顯示處理所獲得之指標A、Β之 值,在對應第4〗圖所示之畫面欄,分別顯示被收納在 R A Μ (Π的行程區域内之Μ 0 N T H ( B )的第A日之行程資料 S C Π ( η )之資料。 在步驟4 0 4,將滑鼠用游標顯示在顯示畫而上之任意 位置。 在步驟4 Π 5 ,檢杳滑鼠:Π是否已被移動,假如檢測到 有滑Ε之移動時,就在步驟4QG能與滑鼠之移動方向、 移動距離對應般,俥使滑鼠用游標移動,然後前進到步 驟4 (1 7。另一方而,假如未檢測到滑鼠3 1之移動時,就 毫不作動地官接前進到步驟4 0 7。 在步驟4 0 7 ,檢査滑鼠3是否被施加喀_操作,若有 喀嚅橾作時就前進到步驟4 Q 8 ,另一方面,若無喀嚒操 作時就回到步驟4 0 5 ,重複進行滑鼠3 1的操作狀況之監 視Γ. 在步驟4 0 8,假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀曬操作時之滑鼠用 -(51 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標隼(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) ----------I (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 (y〇 ) 1 游 標 之 顯 示 棗 而 位 置 是 在 第 4 1圖顯 示 輋 面 右 下部之 「結 1 1 I 束 .」 顯 示 之 部 份 時 9 就 刖 進 到步驟 4 0 9 〇 另- -方面, 假 1 1 如 滑 鼠 用 游 標 在 其 他 位 置 時 ,就前 進 到 步 驟 4 1 0 (第 4 0圖 )〇 請 ! 先 1 在 步 驟 4 0 9 , 消除藉該行程詳細顯示處理之所有畫面 閱 讀 1 I 顯 示 結 束 此 次 之 行 程 詳 細 顯7F處 理 9 妖 /&gt;ν&gt; 後 回到行 程顯 背 面 1 I 之 1 示 1^ m 理 〇 注 意 1 I 事 1 移 到 第 4 0 圖 在 步 驟 4 1 0 , 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀壢操 項 再 1 1 作 時 之 猾 鼠 用 游 frift 標 之 顯 示 畫 面位置 是 在 第 4 1 圔顯示 畫面 填 寫 '本 C I 下 部 之 厂 ,·&gt; /. 刖 行 程 .」 顯 示 之 部 份時, 就 1 J. 刖 進 到 步驟4 1 頁 I 一 方 而 假 如 滑 鼠 用 游 標 在其他 位 置 時 就 前進到 步驟 1 1 1 4 1 4〇 1 1 在 步 驟 4 1 1 , ,檢杳η 值, Ώ 若非&quot; 1 &quot; 時 就 .V.A. 刖 進到步 驟4 1 2 1 訂 1 〇 另 一 方 而 y 假 如 η 為 &quot;1 ”時,就無視於步驟4 1 0所 撿測 到 之 厂 刖 行 程 J 顯 示 的 喀 喔 ,重複 進 行 滑 m 31的操 作狀 1 1 況 之 監 視 〇 亦 m 5 現 在 詳 細 顯示之 行 程 資 料 為 SCD ( 1), 1 I 因 為 在 該 曰 並 未 登 錄 有 更 前 而號碼 之 行 程 資 料,所 以可 1 1 忽 視 該 喀 操 作 〇 T 在 步 驟 4 1 2 , 使變數η 之值退回] 〇 1 f 在 步 驟 4 1 3 , 消除第4 1 _所示畫面之顯示欄内行程資 1 | β 料 之 顯 示 &gt; 為 電 新 顯 示 行 程 資料, 回 到 步 驟 4 0 3 (第 3 9圖 )〇 1 在 步 驟 4 1 4 , 假如滑鼠3 1被施加喀嚒橾作時之滑鼠用 1 | 游 標 之 顯 示 棗 面 位 置 是 在 第 4 1圖顯 示 畫 面 下 部之「 下個 1 1 行 程 J 顯 示 之 部 扮 時 就 刖 進到步 驟 4 1 5 〇 另一方而, 1 1 假 如 滑 鼠 用 游 標 在 其 他 位 直 時,就 判 斷 為 步 驟 4 0 7 ( 第39 1 I -6 2- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(w) 圖),所檢測到之此次的滑鼠喀喔並無意義,而回到步 驟4 (1 Γι (第3 9圖),重複進行滑鼠3丨的橾作之監視。 在步驟4 ] 5,檢杳η值,檢杳η是否等於R A Μ 6 1之行程 區域内可記億之一日份行程資料之最大數,假如不相等 者就前進到步驟4 ] β。另一方而,假如相等時,就漠視 步驟4 1 4所檢测到之「下一行程」顯示的喀喔操作,重複 進行滑鼠:Π的操作狀況之監視。這.是因為比現在詳細顯 示之行程資料更後面號碼之行程資料並未存在的緣故, 所以可漠視該喀囉操作。 在步驟4 1 G,使變數η之值進1,然後回到步驟4 1 3。 1 4 ·下個月顯示處理和上個月顯示處理 下而將説明4 ·項之行程顯示處理之流程画中步驟2 1 2 (第]7丨國)所實行之下橱月顯示處理,和步驟2 1 0 (第1 7圖) 所實行之上橱月顯示處理。該下個月顯示處理和上個月 顯示處理是將藉行程顯示處理所顯示之行程日暦變更為 下橱月或上個月而顯示之。 … 第42圖表示下锢月顯示處理之流程圖,和第43圖表示 上個月顯示處理之流程圖。比較該兩個就可瞭解,該兩 流程圖大致上為同樣之處理。下而擬失'.説明下個月顯示At step R, the 2 0 is shown by the 24 person. _ Step display a) From the face / fv content area into a post and the display of the figure 5 2 The first system is used for mt 3 4 2 00 The collection and 2 'drawing 4 ί 2 The steps of the description are shown in the frame, and the sides of the first column of the display are drawn as a piece of postage. The Ministry of Standards and Standards Bureau ’s Consumer Cooperatives ’Printing Co., Ltd. ’s designated indexing address r eliminates the issue of the letter ’s item. ○ Remarks, the prominent person participates with π Π, and the word field is the first (? 22 IIP No. &gt; at ΐ7 #] In the reception, 3 and 24 steps are displayed. The steps in the steps should be paired to make the finished products. The post is made into 61 pieces. The post is AM Tt. All sorts of conclusions, etc. / Do not open at the time of writing, and refer to the fields of the famous parliamentary assembly and the rf person letter and add the participating post office. The paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Specifications (210X297 mm) A7, B7 V. Description of the invention (41) In step 2 4 4 it will be used to indicate the text The cursor at the input position is displayed with the cursor in the recipient input area (recipient block displayed on the screen shown in Figure 25). At step 2 4 5, the cursor for the mouse is displayed at any position on the display screen. From step to step Steps 2 5 6 to 2 4 are processed according to the selection of the user of the email device 21A, and the cursor is moved by the cursor 81 by the operation of the mouse 81, from the address list input by the recipient Designation, sending emails, or canceling (suspending) the schedule email. In step 2 4 6, check whether the mouse 3 1 has moved. When the mouse movement is detected, go to step 2 4 7 Can move the mouse with the cursor according to the movement direction and distance of the mouse, and then proceed to step 2 4 8. On the other hand, if the movement of mouse 3 1 is not detected, it will directly move to Step 2 4 8. In step 2 4 8, check if there is a click operation on mouse 3 1, if there is click operation, proceed to step 2 4 9, if there is no click operation, proceed to step 2 5 9 (Figure 24). The staff of the Central Bureau of Standards Printed by Fei Cooperatives -.-------- ί 'ν,'-(Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) At step 249, if the mouse 31 is slipped when it is clicked The position of the mouse cursor display screen is in the text input area of the display screen in Figure 25 (recipients, meeting name, start, end, place, participants, special notes, etc. in Figure 25). Step 2 5 Q, move the cursor for text to the current position of the cursor for the mouse, and proceed to step 2 5 li on the other side, if the cursor for the mouse is in another position, proceed directly to it without any honour. Step 2 5 1. -43- This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Invention Description (〇) In step 251, if mouse 31 is applied When clicking, the position of the display screen of the mouse cursor during operation is the part of the "Sending" displayed on the right side of the 25th display screen, then proceed to step 2 5 2. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor In other positions, proceed to step 254 (Fig. 24). In step 252, in addition to the receipt, meeting name, start, end, place, participant, and special memo displayed on the itinerary creation screen shown in FIG. 25 (a), the itinerary mail t is also stored in the email device 2 The mail address of the user of 1 A is used as the receiver), and the communication control unit 26 sends a mail to the email service unit 11A via the LAN 5. In addition, as described above, the user's mail address is entered by the user from the keyboard 32, and is stored in advance in other areas of the RAM (Π. In step 2 5 3, all display screens that are processed by the schedule mail are eliminated, and Finish the itinerary mail processing, and then return to the message display 7TC processing. Move to step 2 4 In step 2 5 4, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the cursor position of the mouse cursor is displayed. If it is in the "Cancel" part of the display on the upper right of the 25th display screen, it proceeds to step 2 5 5. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is at another position, it proceeds to step 2 5 7. In step 2 5 5, delete the memory contents of the mail creation area, and then in step 2 5 6 delete all the display screens of the process of making the debit mail, end the process of making the mail in this time, and then return to the reception display process. In step 2 5 7, if the mouse 3 1 is used to display the mouse cursor when the click operation is performed and the position is the part of the "address designation" displayed on the upper right of the display in Figure 25, go forward. Go to step 2 5 8 -4 4-This paper size is in accordance with Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210 X 297 mm) —--------- Vi (Please read the notes on the back before filling this page) Description of the invention After step-by-step, the RE will set the address A7 B7 while the other one is 0. Figure 3 2 The first step is to set the time when it is judged. There is no meaning when you step back to 0. Click next to the test and check the address' • ib to C 3 for 0 inspection of the prison. [17] and [1]-) The _ section 3} 2 is the finest 0 (after 24 points, PΛ, _ loses the 3rd, 1st, and the 25 keys of the 2nd step. It is borrowed from the fm-IX 6 2 steps. Those who are u rF to the 59th postal mail system and 2 steps _ step 2 step to step 6 {before 24 if the fake entry loses 2 3 Panjian ammonium has no supervision on the entrance and loses, and acts as a fake 31, rat The face slippery line is tested and rechecked once. When you step in and out, there is a time when you can enter and return (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) k. Same time Machine mark 0, tour C 2 Use the step word to display the disc key and the step to respond to the input. It is expected that the word will be displayed in the text, and the figure 2 of the text 6 should be 2 pairs. # 6 The 24 and the step in step fal -πυ. The receiving area of the area is a piece of production, the postal adjustment, the addressing step, the process of the flow of the piece of processing, and the item «5 Explanation -1 × 2 steps / V down 7 steps c U Figure P * Wo 4 \ ir 2 Figure tn in the middle of the flow chart: the processing of the item I7 / »1 of the post The address printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards, Ministry of Economic Affairs of the People ’s Republic of China shall indicate the location of the address from the 4th \ The address of the site has 2E of the table in the area, or the mail is reduced to 22, and the mail received at the address can be received by the recipient. The destination of the t-piece mail is to send the letter to the input 2 3 disk keys and use it by the follower. Miscellaneous installation at 21 degrees C. This paper size is applicable to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (210X 297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (4) The second fi chart is Address designation process flow. Fig. 27 shows a screen displayed on the display device 42 by this process. The flowchart of the second fi diagram will be described below with reference to FIG. 27. First, in Figure 2 (5), the drawing is performed in step 2 71, and the address list box in Figure 27 or the upper right of the screen is canceled, finished, etc. by clicking with a mouse. It is a function selection display. The processing from step 2 7 2 to step 2 7 5 is to actually display the mail address to the list in the address list column shown in number 27. In step 2 7 2 substitute 1 into the variable η. In step 273 Referring to the ADD (η) stored in the address list area in the RAM 61 shown in FIG. 4, the corresponding name and mail address are displayed in the first column of the list. In step 2 7 4 make the variable τι only Proceed to 1. In step 2 7 5, check whether the number of displayed addresses τι in the address list exceeds 1 picture and the number of displayable addresses M. If η exceeds M, proceed to step 2 7 6. On the other hand, If η does not exceed M, it returns to step 2 7 2) and repeats the display processing of the address list. The processing from step 2 7 6 to step 2 9 1 is to select the mail sending object from the mail addresses of the list through the operation of mouse 3 1 to copy the selected mail address to FIG. 2 or Recipients shown in Figure 25. In step 2 7 (5, display the mouse cursor at any position on the display screen. In step 2 7 7 check if the mouse 3 has been moved. If the movement of the slider E is detected, it can be connected with step 278. The mouse moves in the same direction and distance, so move the mouse with the cursor, and then proceed to step 2 7 9 -4 G-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (read Please read the notes on the back before filling this page) Order A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (4Γ) 1 1 〇 On the other hand, if the movement of the mouse 3 1 is not detected Just go directly to step 2 7 9 without any action 1 1 1 In step 2 7 9, check if the mouse 3 1 has been clicked. If there is / -— s please 1 I first 1 be When the operation is performed, the process proceeds to step 280. On the other hand, if it is not read 1 | when the operation is performed, the process returns to step 2 7 7. Repeat the operation of the mouse 3 1 to monitor the back 1 I 1 〇 Note 1 1 event 1 In step 28, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the mouse cursor is used to display the picture and the position is reversed. The mail address list in the display screen in Figure 27 is written in the book. If it is, then go to step 28 1. Otherwise, if the mouse cursor page 1 I is in another position, go to step 28 3〇1 1 In step 28 1, get the line corresponding to the position of the mouse cursor. 1 1 E-mail address number, and substitute variable A, then in step 2 8 2, reverse display 1 Order the text and background color of ADD (A) corresponding to variable A 0 1 In step 28 3, if you slide The mouse 3 1 is applied. When the mouse is in operation, use the 1 1 cursor to display the picture and the position is at the top right part of the 7TC screen in Figure 27. When the I factory cancels the J display part, proceed to step 2 8 4. It is used to eliminate all the display pictures shown in Figure 27 in 1 μ. To end the address designation i 1 this time, return to Made to the mail processing or made travel-mail processing. At the step of 1 I, when the address designation process is finished, the copy of the address box of the mail address 1 1 will not be performed. On the other hand, if the cursor is on the other 1 1 * address, the mouse will advance to Step 2 8 5 〇1 I In step 28 5, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the position of the display screen of the mouse cursor 1 1 at the time of operation is the 7K picture on the 27th display and the 1 I factory in the upper right is over. When J is displayed, go to step 2 8 6. On the other hand 1 1 1 -4 7-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to the Chinese national standard (CNS> A4 size (210'〆297 mm) V. Description of the invention (4 A7 B7 Step by step back to back Judgment by judgment, righteousness, no side-by-side _ he khaki mouse on the slide of the slider, use this mouse to slide as tested false test, slide J7, step 2828 step by step focus on The LL position of the inspector's work. The face of the post shows the η number of the person who changed the figure 27 generations. Article} W will show whether the reverse is borrowed 〇〇 显 28 of the step η step / 1 -D is displayed at the time of AD, the display is reversed and the anti-receipt is received when it is in place as indicated by the fake post, and the display is displayed at the time of the change. If you do n’t accept the bank, it will show η) in the display area of the domain. / V Person D letter AD is accepted as false. The domain and the district are in one system. Countless changes to advance (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) ο of the 9 Geng 2 step sequence address in place when the inspection is in place Draw 27th super η is shown as false, was &lt; Whether it is a super-large digital address or not, the fc N h when it is reprinted. If the over-qualified file is not mailed, it is listed as false. Rep. 2 Β Steps 7 to 28. Take the first step everywhere {F Rep. The mistakes in this forum are misplaced. Ο The postal troubles are the same as entering TTM — the delivery agency of the logistics agency, and the postal mail of the sender can be more and less. It is also set to make the postal mail the same as the Ministry of Economic Affairs. The Central Bureau of Standards and Staff ’s Consumer Cooperatives printed the incumbent M-piece CC. The picture shows something as shown in Figure 7 2 except the end of the post Λ3 Cheng Yicheng Λ1 or fm-S into a product来 原 ΠΜ- To Huilili 1, the C 29 theorem means that the address of the step is HE, the letter of the letter is closed, the letter of the letter is closed, and the figure is the letter of the letter of the letter. Item No. U: Actual drawing ii, ii, and i3 / V default 4 This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of invention (47) Display processing selected The text of the mail is displayed on the processor of the display device 42. Figure 28 is a flow chart of the unsealing process. 29 and 30 show screens displayed on the display device 42 by this process. Here, Fig. 29 shows the opening screen of a normal mail, and Fig. 30 shows a written display of an opening mail. The flow chart of Figure 28 will be described below with reference to Figures 39 and 30 simultaneously. First, from step 3 01 to step 3 (the processing of 13 is to identify whether the displayed mail is a normal mail or a travel mail, and apply the corresponding display to it. First, step 3 1) 1 is in In the process of receiving and displaying, before performing the unsealing process, check the flag SCF of M AI L (A) which is displayed in reverse. If SCF is “1”, it also means that MAIL (A) is an itinerary mail When proceeding to step 302, execute the display box for the itinerary mail shown in Figure 30 or the text of the meeting name, time, place, participants, special notes, etc. (Please read the precautions on the back before filling (On this page) k. The order must be closed. I will open the seal and choose 4 to 30. Step the mouse to the front of the head, and the right screen drawing will be displayed as 0 if it is false. Just before you step in il • ILL τη 'Changtong's display Figure 9 2 First 7 / Ji Printed on the right screen by employee consumer cooperatives, etc. At the end of the registration process, the seal person will make a choice. Check or select the box * The mailing list of the display part of the display mouse and the display of the display are 1/11. The entry is 5 Q 3 0 step 4. Π step 3 2 step 30 before step advance The reason is that the 61 mark of the AM ί operation 4 'flag 3 the step of the seal is opened in one piece will be divided into different materials to receive the paper size of this paper applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm ) Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Β7. V. The description of the invention (4 /) is shown in the corresponding column in Figure 29 or Figure 30. In step 305, "1" is substituted into the flag K A I F M of M A I L (A), which is used to indicate that M A T L (A) has been unsealed at least once. The process from step 30 to step 3 1 1 is to select the end of the mail unsealing process by the operation of mouse 31. First, in step 3 f), display the cursor on the display screen with the mouse cursor. Any position. In step 3 (Π, check whether the mouse 31 has been moved. If the movement of the mouse is detected, it can correspond to the direction and distance of the movement of the mouse in step 308, so that the mouse cursor is used. Move and then proceed to step 3 Q 9. On the other hand, if no movement of mouse 3 1 is detected, proceed directly to step 3 0 9 without any action. In step 3 (1 9, check mouse 3 Whether 1 is clicked, if it is clicked, proceed to step 3 1 G, if it is not clicked, go back to step 3 0 7, and repeat the monitoring of the operation status of mouse 3 1. Step 3 1 Π, if the mouse 3 1 is applied, the cunning mouse uses the display book of the Peregrine Falcon and the position is in the display picture of FIG. 29 or 30, and the “top j display part” If it is, move to step 3 1 1. On the other hand, if you slide the cursor with E at another position, return to step 3 7 and repeat the monitoring of the operation status of Mole 3 1. At step 3 1 1, Eliminate all screen display by borrowing and unsealing processing, end the unsealing process this time, and return to the reception display processing. 9. Add address I will continue to explain the flow chart of address list display processing of item 3. -50-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) —.11 —-1 II n-I- I ~~ Order (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) A7 clearly states that the address must be sent to five plus ο m: 1 plus the address plus the address of the address // // the address book of the address The location of the chase area is shown in Figure C. Tutuna 134 received the first U in the plus 17 and when the material is shown at the table, the fii is the same as the 32nd, and the next is 0. 2 Process 4 The placement of the display is displayed at the address of the tracking site, but it is the _ place 3 This is borrowed from the map of the flow of the flow ϋ · 3 It is said that 1 Use 32 steps 32 steps in the picture Is there a new step to check the new mailing address of the material? Hu Hu will stay there until the time before entering. The area, the white area is empty, and the other area is C. 22 2J. At the time of the alarm, 1 is displayed at the 2 and 4 positions, and the new mail can be displayed at the material address. The mail can not be listed in the zone. The address is 2 '32. In the step, the table is displayed as the display table. When the address is set, the position can be set, and any position can be ignored. When the force is followed by the interposition, the display is the next and the conclusion is displayed. After the police, the C will be cleared. »VI calls to use the first name or last name of the frame to draw the picture. 2 3 Select the right side of the display part of the display part of the first display. The sliding predicate is based on the borrowed predicate, etc., remove the address, record --------- c ^ .— (Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) Set the central standard of the Ministry of Economic Affairs The bureau ’s consumer cooperative printed the 3 steps of the keyboard and the 31-key slide record, and borrowed the borrowing information. The 7 t 3 h 3J piece of mail was sent in two steps. Set the name of the first name and last name entered in the bidding in the exercise. Enter the 2 i 3 input step text. Use your mouse to display the display position J J 32. The steps are smooth and smooth: Check the table to show that the display is in # first name 5 last name 32 Figure step 2. 3 The painter arrives at the test if false, 61 ^ . 33 Is the paper size applicable to the Chinese standard (CNS) A4 size (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of invention (r. ) 1 1 When there is a broken movement, it is in step 3 2 7 and can move with the mouse in the moving direction 1 1 m away from the opponent CJi '. Then move the mouse with the cursor, and then move forward 1 1 to step 3 2 8, the other side is-if the movement of the mouse 3 1 is not detected /-V please 1 first 1, then continue to A. / »without moving, then go to step 3 2 8. Read 1 1 In step 32 8, check whether mouse 3 1 is used for the Karai operation. If there is a back & II of I 1 Karo operation, go to Step 3 2 9. On the other hand, if there is no Kara Oh, note 1 I will go to step 33 when you are working. 6 1 Matters and then 1 1 In step 3 2 9, if mouse 3 1 is used when the mouse is clicked, please fill in this / 1 | The position of the cursor display screen is at In the input fields of the display screen in FIG. 32, the page I 9 advances to step 3 3 0, and moves the text cursor to the column at the position 1 1 of the mouse cursor &gt; and then proceeds to step 3 3 1. On the other hand, if mouse 1 is moved to the other position without moving the cursor directly to step 3 3 1 〇1 set in step 331-&gt; if mouse 3 1 is applied to the mouse_ 1 The m-plane position of the cursor is "Cancel" at the bottom right of the second 3_ display screen. 1 1 When the part is displayed &gt; proceed to step 332. On the other hand, if the mouse /. 1 | For other positions, go to Step 3 3 3. I 1 In step 3 3 2, remove all the dealer display for additional processing of the borrowed address &gt; 1 End this time the address is forced to be processed ♦ Return to the address list display processing. 1 I In step 3 3 3, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the mouse displays the egg with the 1 1 cursor and the position is shown in the picture 32 and the “Room 1 Record J” shown in the lower right In some cases, just go to step 3 3 4. On the other hand, 9 false 1 I if the mouse cursor is in other positions, it is judged that the step 3 2 8 is picked up 1 1 here The secondary slide m has no meaning, but return to step 3 2 6 and re-enter the 1 I line to monitor the operation status of the mouse 3 1 〇 1 1 I -f) 2- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (θ) In step 334, the name, mail address, mail type and other data will be displayed in the columns of the display screen in Figure 32 The blank area stored in the address list area of the fourth frame is followed by removing all the date display of the borrowing address addition processing in step 3 3 5 to end the address addition processing and return to the address list display processing. On the other hand, following steps 3 2 8 Step 3 3 6, detect the input to the keyboard 3 2, if there is input, go to step 3 3 7, on the other hand, if there is no turn, go back to step 3 2 6, repeat the mouse 3 1 Monitor the operation. In step 3 37, the text corresponding to the input of the keyboard 32 is displayed in the column for displaying the text game. Then return to step 3 2 6 and repeat the monitoring of the operation of the mouse 31. 10. The detailed display of the address will be explained under the processing of τρί. The flow of the display process of the address list of item 3. will be described. The detailed display of the address is performed in step 1 7 (Figure 13). The detailed display of the address It is used to display the details of each information registered in the mail address in the address list area shown in Figure 4. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (This page) Figures 3 and 3 show the flow of detailed address display processing. In addition, Figure 34 shows that the book is displayed on the display device 42 by this processing. The following figure will also be referred to at the same time. The flowchart is in step 3 4 1, and the display boxes or surnames shown in FIG. 3 4 are implemented. , Address, type, etc., or drawing by clicking the mouse on the lower right of the screen to select the detailed display of the end of the display process and so on. In step 3 4 2, place the address list area of RA Μ 6 1 (ADI) (A) -5-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) V. Description of the invention (^) A7 B7 Use ο, the corresponding action in the column is 3 The mouse slide book is shown by 0. The borrower at the 34th position is shown at 48. The display is 0, ^ 0 and other; subdivision: ^ Details cc address step selection Select the nano mouse to show the position. Set the position to the top of the date. The middle step 3 4 3 steps, C first mark the first time to use 4 movements should be 34 to the step away from the mouse distance is sliding Slide check to check if the mouse is sliding. If the moving direction is false, the movement of the mouse is 45 °; If you move forward and backward, move the cursor to 60 seconds. 34 is not abrupt, els ^ 33 is moved by 1 ± 3. The mouse slides until the test is not performed. 4- 3 o'clock step, check the step in Laika mouse to check if you have any action, if you do not have any action, please click here. 47. --- (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) Step to step back to the time when the C will be inspected 1 3 Mouse slide one / # 1 Enter the double mouse slide if you want to order When it is set and 7, draw 34 shows the abrupt step when the mouse cursor is used to slide the movement. Kaga Shi's part is displayed on the right, and the book shows the fake picture, and it is repeated. 1 4 | 4 3 Another. Step 8 Step 34 to Step back. As soon as it arrives, it is in front of you when you enter, and his part is displayed on the ministry standard with a mouse J slide beam printed by the Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. According to the situation of the supervisor, 34, 3, 3, 3, and 3 mouse steps in the -T y / 1 display show some reason to show the details and remove the list of LL positions. Display the detailed address next to the 0 end of the display. &gt; ./ 1, Section I 4. Recorded that Deng said the process will be carried out. The following paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X 297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Fifth, the description of the invention) 1 1 (Figure 17) itinerary registration process. This itinerary registration process uses 1 1 | to register a new r = r to negotiate a new itinerary, etc. 〇1 1 Figure 3 5 is the flow of itinerary registration processing _〇 In addition, Figure 36 shows / —V read 1 I first 1 t- This process is displayed under the screen of the display device 42 and the simultaneous reading and reading will be performed simultaneously. Fig. 36 shows the flow chart of Fig. 35. The back 1 1 of 1 I is first in step 3 5 1 and is processed later, and clear the figure 2 (a). Note that the stroke of R A M 6 1 shown in 1 1 event 1 is made into the content of the area. Item 1 The process from step 3 5 2 to step 3 5 3 is used to make the picture of 3 8 _ and fill in the display of the form 〇 page '--- ^ I First, in step 3 5 2, WFI and the name, time, place, participation 1 1 dbi. S special note &gt; cancel registration and other text are displayed in the display frame of each column of the schedule registration picture ffi 1 I shown in Fig. 36. 1 Ordered in step 3 5 3, the name of the meeting will be created in the area of 1 mail post stored in RAM61 shown in 2 (a) 圔 &gt; start time, end time, meeting place 1 1 place &gt; participants 9 Special information such as the special note, 1 I will be displayed on the corresponding stroke registration picture shown in the 36th _ 〇1 i /:-一 \ In step 3 5 4 will be used to indicate the female character The cursor L · for inputting the text of the position is displayed in the name input area (the conference name column of the 36th picture). 1 1 In step 3 5 5, the cursor for the mouse is displayed at any 1 position on the display screen. 〇 1 The processing from step 3 5 6 to step 3 7 is performed by the operation of mouse 2 1 and selected by 1 1 Text cursor movement? 1 from the address list entered by the recipient 1 I designation 5 mail delivery 9 or cancellation (medium ih) created by the mail itinerary 1 I processing implementation 〇1 1 I _ C 5-I 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A 7 B7 V. Description of the invention (to) In step 3 5 fi, check whether the mouse 3 1 has been moved, if detected When there is mouse movement, it is in step 3 5 7 and it can correspond to the movement direction and distance of the mouse. Press the mouse to move with the cursor, and then proceed to step 3 5 8. On the other hand, if the movement of the mouse 31 is not detected, it proceeds directly to step 3 5 3 without any action. In step 3 5.8, check whether the mouse 3 1 is clicked or not. If there is a click, proceed to step 359. On the other hand, if there is no click, proceed to step 3 7.1. In step 3 5.9, if the mouse 3 is operated, the mouse uses the display of peregrine falcon when the operation is performed, and the position is the area where the text input date of the date is shown in Fig. 36 (the book seller display shown in Fig. 3). (Such as meeting name, time, place, participants, special memo, etc.), proceed to step 3 60, move the cursor for text to the area where the cursor for mouse is located, and then proceed to step 3 fi 1. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor is in another position, it will proceed to step 3 6 without any action. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page). At step 3 R], if the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the written position of the mouse cursor during operation is displayed. When the "Cancel" part of the upper right of the 36th display screen is displayed, the process proceeds to step 3 6 2; on the other hand, if the mouse cursor is at another position, the process proceeds to step 3 6 4. At step 3 2 2, delete the content of 100 million points in the area where the row was made, and then at Φ · step; 3 delete all the display pictures by the stroke registration process, and end the current stroke registration process, and then return to the stroke display process „ In step 3 (5 4), if the mouse 3 1 is applied with the click operation, the display cluster of the mouse is used as a perch and the position is shown in the upper right part of Figure 36. "Deng-5 6-This paper size applies China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Invention Description (β) When the part shown in record j is displayed, proceed to step 3 (5 5. Other On the one hand, for example, when the mouse cursor is in another position, it is judged that the mouse click detected at step 3 5 8 is meaningless. Return to step 3 5 6 and repeat the mouse 3 1 Monitoring of the operation. At step 3 fi 5, during the upper stroke display process, the date of the display column color is changed from the stroke area in the RA 6.1. In step 3 fi (5, the previous step Start time and end time of the extracted trip data, and itinerary The start time and end time in the area are compared, and the time is checked for repetition. If there is no repetition, the process proceeds to step 3 fi 8; on the other hand, if the time zone is repetitive, the process proceeds to step 3ί; Carry out the warning dealer display processing, and then return to step 3 5 2 As for the warning picture, the details of the display processing will be described in item 12. In step 3 fi 8, for all the travel data extracted in step 3 6 5 check Whether the judgment process has been repeated for the time zone of step 3 6 6. If the judgment process has been performed for all the trip data, proceed to step 3 6 9. On the other hand, if there is no judgment process yet to be performed For itinerary data, return to step 3 6 6 and repeat the judgment process. Step 3 (5 9 falsely stores the memory content of the area created in the area in the area of the stroke area of the RA M 6 1 and stores it in the itinerary display processing. The color of the display column is changed by the date area. In step 3 70, all the display pictures that are borrowed from the trip registration process are eliminated, and the current trip registration process is ended, and then the trip display is returned. On the other hand, in the step following step 3 5 8: m, the input to the keyboard 3 2 is detected, if there is input, proceed to step 3 7 2, on the other hand, if-5 7-this paper size applies China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 '乂 297 mm) (Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page), w_ order A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs -rt) 1 1 If there is no input, go back to step 3 5 6, repeat the operation of mouse 3 1 to monitor 1 1 video 0 1 1 In step 3 7 2, display the text corresponding to the keyboard 3 2 input on the display / · -V Please! First, there is a column with a cursor for text 1 at the same time, and the text data is read in step 3 7 3 1 1 It is stored in the area of the area created by the itinerary of Figure 2 (a) corresponding to this column, Then go back to step 1 I 1 to step 3 5 β〇 '/ idea 1 1 thing 1 1 2 * tell the dealer to display the processing item again 1 The businessmen will explain step 3 in the flowchart of the registration process of item 11-item. 67 Fill in the warning picture performed by this I (Figure 35) and display the process. Page 0 &gt; I warning picture and display 1 The process is used to Indicate that it is new when itinerary registration is processed. Enter 1 1 and the registered trip are repeated on the time zone 9 Let the user 1 1 choose whether to maintain the two itinerary 1 At the same time, for the unselected trip 1 The content of the booking can be changed. Figure 37 is a flowchart showing the process of displaying the warning picture. Additionally> Figure 38 shows the picture displayed on the display means 42 by this process. 〇 Refer to the side reference 1 I below. According to the figure of tsir 38, explain the flow of the 37th figure m 〇I 1 first 9 in step 3 8 1 before the subsequent processing, eliminate the drawing on the current display device 4 2 and display 〇1 I in step 38 2, execute the 3 8 _All displays shown Frame or picture and the top 1 I text, and then the name, time and other characters, or the lower left input stroke change to select the picture by sliding the 1 I, and the display of the 1 function, such as registration itinerary change, etc. 1 1 is displayed in step 38 3 and corresponding to the corresponding figure in FIG. 3 8, and it is judged to be 1 1 -58- 1 by the judgment processing in step 3 6 Μ (3 5 _) of line 1 I registration process. 1 1 1 This paper size applies to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. The description of the invention (β) contains the itinerary data that has been registered in the RA Μ 6 1 itinerary area. The processing from step 3 8 4 to step 3 9 3 is performed by using mouse 3 to select any one of the newly entered itinerary and the registered itinerary, and at the same time, make the content of the unselected itinerary. Changed by. First, at step 3 8 4, the cursor for the mouse is displayed at an arbitrary position on the display screen. In step 3 8 5, check whether the mouse 3 1 has been moved. When the movement of the mouse is detected, it can correspond to the movement direction and distance of the mouse in step 38. Move with the cursor and proceed to step 3 8 7. On the other hand, if the movement of the mouse 31 is not detected, the process proceeds directly to step 3 8 7 without any action. In step 387, check whether the mouse 31 is clicked. If it is clicked, proceed to step 3 8 8; if the other party is not clicked, return to step 3 8 5 and repeat. Monitor the operation status of mouse 31. Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the notes on the back of the poem, and then fill out this page). At step 3 8 3, if the mouse 3] is applied, click and display the position of the mouse cursor during operation. When the part of the "input stroke change" display on the lower left of the 38th written display is displayed, proceed to step 3 8 9 and the other side. If the mouse cursor is in another position, proceed to step 3 9 0 „In step 3 8 9, the registered itinerary is maintained. In order to change the entered itinerary, all screens displayed by the warning picture and display processing are eliminated, and the warning picture is displayed and processed, and then returns to the itinerary. Registration Office-5 9-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (in order) In step 3 9 ϋ, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked The position of the display screen of the current mouse cursor is shown in the lower left part of the display screen in Fig. 38. When the part of the registration stroke change J is displayed, proceed to step 3 9 1. On the other hand, if the mouse cursor Position In order that the mouse click detected at step 3 8 7 is meaningless, return to step 3 8 5 and repeat the monitoring of the operation status of mouse 31. From step 3 to step 3 9 The processing of 3 is to register the newly entered itinerary, so as to change the already registered itinerary. In step 391, the memory content of the row-making area is stored in the area within the itinerary area of RA M 6 1 and is contained in the itinerary display. In the process, the area where the color of the column was changed is displayed. In step 3 9 2, the judgment processing in step 3 6 6 (No. 3 5) of the itinerary registration processing determines that the time is duplicated, and it is registered in the RAM 61 stroke area. The contents of the itinerary data are copied to the itinerary creation area, and then the records of the itinerary data stored in the row area are deleted. At step 3 9 3, all the screen displays that are processed by the warning screen display are eliminated, and this time is ended. Warning picture and display processing, and then return to the itinerary registration process. Printed by the Consumers' Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economy and Economy (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page)] 3. The detailed itinerary will be displayed and processed. Explanation 4. The detailed display process of the itinerary performed in step 2 0 8 (No.7) in the flowchart of the display process of the itinerary of item 4. The detailed display process of the itinerary is used to display the registered itinerary data shown in the figure β. -6 0-This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X 297 mm) A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention () Figures 3 and 9 Fig. 40 is the flow chart of the detailed display process of the itinerary. In addition, Fig. 4 shows the screen displayed on the display device 42 by this process. The lower quotient will explain the pictures of Fig. 39 and 40 at the same time with reference to Fig. 41 flow chart. In step 4 (Implement the display boxes or recipients, meeting name, start, end, place, participants, special memo, etc. as shown in Figure 41, or click on the top right to select the picture. At the end of the part, draw the various functions such as the front and back strokes. In step 402, substitute 1 for the variable η. In step 4 fl 3, according to the values of the indicators A and B obtained from the stroke display processing, Corresponding to the screen column shown in Figure 4], the data of the itinerary SC SC Π (η) on the Ath day of M 0 NTH (B) stored in RA Μ (Π) are displayed. In step 4 0 4. Display the cursor with the mouse at any position on the display. In step 4 Π 5, check if the mouse: Π has been moved. If the movement of the mouse E is detected, you can go to step 4QG. Corresponds to the movement direction and distance of the mouse. Move the mouse with the cursor, and then proceed to step 4 (17. On the other hand, if the movement of mouse 31 is not detected, it will not move. The official connection proceeds to step 4 0. In step 4 7, check whether the mouse 3 is applied. Click_operation, if there is a click operation, proceed to step 4 Q 8; on the other hand, if there is no click operation, return to step 4 5 and repeat the monitoring of the operation status of the mouse 31 1 Γ. In step 408, if the mouse 3 1 is used for the mouse when it is used for the sunburn operation-(51-this paper size applies to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X 297 mm) ------ ---- I (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) Order A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (y〇) 1 The date of the cursor is displayed on the 4th Figure 1 shows the "knot 1 1 I bundle." At the bottom right of the mask. The displayed part 9 goes to step 4 0 9 〇 In addition, -1, if the mouse cursor is in other positions, Proceed to step 4 1 0 (Figure 40) 〇 Please! First 1 In step 4 9, remove all screens that show detailed processing of the trip by reading 1 I display the detailed display of the current trip 7F processing 9 demon / &gt; ν &gt; The back 1 I 1 shows 1 ^ m. Note 1 I matter 1 moves to the 40th figure. At step 4 1 0, if the mouse 3 1 is applied with the click operation item and then 1 1 is used by the squirrel to swim. The position of the target display screen is on the 4th display screen. Fill in the 'bottom of this CI, · &gt; / stroke.' When displaying the part, go to step 4 on page 1 of page 1 and If the mouse cursor is in another position, proceed to step 1 1 1 4 1 4〇1 1 In step 4 1 1, check the value of 杳 η. 非 If it is not &quot; 1 &quot; then go to step 4 1 2 1 Order 1 〇 On the other side, if η is &quot; 1 ”, ignore the check of the factory J stroke J displayed in step 4 1 0, repeat the operation of sliding m 31 1 1 The monitoring of the condition 0 also m 5 The trip data displayed in detail now is SCD (1), 1 I 1 1 Ignore the click operation 〇T in step 4 1 2 to return the value of the variable η] 〇 1 f In step 4 1 3, delete the travel information in the display column of the screen shown in 4 1 _ 1 | β material display &gt; To display the travel data for the new electricity, go back to step 403 (Fig. 39). 〇 In step 4 1 4, if the mouse 3 1 is clicked on the mouse Use 1 | The position of the date surface of the cursor is shown in the lower part of the display screen in Figure 41. "Next 1 1 Itinerary J shows the part displayed, and then proceeds to step 4 1 5 〇 On the other side, if 1 for the mouse When the cursor is in other positions, it is judged as step 4 7 (No. 39 1 I -6 2- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm). Employees of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 was printed by the consumer cooperative 5. Illustration of the invention (w)), the mouse click detected this time is meaningless, but go back to step 4 (1 Γι (Figure 39)) and repeat Monitor the operation of mouse 3. In step 4] 5, check the value of η, check whether η is equal to the maximum number of one-hundred-day trip data in the stroke area of R A M 61, if not equal, proceed to step 4] β. On the other hand, if they are equal, ignore the click operation displayed on the "next trip" detected in step 4 1 4 and repeat the monitoring of the operation status of the mouse: Π. This is because the itinerary data of a later number than the itinerary data currently displayed in detail does not exist, so the click operation can be ignored. In step 4 1 G, advance the value of the variable η to 1, and then return to step 4 1 3. 1 4 · The next month display processing and the previous month display processing will explain the flow of the 4th item's itinerary display processing. The steps shown in step 2 1 2 (No. 7) in the picture are performed, and Step 2 1 0 (Fig. 17) The month display processing is executed. The next month display process and the previous month display process are displayed by changing the itinerary date displayed by the itinerary display process to the next month or the previous month. … Figure 42 shows the flowchart of the next month display process, and Figure 43 shows the flowchart of the previous month display process. It can be understood by comparing the two that the two flowcharts are roughly the same processing. I'm going to lose it next. '

TtO 處理。 首先,在步驟4 2 ],消除第1 9圖所示之行程日暦的框 架之R期顯示,其次,在步驟4 2 2 ,消除顯示畫而的行 稈R曆之框上部之年月顯示部份的指定年月之顯示。 在步驟4 2 3,使指定年月前進一個月,結束此次之下 -63- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) —1^ — ml tnn me n II、一 =°4 (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(h ) 個月顯示處理,而回到行程顯示處理。 下面將説明上個月顯示處理,上値月顯示處理之步驟 4 2 6到步驟4 2 7之處理,輿下個月顯示處理之步驟4 2 1到步 驟422之處理完金相同,只有上個月顯示處理之步驟42 8 與下锢月顯示處理之步驟4 2 3不同。 在步驟428,使指定年月退回一锢月,結束此次之上 個月顯示處理,然後回到行程顯示處理。 1 5 .收信處理 接箸,擬説明1.項之基本處理的流程圖中步驟102 (第7 _)所實行之收信處理。 收信處理乃是當收信到舉辦會議之行程登錄用之行程 郵件時,首先,確認已登錄過之行程。於是,對於舉辦 會議之時間帶,假如在已登錄過之行程有空白時,就登 錄該會議之開會預定。對於舉辦會議之時間帶,假如與 已登錄過之行程重複時,就將定形之電子郵件寄給行程 郵件之寄出人,用以通知與該會議同日而另有空白時間 帶,詢問是否可將會議之開會時間帶變更為此空白時間 帶。然後,對於該被發信之電子郵件,假如重新接收到 表示可將會議之開會時間變更為此空白時間帶的電子郵 件時,就、登錄此變更後的會議之開會時間。似此,該收 信處理可以實現與本發明有關之一大特徵。 第44圖、第45圖、第4G圖和第47圖是收信處理之流程 圖。下而將説明該流程圖。 首先在第44圖,從步驟431到步驟436之處理是重新接 -6 4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) J. 訂 A7 B7 五、發明説明(W ) 受電子郵件而加以收納者。 在步驟4 3]進行對電子郵件服務部1 1 a之存取,檢查是 否存在有新到達之郵件,假如存在有新到達之郵件時就 前進到步驟4 3 2 ,另一方面,假如未存在有新到達之郵 件時,就結束此次之收信處理》 在步驟4 3 2,檢查在R A Μ 6 1内之收信郵件區域是否存在 有儘可收納新郵件之空白區域,假如存在有空白區域時 ,就毫不作動地直接前進到步驟4 3 4。另一方面,假如 未殘留有充分之空白區域時,就前進到步驟4 3 3 ,在被 收納於該收信郵件區域内之收信郵件中,刪除收信時曰 最早之郵件而確保空白區域後,回到步驟4 3 2 ,重複進 行空白區域之調查處理。 在步驟4 3 4 ,將新到逹之收信郵件從電子郵件服務部 U Α卸載1件,而將其納在收信郵件區域之空白領域, 在步驟4 3 5,將用以表示被收納的收信郵件之有無開封 的旗標K A I F U設定為” 0 ”(未開封)而收納,然後在步驟4 3 6 ,以基本處理之流程圖中步驟1 fl 1 (第7画)的時刻計測 處理所取得之現在的時日,作為郵件之收信時曰,而將 其收納在收信郵件區域。 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 (請先聞讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟4 3 7 ,檢杳用以表示該收信郵件是否為行程郵 件之旗標S C F ,假如S C F為” 0 ”,亦即,表示收信郵件為 通常郵件時,就前進到步驟4 5 6 ,另一方而,假如S C F若 非&quot;〇 ”,亦即表示收信郵件為行程郵件時,就前進到步 驟4 3 8 (第4 5圖)。 -6 5 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ^4* ) 1 1 移 到 第 4 5 圖 , 從步 驟4 3 8到步 驟 42 2之處理為, 用來檢 1 1 杳 有 否 與 收 信 到 的行程郵件之 議 開辦預 定重 複 之已 1 1 登 錄 過 之 F=T 議 開 辦預 定存在者。 ^—V 請 ! 先 1 首 先 在 步 驟 4 38, 從R A Μ 6 1的行程區域中,檢取與記 閲 讀 1 I 載 於 收 信 到 的 行 程郵 件之開會年月日同一日期之已登錄 背 ώ 1 I 之 1 過 之 行 程 資 料 〇 注 意 1 1 事 1 在 驟 4 3 9 , 假如收納有與前 步 驟 所檢取 之結 果 其開 項 再 1 金 年 月 曰 為 同 一 Η期 之行程資料時, 就前進到步驟4 4 0。 1 本 1 另 一 方 面 ) 假 如未 收納有與開會年月日同一日期之行 頁 V._^ 1 I 程 資 料 時 就 前 進到 步驟4 4 3。 瞧 1 I 在 步 驟 4 4 〇 , 讀岀- -件與會議 之 開 辦年月 曰同 一 曰期 1 1 之 登 錄 過 的 行 程 資料 ,在步驟4 4 1 9 檢查該 行程 資 料所 1 訂 包 含 的 議 之 開 辦時 間帶(從開 始 時 刻到終 了時 刻 之期 1 間 ), 和被記載於行程郵件的會 議 之 開辦時 間帶 是 否重 1 1 複 S 假 如 未 電 複 時前 進到步驟4 42 9 另一方 面, 假 如有 1 I 重 複 時 就 前 進 到 步驟 4 4 7 (第 4 (5 画) 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 44 2 , 對於步驟4 3 8所檢取的同一日期之行程資 r 料 檢 杳 是 否 以 前步 驟做過開會時間帶有否重複, 假如 1 1 對 部 行 程 資 料 已做 過重複核對者就前進到步驟4 4 3。 1 I I 另 一 方 商 假 如 有尚 未做過重複核對之行程資料殘留時 1 5 就 m 到 步 驟 4 4 0,對殘留之行 程 資 料施加 電複 核 對。 1 I 在 步 驟 4 4 3 , 根據所收信到的 行 程 郵件之 内容 重 新製 1 1 成 行 程 資 料 , 接 著在 步驟4 4 4, 將 所 製成之 行程 資 料收 1 1 納 在 R AMC 1之行程區域内與會議 開 辦 預定曰 對應 之 領域。 1 I -6 6- 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(K ) 在步驟4 4 5,以收信到的行程郵件發出人之郵件位址 作為收信人,使用被收納在第2 ( b )圖所示的R AM 6 1内之 定形郵件儲存區域之定形郵件B製成電子郵件,接著, 在步驟4 4 6 ,將該電子郵件從通信控制部2 6經由L A N 5發 信給電子郵件服務部11A,然後結束此次之收信處理。 在此定形郵件係指構成為包含有郵件内容的一定資訊之 電子郵件謂之,在本實施形態即表示,電子郵件之件名 被預先決定著,且郵件本文以某一預定文章所構成者。 第4 9圖即表示定形郵件B之内容。定形郵件B用來對行 程郵件之發出人,通知按照行程郵件所記載之會議開辦 之預定其行程已被登錄。 移到第4 6圖,繼步驟4 4 1 (第4 5圖}後而從步驟4 4 7到步 驟4 5 5之處理是,已登錄過的行程之開辦畤間(從開始時 刻到結束時刻之期間),與被記載於行程郵件的會議之 開辦時間有重複之場合的處理。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 1.--------.. 11 (讀先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 在步驟4 4 7,從ϋ A Μ 6 1之行程區域内讀出被辨明為重複 時間帶之與登錄過行程資料同一日期之行程資料内容, 在與該行程郵件同日之一日之中,探求行程空白的時間 帶(空白時間帶),在步驟448,假如存在有空白時間帶 時就前進到步驟4 4 9 ,另一方而,若無空白的時間帶存在 時就前進到步驟4 5 4。 在步驟4 4 9 ,將收信到之行程郵件收納在第2 ( a )国所示 之R. Α Μ (Π内的郵件待命區域,在步驟4 5 0 ,將被收納在郵 件待命區域之行程郵件的舉辦會議時間,變更為在步驟 -67- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( yy ) 1 1 44 7所探取的空白畤間帶而加以收納。 1 1 1 在 步 驟 4 5 1 , 以收信到之行程郵件的發出人之郵件位 1 1 1 址 作 為 收 件 人 &gt; 使 用被收納 在 第 2(b) 圖 所 示的 EAM6 1内 請 1 1 之 定 形 郵 件 儲 存 區 域的定形 郵 件 C製 成 電 子郵 件 〇 第 5 0 閱 讀 1 背 1 圖 表 示 定 形 郵 件 C 之内容。 定 形 郵件 C 是 用來 通 知 給 行 面 之 1 注 I 程 郵 件 之 發 出 人 &gt; 因為存在 有 已 登錄 過 之 行程 資 料 » 所 意 1 以 在 被 記 載 於 行 程 郵件之會 議 開 辦之 預 定 時間 帶 雖 不 能 項 再 1 填 登 錄 但 是 9 若 將 會議開辦 之 時 間帶 可 變 更為 記 載 於 郵 寫 本 件 之 時 間 帶 者 就 將可進行 行 程 登錄 之 項 目通 知 行 程 郵 頁 ^ 1 件 之 發 出 人 〇 — 1 I 在 步 驟 4 5 2 , 在電子郵件所記載的定形郵件C 之本文 1 1 中 (第5 0画)之 本 文 欄中圚圈 和 三 角形 之 位 置), 記載以 1 訂 步 驟 4 5 0所收納在郵件待命區域的空白時間帶之開始時 1 I 間 和 結 束 時 間 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 4 5 3 , 將使用定形郵件C 所製成之電子郵件從 1 1 通 信 控 制 部 2 6 經 由 L A Ν 5發信 到 電 子郵 件 服 務部 1 1 A , 妖 1 後 結 束 此 次 之 收 信 處理。此 外 這時 在 電 子郵 件 所 記 載 'J 1 的 定 形 郵 件 之 本 文 中(第5 0圖之本文攔中的黑點記號之 1 | 位 SB. 里 ), 記載了電子郵件裝置2 1 A之固 有 密 碼。 I 另 一 方 而 在 m 步驟4 4 8後之步驟4 54 » 以收 信 到 的 行 1 程 郵 件 之 發 出 人 之 郵件位址 作 為 收信 人 &gt; 使用 被 收 納 在 1 I 第 2 ( h) 圖 所 示 之 R. A Μ 6丨内的定形郵件區域之定形郵件D來 1 1 製 成 電 子 郵 件 〇 第 5 _表示 定 形 郵件 D 之 内容 0 定 形 郵 1 1 件 D 是 用 來 通 知 行 程郵件之 發 出 人, 因 為 在行 程 郵 件 所 1 I -68&quot; 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟、哪中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( y7 ) 1 1 記 載 之 議 開 辦 之 預 定 時間 存 有 已 登 錄 ua m 之 行 程 ί 故 未 1 1 能 登 錄 &gt; 而 Μ 5 將 在 該 會議 開 辦 之 預 定 曰 並 Μ y\\\ 可 出 席 1 ! 議 之 空 白 時 間 帶 事 宜 通 知給 行 程 郵 件 之 發 出 人 •t 在 行 程 ,·~·、 讀 1 先 1 郵 件 之 收 信 人 不 知 行 並無 空 白 , 而 開 始 ^9 議 之 開 辦 時 閱 讀 1 間 之 變 更 作 業 時 可 防 lh該 作 業 徒 勞 -frrr Μ 益 〇 脅 1 之 1 在 步 驟 4 5 將使用定形郵件I) 所製成之電子郵件從 注 意 1 1 通 信 控 制 部 2 0 經 由 L A N 5 發信 給 電 子 郵 件 服 務 部 11 A , 然後 事 1 I 再 *. 結 束 此 次 之 收 信 處 理 〇 填 寫 本 V 回 到 第 4 4 圈 ί 步 驟 4 5 6以後之處理是對通常郵件之收 頁 &gt;—^ 1 信 郵 件 所 施 行 者 〇 1 1 在 步 驟 4 5 6, 檢査RAM f) 1内 之 郵 件 待 命 區 域 5 假 如 在 郵 1 I 件 待 命 區 域 收 納 有 郵 件 時, 就 刖 進 到 步 驟 4 5 7〇 另- -方 1 訂 而 假 如 在 郵 件 待 命 區 域小 存 在 有 郵 件 時 9 就 結 束 此 次 1 之 收 信 處 理 〇 1 I 從 步 驢 4 5 7到步驟4 6 1 (第4 m ) 之 處 理 為 9 用 於 檢 查 收 1 1 I 信 郵 件 是 否 為 對 BE 被 收 納在 郵 件 待 命 區 域 之 郵 件 (以下 1 稱 為 待 命 郵 件 )而容許變更會議開辦的預定時間之郵件。 、\) I 在 步 驟 4 5 7, 1 賨出- -件待命郵件之内容。 1 1 在 步 驟 4 5 8 , 將收信郵件和待命郵件的發出人之郵件 1 位 址 加 以 hh 較 5 假 如 郵 件位 置 相 同 時 就 前 進 到 步 驟 4 G 1 1 (第4 7圖) 〇 另 一 方 而 j 假如 郵 件 位 址 不 同 時 就 前 進 到 步 1 1 驟 4 f 9 〇 1 在 步 驟 4 5 9 , 檢査是否存在有尚未進行前步驟郵件位 1 I 址 之 比 較 的 待 命 郵 件 9 假如 殘 留 有 尚 未 進 行 bb 較 的 待 命 1 1 -69- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X 297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ) 1 1 郵 件 時 就 前 進 到 步驟4 6 0。 另- -方 面 9 假 如就 所 有 的待 1 1 命 郵 件 都 做 過 m 步驟之比 較 時 ,就結束此次之收信處理。 1 I 在 步 驟 4 (] π, 讀出殘留件中之一 件 待 命 郵件 之 内 容, /·-N 請 1 先 1 同 到 步 驟 4 5 8, 重複進行比較處理 〇 閱 I Λ 1 I 移 到 第 4 7 W 5 在步驟4G 1撿査在 收 信 郵 件中 是 否 包含 背 面 1 1 之 1 有 電 子 郵 件 裝 貫 2 1 A之固有密碼, 假 如 包 含有 密 碼 時, 注 意 1 1 就 前 進 到 步 驟 4 G 2。另一方而, 假 如 未 包 含有 密 碼 時就 事 項 1 I 再 1 回 到 步 驟 4 5 9 ( 第 44圖)0 填 寫 本 k 在 步 驟 4 0 2, 根據與步驟4 58之收信郵件比較的結果, 頁 '---, ί 辨 明 該 郵 件 位 址 為相同的 待 命 郵件之内容,以重新製成 1 1 行 程 資 料 » 接 箸 在步驟4 6 3 , 將其 收 納 在 RAM6 1之行程區 I 1 域 内 與 讓 開 辦 預定日對 應 之 領域〇 1 訂 在 步 驟 4 6 4, 以收信到的行程郵 件 之 發 出人 的 郵 件位 1 址 作 為 收 信 人 9 使用被收 納 在 第2 (b )圖所示的R. A Μ 6 1内 1 I 之 定 形 郵 件 儲 存 區域之定 形 郵 件A r 來 製 成電 子 郵 件。 1 1 第 4 8 圖 表 示 定 形 郵件A之 内 容 。定形郵件A是用來通知 1 行 程 郵 件 之 發 出 人,乃是 通 知 從被記載於行程郵件之時 j 間 帶 變 更 為 記 載 於使用定 形 郵 件c 所製成之郵件的時間 1 1 帶 而 將 η 議 預 定登記在 行 程 表者, 會議之主辦人(行程 1 郵 件 之 發 出 人 )可確認該會議的開 辦 時 間 之變 更 已 確實 1 被 傳 達 的 同 時 且可獲得 議 之參加確認。 1 1 在 步 驟 4 0 5, 在電子郵件所記載 之 定 形 郵件 A 之 本文 1 1 中 (第4 8画之本文中之圓圈和三 1角 形 記 號 之位 置 ), 記載 I I 被 收 納 在 待 命 郵 件之舉辦 時 間 Ο 1 1 -7 0 - 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS〉A4規格(2H)X297公釐) 五、發明説明(W ) 驟制 步控 4 在信驟 通步 部 從 件 7J 0 將由寺 α·η·1/ϋι N't&quot; 用 使 0 命 A7 B7 成W驟 製 Φ步 所Η據 Α 電 : 件L除 郵 ί.言、ν 形Η中 定 5 域 從在 件 , 郵1A 子I 電 之 料 資 A,程 11行 部中 2 務 6 Λ4- 艮 月 m: 理 處' 信 收 之 次 此 束 結 後 然 , 理 件處 郵除 命消 待件 之郵 理命 處待 成 · 明 說 將 而 下圖 驟 步 中 画 程 流 ? 之理 理處 處除 本消 基件 之郵 項命 .待 I之 1T //1 實 所 第 除 4 消 4. 件驟 郵步 命的 待中 該圖 稈 從 由 藉 是 fTM i 理 處 驟 步 到 第 圖 流收 的被 理於 處對 信 , 收理 之處 項之 (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) W衣. 件. 郵 命 待 之 間 時 白 之 fi ir Μ 料 RΑ資 在程 納行 為 更 變 被 間 時 辦 開 議 會 的 域 區 命 待 件 郵 之 内 始 開 議 會 該 了 到 使 即 更不 變更 間變 時之 辦.間 開時 議辦 會開 應議 答會 到斷 信判 收就 未 , 因時 ,納 刻收 時被 始然 開仍 之而 後件 更郵 變的 應 答 C 被理 除 刪 而 因 處 除 消 以 加 而 件 郵 命 待 該 用 不 已 為 第 明 説 將 而 下 0 圖 程 流 之 理 處 除 消 件 郵 命 0 待圖 是程 圖流 2 -5 之 第 _ 2 5 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 4 件 驟郵 步命 在待 ,有 先在 首存 否 另 而 方 是步 t 域到Μ 區進1§ 命前&amp; 就 待就Η 诗 件時Μ 郵在if ff 之存Η , 命 内件 —1 € 6 ΪΚ Μ6有 RA/叩在 寺 * * 一仔 SM 不 檢&quot;如. ,«假 容 内 之 件 郵 命 待 件 。出 理 處讀 除 2 7 消 4 命驟 待步 之在 次 驟驟 步步 在藉 和 第 曰時 時在 始.現 開之 之得 議取 會所 的理 載處 記測 所ΪΙ 件刻 郵時 命之 寺 &gt; /2Ί 該 將 圖 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4祝格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( rp ) 1 1 闩 加 以 比 較 &gt; 假 如 現 在 時 Η 超 過 待 命 郵 件 所 記 載 之 E3 議 1 1 之 開 始 時 者 就 刖 進 到 步 驟 4 7 4 , 從郵件待命區域中 1 1 消 除 該 待 命 郵 件 之 後 « 刖 進 到 步 驟 4 7 5 〇 另- -方面, 假 /、 請 1 先 1 如 現 在 時 R 尚 未 超 過 待 命 郵 件 所 記 載 的 宵 議 之 開 始 時 B 閱 讀 1 者 就 m 不 作 動 地 直 接 刖 進 到 步 驟 4 7 5〇 背 I | 之 1 在 步 驟 4 7 5 , 以眈次之待命郵件消除處理, 檢査在郵 注 意 I I 件 待 命 ΤπΤ ΕΪ5 域 是 否 殘 留 有 尚 未 進 行 步 驟 4 7 3之判斷處理的 事 項 1 I 1 ,卜 待 叩 郵 件 9 假 如 部 待 命 郵 件 都 已 做 過 判 斷 處 理 時 就 填 寫 本 k 結 束 此 次 之 待 命 郵 件 消 除 處 理 0 另 —* 方 面 9 假 如 判 斷 處 頁 '—^ I 理 尚 未 兀 成 而 仍 留 有 待 命 郵 件 時 ) 就 回 到 步 驟 47 2, 重複 1 1 進 行 上 述 之 處 理 〇 1 | 1 7 第 1 實 施 形 態 之 變 化 例 I 訂 在 以 上 所 說 明 之 第 1 實 施 形 態 中 * 使 用 行 程 郵 件 作 為 1 要 求 宵 議 的 行 程 登 錄 之 郵 件 9 在 收 信 顯 示 處 理 和 收 信 處 1 | 理 等 使 用 旗 標 SC F用來識別行程郵件和通常郵件, 但是 1 作 為 變 化 例 乃 將 郵 件 本 文 中 包 含 特 定 密 碼 之 電 子 郵 件 作 1 為 行 程 郵 件 理 與 通 常 郵 件 之 識 別 即 視 宜 本 文 中 是 否 ί 存 在 有 該 特 定 密 碼 而 為 之 〇 1 1 1 而 目. , 在 收 信 處 理 上 雖 構 成 為 9 將 收 信 到 之 郵 件 全 部 1 1 收 纳 在 收 信 郵 件 區 域 9 但 是 就 包 含 有 已 兀 成 行 程 登 錄 1 之 乂、 議 預 定 之 行 程 郵 件 判 斷 為 已 不 需 保 存 , 而 在 定 形 郵 1 1 件 A 或 B 之 發 倍 後 9 從 收 信 郵 件 區 域 中 消 除 該 行 程 郵 件 1 1 亦 可 〇 而 目. 在 考 慮 到 收 倍 郵 件 區 域 之 記 億 容 量 時 &gt; 亦 1 I 可 構 成 為 只 限 於 收 信 郵 件 區 域 之 空 白 容 量 比 指 定 值 較 少 1 1 -7 2- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210父29?公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明( 7 1 1 | 的 的 場 合 才 賁 行 此 消 除 處 理 〇 1 1 1 於 是 將 相 當 於 本 第 1 實 施 形 態 所 說 明 之 各 處 理 流 程 1 I 围 的 步 驟 記 逑 的 電 子 郵 件 處 理 程 式 預 先 記 錄 在 電 腦 可 請 Aj 1 1 讀 取 之 記 錄 媒 p 9 將 該 記 錄 媒 體 所 包 含 之 電 子 郵 件 處 理 閱 讀 背 1 I 程 式 裝 載 在 電 腦 主 記 億 器 上 9 亦 可 用 來 實 施 本 發 明 Ο 面 之 1 注 1 亦 即 9 m 將 程 式 記 錄 在 以 通 用 之 個 人 電 腦 或 字 處 理 機 意 事 1 等 裝 置 驅 動 之 記 錄 媒 體 9 而 將 該 等 通 用 裝 置 作 為 電 子 郵 項 再 娘 1 i 件 裝 置 動 作 〇 上 述 程 式 所 包 含 之 步 驟 有 : 電 子 郵 件 收 信 寫 本 (' 1 步 驟 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 9 行 程 資 料 記 億 步 驟 , 用 來 記 頁 r 1 億 行 程 資 料 9 行 程 郵 件 辨 別 步 驟 9 用 來 辨 別 藉 上 逑 電 子 1 1 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 所 收 信 到 之 電 子 郵 件 是 否 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 1 I 之 行 程 郵 件 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 9 當 m 由 上 逑 之 行 程 郵 1 訂 件 辨 別 步 驟 辨 別 為 上 述 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 所 收 信 到 之 電 1 I 子 郵 件 為 行 程 郵 件 時 就 將 上 逑 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 1 1 資 料 和 上 述 行 程 資 料 記 億 步 驟 所 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 比 1 1 較 檢 測 該 兩 行 程 資 料 間 有 無 重 複 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 ! 步 驟 » 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 之 fcb 較 m 撿 測 到 上 Ί 述 兩 個 行 程 資 料 間 並 Μ 重 複 時 9 就 藉 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 記 1 1 億 步 驟 記 億 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 9 電 子 郵 l· I 件 動 發 信 步 驟 &gt; 用 來 白 動 發 信 電 子 郵 件 , 第 一 電 子 郵 1 i 件 自 動 發 信 步 驟 9 藉 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 之 比 較 1 I m 撿 測 到 上 逑 兩 個 行 程 資 料 間 有 重 複 時 具 有 避 免 上 述 1 Ι 重 複 的 行 程 變 更 有 關 之 資 訊 的 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 給 上 述行 1 1 程 郵 件 之 發 信 人 和 變 更 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 m 由 1 1 Γ ?3· 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(P ) 上述電子郵件自動發信步驟發送具有上逑資訊之資料郵 件後,因應具有該資訊之電子郵件,能避免上述重複般 通知變更上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料的上述電子郵 件,藉收信步驟收到時,就以上述行程資料記憶步驟記 億根據上述資訊被變更之上述行程郵件所包含之行程資 料。 第53圖表示記錄有電子郵件程式之電腦可讀取之記錄 媒體之實例。如該圖所示,作為電腦可讀取之記錄媒體 ,可使用在電腦50】之内部或外加所具備之ROM或硬碟等 記憶裝置5 02,或電腦501所具備之讀取裝置可讀取之軟 碟、Μ 0、C 1) - R () Μ、D V丨)-R 0 Μ等可攜帶之記錄媒體5 0 3,或 可以是從電腦5 01經由網路5 0 4卸載之程式服務部5 0 5内 之記憶裝置。另外,亦可構成為分割該電子郵件處理之 程式,將其分散的記錄在該等可讀取之多數記錄媒體, 而因應電腦5 (Π之主記億器從各記錄媒體將該程式卸載 而實行之。 上述第ί實施形態之電子郵件裝置和被記錄在記錄媒 體之電子郵件處理之程式,若接受到包含有項目預定之 電子郵件時,就自動進行行程登錄的同時,且與其他登 錄過之項目若發生重複時,就自動進行行程之調整,所 以可得到裝置之使用者就有關行程不需任何麻煩之效 果。 1 8 .第2實施形態 下面將説明本發明之第2實施形態。 -7 4 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4祝格(210X297公釐) (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 、1Τ 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(W ) 第2實施形態之R A Μ 6之記憶内容與第1實施形態者 相同。另外,在第7 _所示之C P U 5 1之主流程中,除了 待命郵件消除處理外,其他之處理也和第2實施形態相 同。另外,第2實施形態之收信顯示處理與第8圖〜第 1 〇圖所示之第1實施形態之收信顯示處理之流程相同, 而Μ ,在第9圖之收信顯示處理中,步驟1 3 4之行程顯示 處理亦與第15_〜第18_所示之流.程相同。但是,第17 圖之行程顯示處理中之步驟2 ϋ G之行程登錄處理,和步驟 208之行程詳細顯示處理與第1實施形態不同。另外, 主流程中之收信處理與第1實施形態不同。從而,在第 2實施形態中,其與第1實施形態相同之處理和相同之 顯示害而即沿用第1實施形態之圖面,同時,其重複之 說明從略,而只說明與第1實施形態不同之處理。 1 3 .行程顯示處理 第5 4圖〜第5 6 _是第2實施形態之行程登錄處理之流 程。而且,第5 7 _是行程追加登錄之畫面。第1 9圔藉行 程顯示處理之畫面中,當滑鼠用游標在「登錄」顯示之 部份時,在滑鼠3 1被施加喀喔操作之場合,就實行該行 程登錄處理。在第5 4圖中,清除R Α Μ β 1之行程製成區域 (步驟5 0 (1 ),顯示行程追加登錄之框畫面(步驟5 0 1 )。然 後,根據行程製成區域顯示輸入區域(步驟5 0 2 )。其次, 在第57圖所示之行程追加登錄書面顯示滑鼠用游標(步 驟5 0 3},辨別滑鼠;Η是否被移動(步驟5 G 4 )。當滑鼠3 1 -75- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4祝格(210Χ297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) J衣_ 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( 74· ) 1 1 已 被 移 動 時 就 因 應該移 動 來 移 動游 標 位置 (步驟5 0 5 )。 ! 1 其 次 &gt; 辨 別 滑 鼠 3 1是否 被 喀 m 操作 (步驟5 06), 若被 1 ! 喀 曠 時 就 辨 別 游 標 位置是 否 在 第 5 7圖 畫 面之 取消 開關的 /·-V 請 1 先 1 位 賈 (步驟5 0 7 )〇 若為該位置之場合, 就清除行程製成 閲 讀 1 區 域 (步驟5 08 ), 清除顯示(步 驟 5 0 9 ) &gt; 然後 結束 該行程 脊 面 1 | 之 1 追 加 登 綠 處 理 之 流 稈。 注 意 1 | 在 步 驟 5 0 6中, 若滑鼠3 1未被喀暱操作的場合, 就在 事 項 1 I 再 1 1-.. 第 5 5 圖 &gt; 辨 別 游 標 位置是 否 在 第 5 7圖 畫 面之 登錄 開關之 瑱 寫 本 k 位 置 (步驟5 1 0 )0 在是該位置之情況時, 就參照指定年 頁 、✓ 1 | 月 Η 之 行 S0 1·王 區 域 内 之資料 (步驟5 11)0 然而, 辨別在與 1 1 迫 加 之 行 程 柑 同 之 時間帶 是 否 有 其他 行 程重 複(步驟5 1 2 ) ί 1 〇 若 並 無 重 複 時 就辨別 是 否 没 有下 一 値之 資料 (步驟 ι 訂 5 13) 〇 若 有 下 個 資料之 場 合 &gt; 就轉 移 到步 驟51 2,辨 1 別 時 間 帶 之 重 複 » 若無下 一 個 資 料之 場 合, 就將 行程製 1 I 成 區 域 之 資 料 儲 存 在指定 月 B (步驟5 ]4 ),而清除顯示 1 I (步驟5 15 )。 1 1 其 次 &gt; 將 行 程 製 成區域 之 議 名稱 開議 曰時 、參加 1 j :±L· 姓 名 9 特 記 事 項 等寫入 定 形 郵 件A 之 本文 内(步驟516 ) 1 〇 第 58 圖 表 示 定 形 郵件A 之 畫 而 〇接 著 ,指 定参 加者中 1 ι » 之 一 人 (步驟5 1 7 ), 以該参加者之郵件位址作為定形郵 1 件 Α之收信人(步 驟 518)。 妖 /\\\ 後 將該 参 加者 之郵 件位址 I I 儲 存 在 R. A M G 1之參加者區域(步 驟 5 1 9 ) 0 1 1 在 步 驟 5 ] η, 當游標位置不在登錄開關之位置, 而且 1 I 也 不 在 第 5 7 圖 之 其 他圖符 開 關 位 置時 J 就轉 移到 第54圖 1 1 -7 6- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4^格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7TtO processing. First, at step 4 2], the R period display of the frame of the travel date digraph shown in FIG. 19 is eliminated, and second, at step 4 2 2, the year and month display at the upper part of the frame of the R calendar displayed by the drawing is eliminated. Part of the specified year and month display. In step 4 2 3, advance the specified year and month by one month, and end this time. -63- This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 X 297 mm) —1 ^ — ml tnn me n II 1 = ° 4 (read the precautions on the back and then fill out this page) Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of invention (h) Month display processing, and return to itinerary display processing. The following will describe the display processing of the previous month, the processing of steps 4 2 6 to 4 2 7 of the previous month display processing, and the processing of steps 4 2 1 to 422 of the next month display processing are the same, except for the previous month. The display processing step 42 8 is different from the next month display processing step 4 2 3. In step 428, the specified year and month are returned to the next month, the current previous month display processing is ended, and then the itinerary display processing is returned. 1 5. Receiving processing Next, it is intended to describe the receiving processing performed in step 102 (7th _) of the flowchart of the basic processing of item 1. Receiving processing is to confirm the registered itinerary when receiving the mail for the itinerary for the itinerary registration of the conference. Therefore, for the time zone for holding a conference, if there is a gap in the registered trip, the conference reservation for the conference is registered. For the time zone of the conference, if it overlaps with the registered itinerary, send a fixed email to the sender of the itinerary email to notify the same day as the meeting and a blank time zone. The meeting time zone is changed to this blank time zone. Then, if the e-mail being sent is re-received, an e-mail message indicating that the meeting time can be changed to a blank time zone is used to register the changed meeting time. Like this, the reception processing can realize a large feature related to the present invention. Figures 44, 45, 4G, and 47 are flowcharts of the receiving process. The flowchart will be described below. First in Figure 44, the process from step 431 to step 436 is to reconnect-4-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this Page) J. Order A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (W) Accepted by e-mail. In step 4 3], access to the email service department 1 1 a and check whether there is a newly arrived mail. If there is a newly arrived mail, proceed to step 4 3 2. On the other hand, if it does not exist When there is a newly arrived mail, the receiving process will be terminated. In step 4 2 2, check whether there is a blank area in the receiving mail area in RA Μ 61 to accommodate all new mail. If there is a blank area, Zone, proceed to step 4 3 4 without any action. On the other hand, if there is not enough blank space left, proceed to step 4 3 3, and delete the earliest mail from the received mail in the received mail stored in the received mail area to ensure a blank area. After that, return to step 4 3 2 and repeat the survey process of the blank area. At step 4 3 4, unload one new incoming mail from the email service department U Α and store it in the blank area of the receiving mail area. At step 4 3 5, it will be used to indicate the received mail. The flag KAIFU of the received mail is set to "0" (unopened) and stored, and the measurement is performed at step 4 3 6 at the time of step 1 fl 1 (picture 7) in the flowchart of basic processing. The current date and time is obtained as the mail receiving time, and it is stored in the mail receiving area. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the notes on the back before filling out this page). At step 4 3 7, check whether the received mail is the flag SCF of the itinerary. SCF is "0", that is, if the received mail is a normal mail, it proceeds to step 4 5 6; on the other hand, if SCF is not &quot; 〇 ", that is, when the received mail is an itinerary mail, then Proceed to step 4 3 8 (Figure 4 5). -6 5-This paper size applies Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Staff Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (^ 4 *) 1 1 Move to Figure 4 5 and the process from step 4 3 8 to step 42 2 is used to check 1 1 杳 Whether it has been scheduled with the received itinerary email has been scheduled to repeat 1 1 Registered F = T to discuss the existence of a scheduled existence. ^ —V Please! First 1 First, in step 4 38, from the travel area of RA Μ 1 to retrieve and record 1 I The itinerary contained in the receipt mail Registered back-to-back 1 I-1 past itinerary data on the same date as the meeting date. Note 1 1 event 1 in step 4 3 9. If the result obtained from the previous step is stored, the entry will be reopened for 1 golden year and month. When itinerary data for the same period, proceed to step 4 4 0. 1 book 1 on the other hand) If there is no travel page V ._ ^ 1 on the same date as the meeting year, month and day, I proceed with Go to Step 4 4 3. Look at 1 I At Step 4 4 〇, read 岀--the registered travel information of the same date as the date of the conference 1 1 at the start of the meeting, and check the travel information in step 4 4 1 9 1 Check whether the start time zone included in the negotiation (1 period from the start time to the end time), and whether the start time zone of the meeting recorded in the itinerary email is repeated. 1 1 S If the call is not restored, proceed to step 4 42 9 On the other hand, if there is 1 I repeated, proceed to step 4 4 7 (4th (5 strokes) 〇1 1 In step 44 2, check the travel information on the same date obtained in step 4 3 8. Check whether the meeting time has been repeated in the previous steps. If the time has been repeated, check if the travel information has been repeated. Go to step 4 4 3. 1 I I The other party will discuss if there is any itinerary data that has not been rechecked yet. 15 Respond to step 4 4 0 and perform an electrical recheck on the remaining travel data. 1 I In step 4 4 3, according to the content of the received itinerary mail, re-create 1 1 into the itinerary data, and then in step 4 4 4 collect the created itinerary data 1 1 into the R AMC 1 itinerary Areas in the area corresponding to the scheduled conference start date. 1 I -6 6- 1 1 1 This paper size applies Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (K) In step 4 4 5 the sender of the mail received from the itinerary The mail address is used as the recipient, and the fixed mail B stored in the fixed mail storage area in R AM 6 1 shown in FIG. 2 (b) is used to create an email. Then, in step 4 4 6, The e-mail is transmitted from the communication control unit 26 to the e-mail service unit 11A via the LAN 5, and then the reception processing is terminated. Here, a fixed mail refers to an e-mail constituted with certain information including the contents of the e-mail. In this embodiment, it means that the name of the e-mail is determined in advance, and the body of the mail is composed of a predetermined article. Figures 4 and 9 show the contents of the fixed mail B. The fixed mail B is used to inform the sender of the travel mail that the schedule of the meeting held in the travel mail has been registered. Move to Figure 4 6 and follow Step 4 4 1 (Figure 4 5) and the processing from Step 4 4 7 to Step 4 5 5 is to start the registered trip (from the start time to the end time) During the period), it will be dealt with in the case where there is overlap with the start time of the meeting recorded in the itinerary. Printed by the Staff Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 1 .-------- .. 11 (Please note this page and fill in this page again) In step 4 4 7 from the itinerary area of ϋ A Μ 6 1 read out the content of the itinerary data which is identified as a repeat time zone and the same date as the registered itinerary data. On the same day, search for a blank time zone (blank time zone). In step 448, if there is a blank time zone, proceed to step 4 4 9. On the other hand, if there is no blank time zone, Proceed to step 4 5 4. In step 4 4 9, store the received travel itinerary in the mail standby area in R. Α M (Π shown in country 2 (a), and in step 4 5 0, Change the schedule of the conference mail stored in the mail standby area to step -6 7- This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (yy) 1 1 44 7 1 1 1 At step 4 5 1, use the mail address of the sender of the received itinerary as the recipient 1 1 1 &gt; Use the EAM6 shown in Figure 2 (b) 1 Please set the shape mail C in the shape mail storage area of 1 1 to create an e-mail. 0 5 0 Read 1 Figure 1 shows the contents of the shape mail C. The shape mail C is used to notify the line 1 of the note. Issuer &gt; Because there is registered itinerary information »Intention 1 Although the scheduled time zone for the meeting that is recorded in the itinerary email cannot be entered again, fill in the registration but 9 If the time zone for the meeting is changed For recording in the post The time zone informs the itinerary post page of the items that can be registered for the itinerary. ^ 1 The sender of the document 〇 1 I In step 4 5 2, in the post 1 of the fixed mail C recorded in the e-mail (page 50) ) The position of the circle and triangle in the text column of this text), record the beginning time 1 1 time and end time 0 1 1 in step 4 5 0 of the blank time zone stored in the mail standby area. The e-mail created using the fixed mail C is sent from the 1 1 communication control unit 2 6 to the e-mail service department 1 1 A via LA Ν 5, and the reception process is finished after the demon 1. In addition, at this time, in the text of the fixed email containing 'J1' in the e-mail (1 | SB. Of the black dot mark in the text box of Fig. 50), the e-mail device 21 A's fixed password is recorded. I The other party, after step 4 4 8 Step 4 54 »Use the mail address of the sender of the mail received on line 1 as the recipient &gt; Use it stored in 1 I Figure 2 (h) The fixed mail D in the fixed mail area in R. A Μ 6 丨 is shown as 1 1 and made into an e-mail. The 5th _ indicates the content of the fixed mail D. 0 The fixed mail 1 1 piece D is used to notify the sender of the travel mail. Because in the itinerary of the itinerary 1 I -68 &quot; 1 1 1 1 This paper size is applicable to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Economic, which is printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards y7) There is a registered ua m schedule at the scheduled time recorded in the 1 1 record. Therefore, 1 1 can be registered &gt; and Μ 5 will be scheduled for the conference. Μ y \\\ can attend 1! The blank time with the notice to the sender of the itinerary email. • During the itinerary, read ~~, read 1 The recipient of the first 1 mail does not know that there is no blank space, but when you start the ^ 9 meeting, you can read 1 change when you start the operation to prevent lh. The operation is futile -frrr Μ 〇 〇 1 1 At step 4 5 will use the fixed mail I) The created e-mail is sent from the attention 1 1 to the communication control unit 20 via LAN 5 to the e-mail service department 11 A, and then the event 1 I and then *. End the receiving process this time. Fill out this V Back Circle 4 4 ί The processing after steps 4 5 6 is the page receiving of normal mails>-^ 1 The mail mailer is executed 〇 1 1 In step 4 5 6, check the RAM f) 1 in the mail standby area 5 if When there is a mail in the standby area of the mail 1 piece, it proceeds to step 4 5 7〇 Another-Party 1 orders and if there is a mail in the mail standby area small 9 ends the reception processing of this time 1 〇1 I The processing from step donkey 4 5 7 to step 4 6 1 (the 4th m) is 9 for checking whether the received 1 1 I letter is a mail that is stored in the mail standby area for the BE (hereafter 1 is called standby) Mail) and allow you to change the scheduled mail for the conference. , \) I In step 4 5 7, 1, press out--the contents of the standby message. 1 1 In step 4 5 8, add the address 1 of the sender's mail and the standby mail to hh than 5. If the mail position is the same, proceed to step 4 G 1 1 (Fig. 4 7). j If the mail address is different, go to step 1 1 Step 4 f 9 〇1 In step 4 5 9, check if there are any standby mails that have not been compared with the previous mail address 1 I address 9 If there are still not yet bb More standby 1 1 -69- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X 297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention () 1 1 For mail, proceed to step 4 6 0. On the other hand, if you have done the m-step comparison for all the messages that are waiting for 1 1 life, the process of receiving the mail will end. 1 I In step 4 (] π, read out the contents of one of the remaining mails, / · -N Please 1 first 1 Same as step 4 5 8, repeat the comparison process. 〇 I Λ 1 I move to the 4 7 W 5 In step 4G 1 check whether the received mail contains the back side 1 1 1 There is an inherent password for the email 2 2 A. If the password is included, note 1 1 and proceed to step 4 G 2 On the other side, if the password is not included, please proceed to 1 1 and 1 again to step 4 5 9 (Figure 44) 0 Fill out this k in step 4 0 2 and compare it with the received mail in step 4 58 , Page '---, ί Identifies that the mail address is the same as the content of the standby mail to re-create 1 1 itinerary information »Then in step 4 6 3, store it in the travel area I 1 of the RAM 6 1 The field corresponding to the scheduled start date is set at step 4 6 4 The mail address 1 of the sender of the received itinerary mail is used as the receiver 9. The fixed mail A r stored in the fixed mail storage area of 1 I in R. A Μ 6 1 shown in FIG. 2 (b) is used. Figure 1 shows the contents of the fixed mail A. The fixed mail A is used to notify the sender of 1 itinerary, but to notify the change from the time zone j recorded in the itinerary to the record. At the time of the mail created by using the fixed mail c, 1 1 If the η conference is scheduled to be registered in the itinerary, the organizer of the meeting (the sender of the itinerary 1 mail) can confirm that the change in the start time of the meeting has been confirmed1 At the same time, the confirmation of participation can be obtained. 1 1 At step 4 0 5 in the text 1 of the fixed mail A recorded in the e-mail (the circle of the text drawn in the text of the 8th and the triangle of the triangle). Location), record the time when II was stored in the standby mail 〇 1 1 -7 0- 1 1 1 This paper size applies Chinese national standard (CNS> A4 size (2H) X297mm) V. Description of invention (W) Step control 4 In the step of the letter, follow 7J 0 1 / ϋι N't &quot; Use 0 to make A7 B7 into W to make the step Η According to the electricity A: In addition to the post, the 5 domains are defined in the form, the post 1A, the sub-I will be called Materials A, Cheng 11, Department 2, Service 6 Λ4- Gen Yue m: The processing department's receipt of this time will be completed, and the processing department will post the order. And in the figure below, the process flow is drawn? The reason is to delete the post items of the consumer base. Wait for the 1T // 1 of the real thing to be removed 4 to cancel the 4. The post is waiting for the picture. The figure is borrowed from the fTM i. The letter in the figure is handled by the letter, and the place where it is received (read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) W clothing. Pieces. Fi ir Μ 料 Α white when waiting for the mail In the event that Cheng Na's behavior has changed, the parliamentary office of the parliamentary office is waiting for the post to open the parliament. It is time to make the parliament even more unchanged. It is not until the acceptance is judged. Because of this, the response C, which was originally opened at the time of receipt, was postponed. The response C was removed, deleted and added because of the cancellation. It is stated that the next step is to remove the postal order of the 0 map process flow. 0 The map is the 2nd to 5th of the process map. _ 2 5 The 4th order of the Central Consumers Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs, the Consumer Cooperatives, is printing 4 pieces of postal orders, which are waiting. Have you saved in the first place, and then you have to go from the t domain to the M area? Before the death & just wait for the poems, Μ post it in if ff, 内 内 件 —1 € 6 ΪΚ Μ6 has RA / 叩 在 寺 * * 一 仔 SM not checked &quot; eg., «Pretend The contents are on standby. Read from the source 2 7 Cancel 4 The next step is to wait for the next step to borrow and the first time. At the beginning of the meeting, you can pick up the club's office at the time of postage. Temple of Life &gt; / 2Ί The paper size of this drawing applies to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (RP) 1 1 Latch Compare &gt; If the current time exceeds the start of E3 protocol 1 1 recorded in the standby email, proceed to step 4 7 4, after removing the standby email from the email standby area 1 1 «proceed to step 4 7 5 〇 Another--leave /, please 1 first 1 if the current time R has not exceeded the beginning of the discussion recorded in the standby email B read 1 if you do not move directly to step 4 7 50 | No. 1 In step 4 7 5, follow the next step to eliminate the mail, check the post Note whether there are any remaining items in the standby TπΤ ΕΪ5 domain that have not yet undergone the judgment and processing of steps 4 7 3 1 I 1 and the pending mail 9 If all the standby mails have been judged, fill out this k to end the standby. E-mail elimination processing 0 Another — * Aspect 9 If it is judged that the page is' — ^ I has not been completed but there are still standby mails), go back to step 47 2 and repeat 1 1 to perform the above processing 〇 1 | 1 7 No. 1 Modification of the implementation mode I It is set in the first embodiment described above * Use itinerary mail as 1 Email for registration of the itinerary required to be discussed 9 Use the flag SC F at the reception display processing and reception office 1 | processing, etc. It is used to identify itinerary mail and normal mail, but 1 as a variation is an email containing a specific password in the body of the mail as 1 The document management and the identification of ordinary mail are based on whether or not the specific password exists in this article. It is for the purpose of 0 1 1 1. Although it is composed of 9 in the reception processing, all the received mails are stored in 1 1 Receiving mail area 9 However, it contains the registered mail of itinerary 1 and it is judged that it is no longer necessary to save the mail. It is 9 times from the receiving mail area after sending 1 or A or B of the fixed mail. It is also possible to eliminate the mail 1 1 in this schedule. When considering the doubled capacity of the mail area, it is also possible to limit the blank capacity of the mail area to less than the specified value. 1 1- 7 2- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210 father 29? Mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (7 1 1 | Occasionally do this In addition to processing, 0 1 1 1 is recorded in advance in the e-mail processing program corresponding to the steps of each processing flow 1 I described in this first embodiment on a computer. The recording medium that can be read by Aj 1 1 is p 9 The e-mail processing and reading back included in the recording medium 1 The program is loaded on the computer's main memory device 9 It can also be used to implement the present invention 0 Aspect 1 Note 1 That is, 9 m The program is recorded on a general-purpose personal computer or computer. The processor intends to act as a device-driven recording medium 9 and use these general-purpose devices as electronic mail items and 1 device. The steps included in the above program are: E-mail written copy ('1 step to accept E-mail 9 Itinerary steps to record the travel information, used to record r 100 million Itinerary information 9 Itinerary identification step 9 is used to identify the borrowed electronic 1 1 post Whether the e-mail received in the receiving step contains itinerary information 1 I Itinerary mail Itinerary data comparison step 9 When m is from the previous itinerary mail 1 The order identification step is identified as the above-mentioned e-mail receiving step When the call arrives, the 1 I sub-mail is the itinerary mail. The itinerary 1 1 data included in the previous itinerary mail and the itinerary data recorded in the above 100 million steps are compared to 1 1 to check whether there is a duplication between the two itinerary data. The stroke data is recorded and controlled in 100 million steps! Step »From the above itinerary data fcb is compared to the step fcb and m, it is detected above. When the two itinerary data are repeated and M 9 is recorded, the above itinerary data is recorded. The itinerary information included in the mail 9 E-mail l · I mobile mail sending steps &gt; Used to send e-mails in white, 1 i mail automatically sent Letter Step 9: Using the comparison of the above-mentioned itinerary data comparison step 1 I m When it is detected that there is a duplication between the two itinerary data, an email with information related to avoiding the above 1 I duplicate itinerary change is sent to the above line 1 The sender of the 1-way email and the change of itinerary are recorded in 100 million control steps m by 1 1 Γ? 3 · 1 1 1 This paper size applies to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) Employees of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Printed by Consumer Cooperatives A7 B7 V. Description of the Invention (P) After the above automatic email sending step sends the information email with the listing information, the email with the information can avoid the above-mentioned repetitive notification to change the itinerary When the above email of the itinerary information is received by the borrowing and receiving step, the itinerary data contained in the above itinerary email that has been changed according to the above information is recorded in the above itinerary of the itinerary data storage step. Fig. 53 shows an example of a computer-readable recording medium having an electronic mail program recorded thereon. As shown in the figure, as a computer-readable recording medium, a memory device such as a ROM or a hard disk provided in the computer 50 or a computer 50 can be used, or a reading device provided in the computer 501 can be read. Floppy disk, Μ 0, C 1)-R () Μ, DV 丨) -R 0 Μ and other portable recording media 5 0 3, or can be a program service uninstalled from a computer 5 01 via the network 5 0 4 Memory device in the 505. In addition, it can also be constituted as a program that divides the e-mail processing, and records it dispersedly in most of these readable recording media, and responds to the uninstallation of the program from each recording medium by the computer 5 If the e-mail device according to the above-mentioned embodiment and the e-mail processing program recorded in the recording medium are received, if an e-mail containing a project reservation is received, itinerary will be automatically registered at the same time as other registrations. If the items are repeated, the stroke is automatically adjusted, so that the user of the device can obtain the effect of no trouble about the stroke. 1 8. 2nd Embodiment The second embodiment of the present invention will be described below. 7 4-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (Please read the notes on the back before filling this page), 1T Printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 5. Description of the invention (W) The memory content of the RA Μ 6 in the second embodiment is the same as that in the first embodiment. In addition, in the main flow of the CPU 51 shown in 7_ Except for the standby mail erasing process, other processes are the same as those in the second embodiment. In addition, the reception display process in the second embodiment is the same as the reception display in the first embodiment shown in FIGS. 8 to 10. The processing flow is the same, and in the reception display processing of FIG. 9, the travel display processing of step 1 3 4 is the same as the flow shown in 15_ ~ 18_. However, the travel of FIG. 17 In the display process, the itinerary registration process of step 2 ϋ G and the detailed display process of the itinerary of step 208 are different from the first embodiment. In addition, the reception process in the main flow is different from the first embodiment. Therefore, in the second implementation In the form, the same processing and the same display defects as in the first embodiment are used, and the drawing of the first embodiment is used. At the same time, the repeated description is omitted, and only the processes different from the first embodiment are described. 3. Itinerary display processing Figure 5-4 ~ 5 6 _ is the flow of the itinerary registration processing of the second embodiment. In addition, 5 7 _ is the screen for additional registration of the itinerary. The 19th screen of the itinerary display processing When the mouse is over the " In the part shown in the “Record”, when the mouse 3 1 is clicked, the stroke registration process is performed. In FIG. 54, the stroke creation area of R Α β β 1 is cleared (step 50). (1) Display a frame screen for additional registration of the itinerary (step 501). Then, create an input area based on the itinerary (step 502). Next, add a written registration slip on the itinerary shown in Figure 57 Mouse cursor (step 5 0 3), identify the mouse; whether the Η is moved (step 5 G 4). When the mouse 3 1 -75- This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 Zhuge (210 × 297 mm) ) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) J clothes _ Order A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (74 ·) 1 1 When it has been moved, it should be moved accordingly Cursor position (step 5 0 5). ! 1 Second &gt; Determine if mouse 3 1 is operated by click (step 5 06). If it is clicked, identify whether the cursor position is on the cancel switch of the picture in Fig. 5 / --V Please 1 first 1 bit (step 5 0 7). If it is the position, clear the stroke to create a reading 1 area (step 5 08), clear the display (step 5 0 9) &gt; and then end the stroke ridge surface 1 | 1 Added stalk for greening treatment. Note 1 | In step 5 06, if the mouse 3 1 is not operated by click, it is in item 1 I and then 1 1- .. Fig. 5 5 &gt; Determine whether the cursor position is in the picture of Fig. 5 7 K position of the copy switch of the registration switch (step 5 1 0) 0 If it is the position, refer to the specified year page, ✓ 1 | Month trip S0 1 · Data in the king area (step 5 11) 0 However, it is discriminated whether there are other itinerary repeats in the same time zone as the 1 1 forced addition itinerary (step 5 1 2) ί 1 〇 if there is no repeat, it is discriminated whether there is no next data (step ι order 5 13) 〇 If there is the next data, then go to step 51 2. Identify the repetition of the time zone. »If there is no next data, save the data of the itinerary system to the specified month B (step 5] 4), and 1 I is cleared (step 5 15). 1 1 Next> Enter the name of the area where the itinerary is to be created, open the date, and participate in 1 j: ± L. Name 9 Special notes, etc., are written in the body of Formed Mail A (step 516) 1〇 Figure 58 shows the shaped mail A picture of A. Then, one of the participants is designated (step 5 17), and the mail address of the participant is used as the recipient of one fixed mail A (step 518). Demon / \\\ store the participant's mail address II in the participant area of R. AMG 1 (step 5 1 9) 0 1 1 at step 5] η, when the cursor position is not in the position of the registration switch, and 1 I is not in the other icon switch position of Fig. 5 7 J will move to Fig. 54 1 1 -7 6- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 ^ grid (210X297 mm) Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7

五、發明説明(7M 之步驟5 0 1,辨別滑鼠3 1之移動。另外,在步驟5 1 2中, 若與想要迫加之行程相同時間帶重複有其他行程時,就實 行警告書面顯示處理(步驟5 2 0 )。該警告畫面顯示處理 是與第3 7圖所示之流程相同之處理。然後,轉移到第5 5 4 圖之步驟5 Π1 ,顯示行程追加登錄之框畫面。 在步驟5 1 9中,將郵件位址儲存在參加者區域之後, 就自動的發送第56圖中之定形郵件A (步驟52】.)。然後, 結束參加者之所有指定,辨別定形郵件A是否被發信(步 驟5 2 2 ),若所有的指定尚未結束時,就轉移到第5 5 _之 步驟517,指定下一锢參加者之一人。在第56圖之步驟522 中,當參加者之指定結束而定形郵件A已被發信時,就 將追加行程儲存區域之號碼設定在暫存器B (步驟5 2 3 )。 然後,結束該行程追加登錄處理之流程。 在第5 4 _之步驟5 fl β中,當滑鼠3 1未被喀喔操作時就 在第5 6圖之流程中辨別是否有資料輸入(步驟5 2 4 )。若 有資料輸入時,就將資料顯示於有文字游標之輸入區域 (步驟5 2 5 )。而目.,將資料儲存在與行程製成區域對應 之區域(步驟5 2 fi )。然後,結束該行程追加登錄處理之 流程。若在步驟5 2 4並無資料輸入之場合,就轉移到第 5 4圖之步驟5 0 4 ,用來辨別滑鼠3 1之移動。 20.彳了程詳細顯7F處理 第5 9圖〜第6 2圖是第1 7圖之行程顯示處理之步驟2 0 8 中行程詳細顯示處理之流程,第6 3圖是顯示有行程列表 之行程詳細顯示畫面(1),第64圖是顯示有各傾行程之 -7 7 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210Χ297公釐) ----------/ -- (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 、?τ 五、發明説明(外 A7 B7 8 2 5 驟 步 /V 示 顯 之 圖 9 )o第 (2除 而清 棗:, 示中 顯圖 ί 9 細 5 詳第 程在 行 示 之之 面程η) 畫行ί)( 框I1SC 的各示 示之顯 顯中序 細表依 詳列起 稈_=1 行行 η 之定從 日 指 , 驟 步 次 其 資 1 間 為時 定和 設稱 η 名 標議 指會 將步 以 5 步 用驟Μ π ο 使3) 示53: 顯驟 一 步 每k( 按數 e 大 1)最 53過 驟超 驟 歩 k 過 超 未 増 η 遞在 否 是 Π riM 辨 合 場 之 轉 就 J第 Γ13在 驟 , 步果 到結 移其 示 顯 來 用 料 資 間 時 和 稱 名 議 .會 之 和 稱 名 議 會 之 程 f /XI 各 示 顯 一 逐 而 * 之 圖 第 在 就 合 場 之 k 數 大 最 過 超 Π 當 中 3 3 0 5 料驟 資步 間在 時 示態 顯狀 而構 書此 之在 圖 〇 資 間 時 和 稱 名 議 會 之 程 f 有 所 之 0 之 表 列 程 1T /#1 之 示 顯 被 定 指 以 用 將 指 -----------rr--(請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) • J «ί I 、τV. Description of the invention (Step 501 of 7M, discerning the movement of mouse 31. In addition, if there is another itinerary in the same time zone as the itinerary in step 5 1 2, a written warning will be displayed. Processing (step 5 2 0). This warning screen display processing is the same as the flow shown in Fig. 37. Then, it moves to step 5 Π1 in Fig. 5 5 4 to display a frame screen for additional registration of the trip. In step 5 19, after the mail address is stored in the participant's area, the shaped mail A in Fig. 56 is automatically sent (step 52). Then, all the participants' designations are ended, and it is determined whether the shaped mail A is If it is sent (step 5 2 2), if all the designations have not been completed, it will move to step 517 of 5 5 _ to designate one of the next participants. In step 522 of FIG. 56, when the participant is When the designation ends and the fixed mail A has been sent, the number of the additional itinerary storage area is set in the register B (step 5 2 3). Then, the flow of the additional registration process of this itinerary is ended. In step 5 fl β, when mouse 3 1 is not clicked At the time of operation, identify whether there is data input in the flow of Figure 5 6 (step 5 2 4). If there is data input, display the data in the input area with text cursors (step 5 2 5). And the purpose. , Store the data in the area corresponding to the area created by the itinerary (step 5 2 fi). Then, end the flow of the additional registration process of the itinerary. If there is no data input in step 5 2 4, move to the 5th 4 The step 5 0 4 in the figure is used to identify the movement of the mouse 31. 20. The detailed display of the 7F process is shown in steps 5 9 to 62. Fig. 2 is the step 2 of the stroke display process in Fig. 17 The detailed process flow of the itinerary is shown in Fig. 6 and Fig. 6 is the detailed display screen of the itinerary with the itinerary list (1), and Fig. 64 is the image showing the inclination of each tilt. Specifications (210 × 297 mm) ---------- /-(Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page),? Τ V. Description of the invention (outside A7 B7 8 2 5 step / V Figure 9 of the display) o (2 in addition to the clear jujube :, the display of the display shows 9 9 5 details of the process in the process of showing the process η) draw the line ί) (The display order of each indication in the frame I1SC is shown in detail. The order is _ = 1 line and line η from the date index, and the next step is to set the time and set the name η. Step 5 will be used in 5 steps with step π ο so that 3) shows 53: the obvious step per k (by the number e is large 1) the most 53 oversteps 歩 k overstepped 増 η pass whether it is Π riM The turn of the field is on the 13th step of J. From the end to the end of the display, the display of the materials and the use of materials and names are discussed. The sum of the meeting and the name of the council f / XI shows each one and shows * one by one. Among the k-numbers in the joint field that are the most surpassing Π, 3 3 0 5 is expected to show the status of the time step and the structure of the book is shown in Figure 0 and the name of the council f. The display of the list of procedures 1T / # 1 is set to indicate the use of ----------- rr-(Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) • J «ί I , Τ

D 程 SC行 示面 顯上 轉最 反之 只表 ,列 4)示 3 I 5 顯 驟轉 步反 1(初 為最 定 , 設而 ,從 標 C 驟 畫 在 次 其 滑 示 顯 丄 而動 驟 步 標 游 用 被 I若 移位 被標 否游 是動 3 移 鼠而 滑勳 別移 辨該 ,應 β 因 3 尤 5 f 驟時 步動 ί移 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 驟k 5 (其.ΰ'. 置(ί 第 在 中 程 流 之 圖 鼠 滑 dy 0 辨 第 到 移 轉 就 時 0 喀 被 無 若 #:537 喀 驟 之 是 1 1 圖 3 5 是 5 置驟 位步 標ί 游 0 辨 就表 時列 喔程 喀行 被 β - C 有 S 若個 C 一 動何 移任 之之 31而 鼠畫 LT 3 滑 β 別第 辨在 而否 置 位 的 在 2 4 定 5 設驟 碼步 /(V 號} D 0 c /V s D 之 S 置示 位顯 標轉 游反 將只 就 , ,而 合然 場 〇 之1) 置54 位驟 該步 在ffl( 是標 〇 指 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(21〇χ297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(77 ) 。然而,轉移到第5 9 _之步驟5 3 7 ,用來辨別滑鼠3 1之 移動。 在第G Q圖之步驟5 4 0中,當游標位置並非S C I)之位置時 ,就辨別游標位置是否在畫面右上之3個圃符開關(結 束、刪除、詳細)中之刪除開關之位置(步驟5 4 3 )。是在 該位置之場合,就刪除被反轉顯示之S C I) ( m )之資料(步 驟4 4 ),對(A )闩之行程加以分類(步驟5 4 5 )。然而,清 除第6 3圖之顯示(步驟5 4 6 ),轉移到第5 9 _之步驟5 2 9 , 電新顯示(Μ日之行程框書面。在第6 0圖之步驟5 4 3中, 當游檫位置不在刪除開關之位置時,就辨別游標位置是 杏在第63圖棗面之結束開關位置(步驟5 4 7 )。是在該位 置的場合,就清除第β 3圖畫而之顯示(步驟5 4 8 ),而結 束該行程詳細顯示處理之流程。 在步驟5 4 7中,當游標位置不在結束開闋位置時,就 在第6 1圖之流程中,辨別游標位置是否在詳細開關之位 置(步驟5 4 9 )。假如不是在該位置時雖轉移到第5 9圏之 步驟5 3 7,而判別滑鼠之移動,若游標位置是在詳細開 關之位置時,就清除第(5 3圖畫而之顯示(步驟5 5 0 )。然 而,顯示第64圖所示之行程詳細顯示畫而(2),亦卽顯 示被反轉顯示之S C I) ( m )之行程詳細畫而(步驟5 5 1 )。 繼而,將滑鼠用游標顯示在第6 4圖之棗面(步驟5 5 2 ), 辨別滑鼠3 ]是否被移動(步驟5 5 3 )。若被移動之場合, 就因應該移動而移動游標位置(步驟5 5 4 )。其次,辨別 滑鼠:U是否被喀喔橾作(步驟5 5 5 ),若有被喀_時,就 -7 9 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(以) 辨別游標位置是否在第β 4圖畫而之2锢圖符開關(結束 ,刪除)中之結束開關位置(步驟5 5 6 ),假如是在該位置 時,就清除第β 4書面之顯示(步驟5 5 7 ),而結束該布程詳 細顯示處理之流程。 在步驟5 5 6中,假如游標位置並非結束開關位置時, 就在第G 2 _之流程中,辨別游標位置是否在第6 4圔畫面 之刪除開關之位置(步驟5 5 8 )〇並非該位置之場合,就 轉移到第(Π圖之步驟5 5 3來辨別滑鼠之移動。當游標位 置在刪除開關之位置時,就指定SCD(m)參加者中之一人 (步驟5 5 9 )。然而,以該參加者之郵件位址作為缺席通 知的定形郵件B之收信人(步驟5 6 0 )。第6 5圖表示定形 郵件B之畫而。 接箸,將S C 1) ( m )之資料寫入定形郵件B之本文(步驟 5 (Π ),自動的發送缺席之定形郵件B (步驟5 G 2 )。在這種 場合,當發信人為會議主辦人時就發送會議中止的定形 郵件B 〇其次,結束參加者全體人員之指定,而辨別定 形郵件B是否已被發信(步驟5 6 3 )。參加者全體人員之 指定尚未完成之場合,就轉移到步驟5 5 9來指定下一锢 参加者。在步驟5 6 3中,結束參加者全體人員之指定, 而定形郵件B已被發送給全體人員時,就消除S C D ( m )之 資料(步驟5 6 4 )而結束該行程詳細顯示處理。 2 1 .收倍處瑰 第fi R _是因應計時器中斷而實行之收信處理的流程。 在該處理中辨別是否有牧信郵件(步驟5 β 5 ),.若有收信 -80- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4祝格(210Χ297公釐) (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 」衣. 訂 A7 B7 五、發明説明(79 ) 郵件之場合,就辨別β AM 6 1之收信郵件區域有否空白(步 驟566)。若無空白時,就刪除最早的收信時日之郵件, 使該區域淨空(步驟5 6 7 ),而轉移到步驟5 6 6。其次,將 牧倍郵件儲存在收信郵件區域之空白區域(步驟5 6 8 )。 然而,在被儲存之收信郵件附加開封旗標K A I F U (= 0 )( 步驟5 6 9 ),在被儲存在收信郵件附加T I Μ E (收信時刻) (步驟 5 7 (1 )。 接著,辨別收信郵件之發信源位址是否在參加者位址 區域(步驟5 7 1 )。若發信源位址不在參加者位址區域時, 就結束該流程5若在參加者位址區域時,就辨別在該收 信郵件之本文内是否有特定文字(缺席)(步驟5 7 2 )。若 有特定文字之場合,就從對應之行程S C D ( Β )之參加者資 料中刪除郵件發信·源之參加者姓名(步驟5 7 3 )。刪除參 加者姓名後,或是在步驟5 7 2並無特定文字時,就從參 加者位址區域中消除郵件發信源之位址(步驟5 7 4 )。然 而,.將暫存器Β之資料轉送到暫存器Α (步驟5 7 5 ),用來 實行第5 9圖〜第fi 2 _之行程詳細顯示處理(步驟5 7 6 )。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (#先間讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 似此,若依照上述第2實施形態時,R. A Μ 6 1乃構成用 以記億行程資料之行程記憶手段,C Ρ ϋ 5 1即構成:郵件 收信手段,用來接受電子郵件;變更手段,用來變更R A Μ G 1之記億内容;和自動發信手段,當進行行程之變更時 ,用來將與其變更内容對應的内容之電子郵件自動的發 倍到特定之對方。然而,連同電子郵件之處理動作而自 動進行行程管理的同時,目.連同行程管理動作而自動地 -81-本纸張尺度適用中國國家標隼(CNS ) A4現格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ) 1 1 發 送 電 子 郵 件 〇 從 而 &gt; 當 電 子 郵 件 之 處 理 與 行 程 管 理 之 1 1 處 理 π 相 連 結 時 就 可 簡 化 該 等 處 理 以 減 輕 使 用 者 之 1 1 負 擔 〇 請 ! 先 1 另 外 &gt; 在 上 述 第 2 實 施 形 態 中 9 所 説 明 者 是 在 R0M6 2 閱 讀 1 内 收 納 有 用 以 收 發 電 子 郵 件 的 程 式 之 專 用 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 背 © ! 1 之 1 , 但 是 9 亦 可 構 成 為 9 將 用 以 收 發 電 子 郵 件 之 程 式 記 錄 注 意 1 I 在 軟 碟 或 CD 等 媒 ρ 在 通 用 之 個 人 電 腦 或 字 處 理 機 等 裝 事 項 1 I 再 1 置 使 其 實 行 〇 填 寫 本 裝 I ) 亦 m 藉 將 下 列 程 式 記 錄 在 以 通 用 個 人 電 腦 或 字 處 理 頁 V〆 1 1 機 等 裝 置 驅 動 之 媒 ρ , 就 可 使 該 等 之 通 用 裝 置 作 為 電 子 1 1 郵 件 裝 置 動 作 以 實 現 本 Μ 明 者 &gt; 其 程 式 包 含 有 電 子 1 | 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 &gt; 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 行 程 資 料 記 億 步 驟 1 訂 i 用 來 記 億 行 程 資 料 ; 行 程 資 料 變 更 步 驟 &gt; 用 來 變 更 該 1 行 程 之 記 1E 内 容 和 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 步 驟 } 當 藉 由 該 1 I 行 程 資 料 im. W 更 步 驟 變 更 行 程 時 &gt; 將 與 該 變 更 内 容 對 1 1 ho 的 内 容 之 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 送 到 特 定 對 象 〇 1 L 2 2 - 第 3 實 施 形 態 i 下 而 將 説 明 本 發 明 之 第 3 實 施 形 態 〇 1 1 在 第 3 實 施 形 態 中 RAM β 1之記億内容亦與第1 實施 1 形 態 者 相 同 〇 另 外 J 在 第 7 圖 所 示 之 C Ρ U5 1之主流程中 1 * 除 了 待 命 郵 件 消 除 處 理 外 &gt; 其 他 處 理 均 與 第 2 實 施 形 I 1 態 者 相 同 〇 另 外 9 第 2 實 施 形 態 中 收 信 顯 示 處 理 與 第 8 1 1 丨圃 〜 第 1 η 圖 所 示 之 第 1 實 施 形 態 之 收 信 顯 示 處 理 之 流 程 1 I 相 同 9 而 且 在 第 9 圖 之 收 信 顯 示 處 理 中 &gt; 步 驟 1 3 4之 1 1 -8 2- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4現格(210 X 297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(&amp; ) 行程顯示處理亦與第1 5圖〜第1 8圖所示之流程相同。但 是,第1 7圖之行程顯示處理之步驟2 0 6之行程登錄處理, 步驟2 0 8中之行程詳細顯示處理則與第1實施形態不同。 而日,主流程之收信處理與第1實施形態不同。從而, 在第2實施形態中對於與第1實施形態相同之處理和 相同之顯示書而乃沿用第1實施形態之圖面,同時,其 重複之説明即予從略,下面只說明.與第1實施形態不同 之處理。但是,就第3實施形態之行程詳細顯示處理即 因為與第59謂〜第62圖所示之第2實施形態之處理相同 ,故其說明從略。 2 3 .行程登錄處理 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 第fi 7圖是第3實施形態之行程登錄處理之流程。在第 1 9圖之行程顯示處理之畫而中,當滑鼠用游標在「登錄j 顯示部份時,在滑鼠:U被施加喀_操作的場合,實行行 程登錄處理。清除R A Μ 6 1之行程製成區域(步驟6 0 0 ),顯 示行程追加登錄之框畫面(步驟6 0 1 )。然而,根據行程 製成區域而顯示輸入區域(步驟6 0 2 )。將文字游標設定 在會議名稱輸入區域(步驟U3U其次,在第57_相同 之行程追加登錄畫面顯示滑鼠用游標(步驟6 0 4 ),辨別 滑鼠3〗是否被移動(步驟(3 〇 5 )。當滑鼠3 1被移動時,就 因應該移動而移動游標位置(步驟6 0 (5)。 接箸,辨別滑鼠:U是否被操作(步驟60 7),若被喀壢 時就辨別游檫位置是否為畫而之輸入區域位置(步驟G 0 8 ) 。是在該位置之場合,就將文字游標設定在有游標之輸 入區域(步驟0 9 )。若游標位置並非輸入區域之位置時 -8 3 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS.) A4祝格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(羚) ,就辨別游標位置是否為畫而之取消開關位置(步驟6 1 0 ) 。若為該位置的場合,就清除行程製成區域(步驟6 1 1 ), 清除顯示(步驟G 1 2 )而結束該行程登錄處埋之流程。 在步驟[1 ,當游標位置並非取消開關位置時,就辨 別游標位置是否為畫面之登錄開關位置(步驟6 1 3 )。若 為該位置之場合,一開始就參照指定年月日之行程區域 之資料(步驟β 1 4 )。然而,辨別在想要登錄之行程資料 的相同時間帶,是否有重複而已被登錄之行程資料(步 驟(Π 5 )。若無重複的行程資料時,就辨別是否没有想要 登錄之下一値行程資料(步驟(5 1 0 )。若有下一橱行程資料 時,就轉移到步驟5 ,辨別在與該行程資料相同之時間 帶,是否有重複而已被登錄之行程資料。 在步驟6 ,若無下一個行程資料時,亦即,在想要 登錄之行程資料的相同時間帶完全沒有重複而已被登錄 之行程資料的場合,就將行程製成區域之資料儲存在指 定年月日之區域,以進行迫加登錄(步驟6 1 7 )。然而, 清除顯示(步驟6 1 8 ),而結束該行程追加登錄處理。 在步驟G】5 ,若在想要登錄之行程資料之相同時間帶 已有重複而已被登錄之行程資料時,就實行警告畫面之 顯示處理(步驟6] 9 ),轉移到步驟6 0 1,顯示行程追加登 綠框畫而。 在步驟β 0 7中,當滑鼠3 1未被喀_橾作時,就辨別是 否有資料輸入(步驟S 2 2 0 ) 若有資料輸入時,就將資料 顯示在有文字游標之輪入區域(步驟6 2 1 )。而目.,將資 _ 8 4 — 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X 297公釐) 一 〆''' I I - s mu ......... I I— nn ^ mu nn US —n In、一(^ (請先閎讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 (Ο ) 1 1 料 儲 存 在 與行程 製 成 區域對 應之 區 域(步 驟 6 2 2 ) 〇 在 儲 1 1 存 資 料 之 後,或 是 在 步驟6 2 〇並非資料輸 入 的場 口 就 1 ! 轉 移 到 步 驟 6 0 5, 以辨別滑鼠3 1之移動。 讀 1 先 1 24 • 收 信 處理 閔 讀 1 第 R8 圖 是第3 實 施 形態之 收信 處 理之流程,應其計時 背 1 i 之 1 中 斷 而 實 施。在 該 處 理中, 辨別 有 否收信郵件(步 驟 6 2 3 ) 注 意 1 I 9 在 有 牧 信郵件 之 場 合,辨 別在 R A Μ 6 1 之 收 信郵 件 區 域 事 項 1 1 再 1=3 疋 否 有 空 白(步驟fi 2 4 )〇若 無空白時, 就 刪除 最 早 的 瑱 寫 本 I ^ 收 信 時 R 之郵件 &gt; 使 該區域 淨空 (步驟62 S) ,而 轉 移 到 頁 1 I 步 驟 6 2 4 〇 其次, 將收信郵件儲存在收信 郵 件區 域 之 空 1 i 白 區 域 (步驟 )〇 然而,在被儲存之收 信 郵件 附 加 開 i j 封 旗 標 K A I F U (= 0) (步驟6 2 7 ),又在被儲 存 之收 信 郵 件 i 訂 附 加 Τ I Μ Ε (收信時刻) (步驟6 28) 〇 1 接 著 9 辨別用 以 表 示郵件 種類 之 旗標S C F 是否 為 〇 , 亦 1 1 m 9 辨 別 收信郵 件 是 否為通 常郵 件 (步驟 62 9)。 當 該 旗 1 1 標 為 0 而 收信郵 件 為 通常郵 件之 場 合,就結束該收信處 1 i 理 之 流 程 〇在SC F為1 之場合,亦即,收 信 郵件 為 宵 議 (J ! 舉 辦 通 知 郵件之 場 合 ,就指 定與 收 信郵件之會議舉行年 1 1 月 闩 所 對 應之R 期 行 程區域 (步驟G 30) 〇 然 而, 將 用 以 * * 指 定 行 程 之指標 η 設 定為1 (步驟 G 3 1),辨別所對應日期 1 1 * 之 行 程 (Π )之時間帶是否與收倍郵件之時 間 帶重 複 (步驟 I 1 (;a 2) Λ 若 無時間 帶 重 複之場 合, 就 遞增r 1 (步驟 63 3) 9 1 1 辨 別 η 是 否超過 當 R 已登錄 過之 行 程數 步 驟6 3 4 ) 〇 掛 m 1 I η 並 未 超 過行程 數 之 場合, 就轉 移 到步驟G 3 2, 用 來 辨別 1 1 丨 -85- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 U ) I 1 與 η 所 指 定 之 行 程 (η )時間帶之重複。 1 1 妖 而 在 步 驟 6 3 2产 -步驟6 34 中 9 邊 使 η 遞增 J 而 辨 別 1 1 對 m Η 之 被 登 錄 的 所 有 行 程 之 時 間 帶 的 重 複, 在 步 驟 6 34 f~V 請 1 先 1 中 9 當 Π 超 過 行 程 數 而 所 有 行 程 之 時 間 帶並 未 與 收 信 閱 讀 1 郵 件 之 時 間 帶 電 複 的 場 合 就 指 定 ΙΞΤ 議 舉 行年 月 Β 之 行 背 面 1 i 之 1 程 區 域 的 空 白 區 域 (步驟6 3 5 ), 將收信郵件之資料儲存 注 意 1 I 在 該 白 區 域 (步驟fi 3 fi )〇 然而, 結束該收信處理。 事 項 1 1 再 E 在 步 驟 fi 3 2中, 若以指標η 指定的行程(η )之 時 間 帶 和 寫 本 收 信 郵 件 之 時 間 帶 電 複 時 就 白 動 發 送 表 示會 議 缺 席 之 頁 -----· 1 1 音 的 定 形 郵 件 (步驟fi 3 7 )〇 然而, 結束該牧信處理。 1 I 拟 此 &gt; 若 依 昭 上 逑 第 3 實 施 形 態 者 5 R A Μ 6 1構成即用 ί | 以 記 億 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 記 憶 手 段 , CPU5 1即構成有 郵 i 訂 件 收 信 手 段 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 辨 別 手 段, 用 來 辨 別 1 所 收 信 到 之 電 子 郵 件 是 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料之 行 程 郵 件 1 I ·) 比 較 手 段 9 當 收 信 郵 件 被 辨 別 為 行 程 郵 件時 用 來 將 1 1 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 被 記 億 之 行程 資 料 加 以 1 bb 較 記 億 控 制 手 段 &gt; 若 fcb 較 之 結 果 9 當 撿測 到 該 兩 値 1 行 程 資 料 舱 未 重 複 時 5 用 來 將 收 信 到 的 行 程之 行 set 枉 資 料 1 1 記 憶 在 RAMG 1 和自動發信手段, 當檢測到該兩個行程 1 資 料 有 重 複 時 就 將 定 形 郵 件 自 動 的 發 送 至收 信 到 的 行 1 I 稈 郵 件 之 發 信 源 〇 I 1 然 而 &gt; 在 電 子 郵 件 之 理 和 行 程 肯 理 之 處理 互 相 連 結 1 1 的 場 合 ί 可 和 一 方 處 理 連 動 而 自 動 地 進 行 另一方之 處 理 〇 1 I /iM 1疋 而 &gt; 可 排 除 煩 雜 之 作 業 » 白 可 減 輕 使 用 者之 負: 擔 〇 1 1 -86- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(打) 2 5 .第4實施形態 下面將說明第4實施形態。第4實施形態是第3實施 形態之變化例,只有R A Μ 6 1之記億内容和收信處理之流 程與上述第3實施形態不同,其他之處理則與第3實施 形態相同。 第69圔是記億器圔,用來表示第4實施形態的RAM61 之資料構成,追加有指定位址區域。在該指定位址區域 預先收納有如同公司之薰監事等重要對象的指定位址(1) 〜U),作為備份,即使電流OFF時其記億内容也不會失 去。 2 6 .收信處理 第7 0圖和第7 1圔是第4實施形態的收信處理之流程, 應其計時器中斷而實施。在第70圔中。辨別是否有收信 郵件(步驟638),在有收信郵件之場合,就辨別RAM 61之 收信郵件區域有否空白(步驟6 3 9 )。若無空白時,就刪 除最早之收信時日之郵件,使得該區域淨空(步驟6 4 0 ) ,而轉移到步驟6 3 9。其次,將收信郵件儲存在收信郵 件區域之空白區域(步驟641)。然而,在被儲存之收信 郵件附加開封旗標K A I F U ( = 0 )(步驟6 4 2 ),在被儲存之 收信元件附加T I Μ E (收信時刻)(步驟6 4 3 )。 其次,辨別用以表示郵件種類之旗標S C F是否為0 ,亦 即,辨別收信郵件是否為通常郵件(步驟6 4 4 )。若該旗 標為0,而收信郵件為通常郵件之場合,就結束該收信 處理之流程。若S C F為1之場合,亦卽,收信郵件為會 一 8 7 _ 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) n^— vm nn I fm li / m^v 1 nm ^ N ..¾¾ 、-° (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁). A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( a ) 1 ! 議 舉 行 通 知 郵件 之 場合 ,就指 定 與收信郵 件之會 議舉行 1 1 年 月 Β 對 陴 曰之 行 程區 域(步驟G 4 5 )。然而,將用以指 1 | 定 行 程 之 指 標η 設 定為 1 (步驟 G4 6 ),辨別 對應曰 的行程 /--S 請 1 I (Γ )之時間帶和收信郵件之時間帶有否重複(步驟 647) 0 龙 閱 I I 讀 1 I 時 間 帶 並 無 重複 之 場合 ,就使 η 遞増(步驟6 48 ), 辨別η 背 面 ! _ 之 1 是 否 超 過 當 日已 登 錄過 之行程 數 (步驟6 4 9 )。若η 未超 注 意 1 1 過 行 數 之 場合 9 就轉 移到步 驟 6 4 7而辨別和以η 指定 事 項 1 I 再 1 _ 之 行 程 (η )的時間帶之電複。 Φτ 寫 k 然 而 9 在 步驟 6 4 7〜步驟6 4 9 中 ,邊使η 遞増, 同時辨 頁 '--- 1 別 對 m 曰 被 登錄 之 所有 行程的 時 間帶之重 複,在 步驟6 4 9 1 1 .中 5 當 D 超 過行 程 數時 ,在所 有 的行程之 時間帶 並不與 ί I 收 信 郵 件 之 時間 帶 重複 之場合 就指定收 信郵件 之出席 ! 1 訂 1 者 (步驟R 5 0 ),檢取出席者之郵件位址(步 驟 651) 。然後 ί 以 表 示 出 席會 議 之定 形郵件 A 之收信人 作為參 加者之 1 I 郵 件 位 址 (步驟6 5 2 ),自動發送該定形郵件Α (步驟6 5 3 )。 1 1 其 次 1 從 收 信郵 件 中撿 取下一 個 出席者之 郵件位 址(步 1 驟 6 5 4) 〇 妖 而, 辨 別是 否有下 一 個出席者 (步驟6 55), L I 另 外 尚 留 存有 未 發送 定形郵 件 Α的出席 dbzL 4-Θ ^ ^Z. m 合,就 1 1 轉 移 到 步 驟 6 5 1, 檢取該出席者之郵件位址。 1 | 在 步 驟 G 5 S中, 並無下一個出席者,已完成所有出席 1 I 者 之 定 形 郵 件A 發 送時 ,就指 定 會議舉行 年月曰 的行程 1 1 區 域 之 空 區域 (步驟0 5 fi ),將收信郵件資料儲存在該 1 | 举 白 \m 域 (步驟r&gt; 5 7 )。然而,結束該收信處理之流程。 1 在 步 驟 0 4 7中, 當以指標η指定的彳1*程(η)之時 間帶和 1 1 ~ 8 8 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張又度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(κ ) 收信郵件之時間帶重複的場合,就在第7 1圔之流程,將 用以表示指定位址之指標k設定為1 (步驟6 5 8 ),辨別被 收納在UAM61之指定位址中以指標k指定之指定位址(k) 是否與收信郵件之位址相同(步驟6 5 9 )。若不相同之場合 ,就使k遞增(步驟6 6 0 ),辨別k是否大於指定位址之 最大數(步驟661)。在未超過最大數之場合。就轉移到 步驟6 5 9,辨別指定位址(k )和收信郵件之位址是否相同。 在步驟661中,當k超過最大數之場合,亦即當收佶 郵件之位址與所有指定位址不相同之場合,其已登錄之 行程比收信郵件之行程優先。在這種場合,指定收信郵 件之出席者(步驟6 6 2 ),而檢取出席者之郵件位址(步驟 6 G 3 )。然而,以表示會議缺席之定形郵件B之收信人作 為參加者之郵件位址(步驟6 6 4 ),自動的發送該定形郵件 B (步驟6 6 5 )。其次,從收信郵件中檢取下一個出席者之 郵件位址(步驟666U然而,辨別是否有下一個出席者 (步驟667),而且,尚留存有並未發送定形郵件B的出 席者之場合,就轉移到步驟6 6 3 ,而檢取該出席者之郵 件位址。在步驟667中,若無下一個出席者,對所有的 出席者均已完成定形郵件B之發送時,就結束該收信處 理之流程。 在步驟6 5 9中,若指定位址(k )與收信郵件之位址相同 時,該收信郵件之行程較諸已被登錄之行程優先。在這 種場合,指定與收信郵件重複的行程(η )之參加者(步驟 6 6 8 )。然而,檢取該參加者之郵件位址(步驟6 6 9 ),以 -89- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4祝格(210X 297公釐) (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) /裝 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印家 A7 B7 五、發明説明(Η ) 表示缺席的定形郵件B之收信人作為該參加者之郵件位 址(步驟fi 7 0 ),自動地發送定形郵件B (步驟6 7〗)。其 次,從行程(η )中檢取下一個參加者之郵件位址(步驟6 7 2 ) ,辨別有否下一個參加者(步驟6 7 3 )。若有下一個參加者 之場合,就轉移到步驟G G 9,用來檢取該參加者之郵件 位址。 在步驟f&gt; 7 3中,若無下一個參加者而對所有之參加者均 已發送過定形郵件B之場合,就刪除行程(n )(步驟6 7 4 ) ,將收信郵件之資料儲存在行程(η)之空白區域(步驟675) 。然後,結束該收信處理之流程。另外,在步驟6 7 1對 行程(η )之出席者全體人員發送定形郵件Β之後,與第7 0 _之步驟G 5 Π〜步驟G 5 5之處理同樣的,亦可對收信郵件 之出席者全體人員發送表示出席會議之定形郵件Α。 似此,若依照上述第4實施形態者,C Ρ ϋ 5 1除了先前 的第3實施形態之構造外,更構成有藉由比較手段之功 能檢測了收信到的行程郵件之行程資料和已被登錄在 R. A Μ ίΠ的行程資料之兩行程資料重複時,辨別收信到之 行程郵件是否滿足所定條件的條件辨別手段,藉由該條 件辨別手段辨別為能滿足所定條件時,就刪除被記億在 R. A Μ (U而重複之行程資料的同時,並構成有記億更新手段 ,用來將行程郵件所包含之行程資料記億在R A Μ 6 1 ,而 使其換新者。 -9 0 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(〇呢)八4規格(210乂297公釐) (讀先閔讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 訂 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(朽) ' 然而,例如,以如同公司内之蓳監事等重要對象之郵 件位址和收信到之行程郵件之郵件位址相同作為所定條 件之場合,乃刪除被登錄在R A Μ 6 1之重複的行程資料, 換寫為重要對象之行程資料。從而,即使收信到之行程 郵件與被登錄之行程重複時,不機械式的排除行程郵件 ,而可考慮行程資料之優先程度,以施加行程管理。 另外,在上述第3和第4實施形態中,就R0M62内收 納用以收發電子郵件的程式之專用電子郵件裝置,雖 說明,但是,亦可構成為將用以收發電子郵件之程 式記錄在軟碟或光碟等記錄媒體,在通用之個人電腦或 字處理機等手段實行該程式。 亦即,在第3實施形態中,藉將下列程式記錄在以通 用之個人電腦或字處理機等手段驅動之記錄媒體,就可 使該等通用手段作為電子郵件裝置動作,該程式所包含 之步驟有:電子郵件收信步驟,用來接受電子郵件;行 程資料記億步驟,用來記億行程資料;行程資料辨別步 驟,用來辨別收信到之電子郵件是否包含有行程資料之 行程郵件;行程資料比較步驟,藉由該行程辨別步驟辨 別為行程郵件時,將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料和被 記億之行程資料加以比較;行程資料記億控制步驟,藉 由該行程資料比較步驟檢測到該兩値行程資料並未重複 時,就記億收信到的行程郵件之行程資料;和行程資料 自動發信步驟,藉由上述行程資料比較步驟檢測到上述 兩個行程資料有重複時,就對收信到之行程郵件之發信 -9 1 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4祝格(210X297公釐) (讀先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) v裝·The D line and SC line show the most upturned table, column 4) shows 3 I 5 shows a sudden turn and reverses the step 1 (beginning with the most fixed, let ’s say, the drawing from the standard C is followed by the slide show. If you move the cursor, it should be moved if you move it. If you move it, you should move it. If you move it, you should distinguish it. It should be β because of 3 especially 5 f. Moved by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. K k 5 (其 .ΰ '. 置 (ί No. in the middle-range flow of the mouse slide dy 0 discriminated when the transfer to the time 0 0 was clicked without Ruo #: 537 click is the 1 1 Figure 3 5 is the 5 set Step indicator Swim 0 to identify the list when the process is performed. Β-C has S. If C moves 31, then the mouse draws LT 3. Slide β. Do not discriminate or not. 2 4 5 Set the step code step / (V number) D 0 c / V s D The S display bit will be displayed on the screen, and the game will be reversed, and the coherent field 0 of 1) Set the 54 step This step is in ffl (Yes Standard 〇 means that this paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (21 × 297 mm) Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (7 7). However, move to step 5 3 7 of 5 9 _ to identify the movement of mouse 31. In step 5 4 0 of GQ diagram, when the cursor position is not SCI), it is identified Whether the cursor position is the position of the delete switch (step 5 4 3) among the three symbol switches (end, delete, and detail) on the upper right of the screen. If it is at this position, the SCI displayed in reverse is deleted) (m ) (Step 4 4), classify the stroke of (A) latches (step 5 4 5). However, clear the display in Fig. 63 (step 5 4 6) and move to step 5 of step 5 9 _ 2 9, Dianxin display (Writing in the itinerary of the day M. In steps 5 4 3 of Fig. 60, when the position of the cruise is not the position of the delete switch, it is determined that the position of the cursor is apricot on the date surface of Fig. 63 End the switch position (step 5 4 7). If it is at this position, clear the β3 picture and display it (step 5 4 8), and end the detailed display processing flow of the stroke. In step 5 4 7 When the cursor position is not at the end of the opening position, in the flow of Figure 61, identify whether the cursor position is in the detailed opening. Position (step 5 4 9). If it is not at this position, although it moves to step 5 3 7 of 5 9 圏, and judges the movement of the mouse, if the cursor position is at the position of the detailed switch, the ( 5 3 pictures are displayed (step 5 5 0). However, the stroke detailed display picture shown in FIG. 64 is displayed (2), and the stroke detailed picture of S C I (m) displayed in reverse is displayed (step 5 5 1). Then, the cursor for the mouse is displayed on the date surface of FIG. 64 (step 5 5 2), and it is discriminated whether the mouse 3] is moved (step 5 5 3). If it is moved, move the cursor position according to the movement (step 5 5 4). Secondly, identify the mouse: whether U was clicked (step 5 5 5), if it is clicked, then-79-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) Order A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (to) Determine whether the cursor position is on the 4th picture and the 2 锢 icon switch ( End, delete) the end switch position (step 5 5 6), if it is at this position, clear the β 4 written display (step 5 5 7), and end the detailed display processing flow of the schedule. In step 5 56, if the cursor position is not the end switch position, in the G 2 _ flow, it is discriminated whether the cursor position is the position of the delete switch on the 64th frame (step 5 5 8). In the case of position, move to the step (5) in Figure 5 to identify the movement of the mouse. When the cursor position is the position of the delete switch, specify one of the SCD (m) participants (step 5 5 9) However, the mail address of the participant is used as the recipient of the fixed mail B of the absence notification (step 560). Figure 65 shows the drawing of the fixed mail B. Then, SC 1) (m) The information is written into the body of the fixed mail B (step 5 (Π), and the absent fixed mail B is automatically sent (step 5 G 2). In this case, when the sender is the conference host, the fixed shape of the conference suspension is sent. Mail B 〇 Secondly, the designation of all participants is ended, and it is discriminated whether or not shaped mail B has been sent (step 5 6 3). If the designation of all the participants has not been completed, the process moves to step 5 5 9 for designation Next participant. In step 5 6 3, end the participation If the designated mail B has been sent to all the staff, the SCD (m) data will be eliminated (step 5 6 4) and the detailed display process of the itinerary will be terminated. 2 1 .Finished place fi R _ Is the flow of the receiving process in response to the interruption of the timer. In this process, it is discriminated whether there is a Muxin mail (step 5 β 5). If there is a receiving -80- This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 Zhuge (210 × 297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) "clothing. Order A7 B7 V. Invention Description (79) In the case of mail, identify the mail area of β AM 6 1 No blank (step 566). If there is no blank, delete the earliest mail at the date of receipt to make the area clear (step 5 6 7), and move to step 5 6 6. Next, store the Maki mail in The blank area of the received mail area (step 5 6 8). However, the unopened flag KAIFU (= 0) is added to the stored received mail (step 5 6 9), and TI Μ E is attached to the stored mail (Receiving time) (Step 5 7 (1). Next, identify the receiving mail Whether the source address is in the participant's address area (step 5 7 1). If the source address is not in the participant's address area, the process ends. 5 If it is in the participant's address area, it is identified in the participant's address area. Is there any specific text (absent) in the body of the received email (step 5 7 2). If there is specific text, delete the email sender and source participant from the participant information of the corresponding itinerary SCD (B) Name (step 5 7 3). After deleting the participant's name, or if there is no specific text in step 5 7 2, delete the address of the email source from the participant's address area (step 5 7 4). However, the data of the register B is transferred to the register A (step 5 7 5), and is used to implement the detailed display processing of the strokes from Fig. 59 to fi 2 _ (step 5 7 6). Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (#Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page) Similarly, if you follow the second embodiment, R. A Μ 6 1 is used to record 100 million trips. C ϋ 1 51 means: mail receiving means to accept e-mail; change means to change the contents of the RA MG G 1 billion; and automatic letter means to change the itinerary At the same time, it is used to automatically send e-mails of the content corresponding to the changed content to a specific counterparty. However, while the itinerary management is automatically performed with the processing action of the e-mail, the project is automatically performed with the itinerary management action. -81- This paper size is applicable to China National Standards (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention () 1 1 Send an e-mail 0 thus &gt; When the processing of the e-mail is linked to the 1 1 process π of the itinerary management, these processes can be simplified to reduce the use 1 1 Burden 0 Please! First 1 In addition, in the second embodiment 9 described above is a special e-mail device containing a program for sending and receiving e-mail in the ROM 6 2 reading 1 ©! 1 of 1 However, 9 can also be constituted as 9 will record the program used to send and receive e-mail. Note 1 I On a floppy disk or CD and other media ρ On a general-purpose personal computer or word processor Wait for the installation items 1 I and 1 to implement them. Fill in this installation I) Also m By recording the following program on a medium ρ driven by a general-purpose personal computer or word processing page V〆1 1 machine, etc. The universal device operates as an electronic 1 1 mail device to realize the present invention. The program contains the electronic 1 | mail receiving steps> to receive e-mail itinerary data and record billions of steps. ; Itinerary data change steps &gt; Steps to change the 1E contents of the 1 itinerary and white email sending steps} When changing the itinerary with the 1 I itinerary data im. W &gt; will be matched with the changes 1 1 ho content e-mail is sent to a specific subject 〇1 L 2 2-Embodiment 3 i The present invention will be described The third embodiment 〇1 1 In the third embodiment, the contents of billions of RAM β 1 are the same as those of the first embodiment 1. In addition, J is in the main flow of CP U5 1 shown in FIG. 7 * Except for the standby mail erasing process, the other processes are the same as those in the second embodiment I 1 state. In addition, in the second embodiment, the reception display process is the same as that in the first embodiment. The first one is shown in the figure below. The process of receiving display processing in the embodiment 1 I is the same 9 and in the receiving display processing of FIG. 9 &gt; Step 1 3 4 of 1 1 -8 2- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS ) A4 is present (210 X 297 mm) A7 B7 5. & Explanation (&amp;) The process of displaying the stroke is also the same as the process shown in Figures 15 to 18. However, the itinerary registration process of step 206 in the itinerary display process in FIG. 17 and the detailed display process of the itinerary in step 208 are different from those in the first embodiment. On the other hand, the reception process of the main flow is different from the first embodiment. Therefore, in the second embodiment, the same processing and the same display book as in the first embodiment are used in accordance with the drawing of the first embodiment. At the same time, the repeated description is omitted, and only the following description. 1 implementation of different processing. However, the detailed display processing of the third embodiment is the same as the processing of the second embodiment shown in the 59th to the 62nd drawings, so the description is omitted. 2 3. Itinerary registration process Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) Figure fi 7 shows the process of itinerary registration processing in the third embodiment. In the picture of the stroke display processing in FIG. 19, when the mouse cursor is used to display the "register j display portion", the stroke registration process is performed when the mouse: U is operated with a click. Clear RA Μ 6 The stroke creation area of step 1 (step 6 0 0) displays a frame screen for additional registration of the stroke (step 6 0 1). However, the input area is displayed according to the stroke creation area (step 6 0 2). Set the text cursor to Meeting name input area (Step U3U, followed by the additional registration screen on the 57th_same schedule to display the cursor for the mouse (step 604), identify whether the mouse 3 is moved (step (305). When the mouse When 3 1 is moved, the cursor position should be moved according to the movement (step 6 0 (5). Then, identify the mouse: whether U is operated (step 60 7), and if it is clicked, determine whether the position of the cursor is The position of the input area for drawing (step G 0 8). If it is at this position, set the text cursor to the input area with the cursor (step 0 9). If the position of the cursor is not the position of the input area -8 3 -This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS.) A4 (210X297 mm) A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (Antelope), it is discriminated whether the cursor position is a picture and the switch position is canceled (step 6 1 0). In this case, the stroke creation area is cleared (step 6 1 1), the display is cleared (step G 1 2), and the process of embedding the stroke registration point is ended. In step [1, when the cursor position is not the cancel switch position, the cursor is identified. Whether the position is the registration switch position of the screen (step 6 1 3). If it is the position, refer to the information of the designated travel area of the year, month, and day (step β 1 4). However, identify the In the same time zone of the itinerary data, is there any duplicate itinerary data that has been registered (step (Π 5). If there is no duplicate itinerary data, it is discriminated whether there is no next itinerary data that you want to register (step (5 1 0 ). If there is the next cabinet of itinerary data, go to step 5 to identify whether there are duplicate itinerary data registered in the same time zone as the itinerary data. In step 6, if no For each itinerary data, that is, in the case of the itinerary data that has been registered without any repetition at the same time zone of the itinerary that you want to register, the data of the itinerary creation area is stored in the designated year, month, and day area for Force registration (step 6 1 7). However, clear the display (step 6 1 8) and end the itinerary additional registration process. At step G] 5, if the same time zone of the trip data you want to register has been repeated When the itinerary data has been registered, the display process of the warning screen is executed (step 6] 9), and the process shifts to step 601 to display the itinerary with a green frame. In step β 0 7, when the mouse 3 1 is not clicked, it is discriminated whether there is data input (step S 2 2 0). If there is data input, the data is displayed in the wheel with text cursor Area (step 6 2 1). And the head., Will _ 8 4 — This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X 297 mm) 〆 '' 'II-s mu ......... II — nn ^ mu nn US —n In 、 一 (^ (Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention (〇) 1 1 The area corresponding to the area created in the itinerary (step 6 2) 〇 After storing 1 1 to store the data, or at step 6 2 〇 the field entry that is not the data input is 1! Move to step 6 0 5 to identify the mouse 3 Move to 1. Read 1 first 1 24 • Receive processing Min read 1 Figure R8 shows the flow of the receive processing in the third embodiment, and it should be implemented when its timing is interrupted by 1 i 1. In this process, it is identified No receiving mail (step 6 2 3) Note 1 I 9 In the case of pastoral mail, identify the receiving mail area in RA Μ 6 1 matters 1 1 re 1 = 3 疋 No availability White (step fi 2 4). If there is no blank space, delete the earliest copybook I ^ R mail at reception &gt; make the area clear (step 62 S), and move to page 1 I step 6 2 4 〇 Next, the received mail is stored in the empty 1 i white area of the received mail area (step). However, an ij banner KAIFU (= 0) is added to the stored received mail (step 6 2 7), and Attach Τ I Μ Ε (receiving time) to the stored received mail i (step 6 28) 〇1 Then 9 identify whether the flag SCF used to indicate the type of mail is 0, and also 1 1 m 9 Whether the mail is a normal mail (step 62 9). When the flag 1 1 is marked as 0 and the received mail is a normal mail, the processing procedure of the receiving office 1 i is ended. When SC F is 1, also In other words, the received mail is Xiaoyin (J! When a notification mail is held, the R period schedule area corresponding to the November and January meeting of the received mail will be designated (step G 3 0) 〇 However, set the index η for * * to specify the itinerary to 1 (step G 3 1), and discriminate whether the time zone of the itinerary (Π) of the corresponding date 1 1 * overlaps with the time zone of the doubled mail ( Step I 1 (; a 2) Λ If there is no time zone repetition, increment r 1 (step 63 3) 9 1 1 Identify whether η exceeds the number of trips when R has been registered Step 6 3 4) ○ m 1 When I η does not exceed the number of strokes, go to step G 3 2, to identify 1 1 丨 -85- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. 5. Description of the invention U) I 1 and the specified time period (η) are repeated. 1 1 Demonstration in step 6 3 2-step 6 34 9 9 Increase η by J to discriminate 1 1 Repeat the time zone of all trips registered for m Η, in step 6 34 f ~ V Please 1 first 1 in 9 When Π exceeds the number of trips and the time zone of all the trips is not the same as the time of reading 1 mail, the designated time is designated as a blank area on the back of the 1 i one-way zone (step 1) 6 3 5), storing the data of the received mail 1 1 in the white area (step fi 3 fi). However, the receiving process is ended. Matter 1 1 and E In step fi 3 2, if the time zone of the itinerary (η) specified by the index η and the time of writing the e-mail are recharged, they will send a page indicating that the meeting is absent -------- 1 1 tone fixed mail (step fi 3 7). However, this musk letter processing ends. 1 I like this> If it is according to the 3rd embodiment of the above-mentioned 5th embodiment, 5 RA Μ 6 1 constitutes a ready-to-use means to store 100 million itinerary data, the CPU 5 1 constitutes a means of receiving mail through the i-order Accept e-mail identification means to identify whether the received e-mail is an itinerary mail that contains itinerary information 1 I) Comparison means 9 When the e-mail received is identified as itinerary mail, it is used to identify 1 1 the itinerary Add 1 bb to record the travel information and 100 million recorded travel information in the mail. Control means> If fcb compares with the result 9 When the two 1 trip data cabins are not repeated, 5 will be used to receive the mail. Set itinerary of the trip 枉 Data 1 1 is stored in RAMG 1 and automatic transmission means. When it is detected that the data of the two trips 1 are duplicated, the fixed mail is automatically sent to the received line 1 I Source 〇I 1 However, in the case where the principle of email and the processing of itinerary are connected to each other 1 1ί It can interlock with the processing of one party and automatically perform the processing of the other 〇1 I / iM 1 疋 &gt; It can eliminate the trouble Homework »White can reduce the burden on users: burden 01 1 -86- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X 297 mm) Printed by the Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Description of Invention (Hit) 2 5. Fourth Embodiment A fourth embodiment will be described below. The fourth embodiment is a modified example of the third embodiment. Only the content of 100 million yuan of R A M 61 and the process of receiving the mail are different from the above-mentioned third embodiment, and the other processes are the same as those of the third embodiment. The 69th block is a memory register block, which indicates the data structure of the RAM 61 of the fourth embodiment, and a designated address area is added. In this designated address area, designated addresses (1) to U), which are important objects such as the company's Supervisor, are stored in advance. As a backup, their contents will not be lost even when the current is turned off. 26. Receiving Processing Figures 70 and 71 show the flow of receiving processing in the fourth embodiment, and are implemented when the timer is interrupted. In the 70th cent. It is discriminated whether there is a received mail (step 638), and when there is a received mail, it is discriminated whether the received mail area of the RAM 61 is blank (step 6 3 9). If there is no blank space, delete the earliest mail at the earliest date of receipt to make the area clear (step 640), and move to step 63.9. Next, the received mail is stored in a blank area of the received mail area (step 641). However, an unopened flag K A I F U (= 0) is added to the stored received mail (step 6 4 2), and T I ME (received time) is added to the stored received element (step 6 4 3). Secondly, it is determined whether the flag S C F used to indicate the type of mail is 0, that is, whether the received mail is a normal mail (step 6 4 4). If the flag is 0 and the received mail is a normal mail, the process of receiving the mail is ended. If the SCF is 1, the mail will be sent to you 8 7 _ This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) n ^ — vm nn I fm li / m ^ v 1 nm ^ N .. ¾¾,-° (Please read the notes on the back before filling out this page). A7 B7 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the Invention (a) 1 , The meeting area for designating and receiving mails is held in the 11th month of the year B to the travel area (step G 4 5). However, the index η used to refer to 1 | fixed itinerary is set to 1 (step G4 6), to identify whether the corresponding itinerary /-S please 1 I (Γ) and the time zone of the received mail are repeated (Step 647) 0 Longread II Read 1 I When the time zone is not repeated, make η recursively (Step 6 48), identify the back of η! 1 of _ exceeds the number of trips registered on the day (Step 6 4 9 ). If η does not pay attention to the number of lines 1 1 9, then go to step 6 4 7 to identify and restore the time zone of the event (I) specified by η and 1 -1. Φτ Write k. However, in step 6 4 7 ~ step 6 4 9, while recursing η and discerning the page at the same time --- 1 Do not repeat the time zone of all registered trips in m, in step 6 4 9 1 1 .Medium 5 When D exceeds the number of trips, if the time zone of all trips does not overlap with the time zone of the received mail of ί I, the attendance of the received mail is designated! 1 Order 1 person (step R 5 0), retrieve the email addresses of the attendees (step 651). Then, the recipient of the formal mail A represented by the meeting is used as the participant's 1 I mail address (step 6 5 2), and the formal mail A is automatically sent (step 6 5 3). 1 1 Next 1 Pick up the email address of the next attendee from the received mail (step 1 step 6 5 4) 〇 Demon, identify if there is a next attendee (step 6 55), LI also has unsuccessful Send the attendance dbzL 4-Θ ^ ^ Z. M of the shaped mail A, and then go to step 6 5 1 for 1 1 to retrieve the mail address of the attendee. 1 | In step G 5 S, there is no next attendee, and all scheduled attendees who have attended 1 I have been sent. When the scheduled meeting is held, the itinerary 1 1 area is empty (step 0 5 fi ), The received mail data is stored in the 1 | white \ m domain (step r &gt; 5 7). However, the flow of the reception processing is ended. 1 In step 0 4 7 when the time zone of 彳 1 * stroke (η) and 1 1 ~ 8 8-1 1 1 1 specified by the index η again apply the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297) (Mm) A7 B7 printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. In the case where the time for receiving mails is repeated, the process of No. 7 (1) will be used to indicate the index of the designated address k is set to 1 (step 6 5 8), and it is discriminated whether the designated address (k) designated by the index k stored in the designated address of the UAM61 is the same as the address of the received mail (step 6 5 9). If they are not the same, increment k (step 660) to determine whether k is greater than the maximum number of specified addresses (step 661). When the maximum number is not exceeded. Then proceed to step 6 5 9 to determine whether the designated address (k) and the address of the received mail are the same. In step 661, when k exceeds the maximum number, that is, when the address of the received mail is different from all the specified addresses, the registered itinerary has priority over the received mail. In this case, the attendees of the received mail are designated (step 6 6 2), and the mail addresses of the attendees are retrieved (step 6 G 3). However, the recipient of the fixed mail B indicating the absence of the conference is used as the mail address of the participant (step 6 64), and the fixed mail B is automatically sent (step 6 6 5). Next, the mail address of the next attendee is retrieved from the received mail (step 666U. However, it is discriminated whether there is a next attendee (step 667), and there are still some attendees who have not sent the fixed mail B. Then, go to step 6 6 3 and retrieve the email address of the attendee. In step 667, if there is no next attendee and all the attendees have completed sending the fixed email B, the process ends. Receipt processing flow. In step 6 59, if the specified address (k) is the same as the address of the received mail, the itinerary of the received mail has priority over the registered itinerary. In this case, Specify the participant of the itinerary (η) that is the same as the received mail (step 668). However, the mail address of the participant (step 6 6 9) is retrieved, and the paper standard is -89- Chinese national standard applies (CNS) Α4 Zhuge (210X 297 mm) (Read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) / Binding Staff of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs and Consumer Cooperatives A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (Η) A form that indicates absence. Recipient of Mail B as the participant The mail address (step fi 7 0), automatically sends the fixed mail B (step 6 7). Secondly, the mail address of the next participant is retrieved from the itinerary (η) (step 6 7 2), and there is an identification No next participant (step 6 7 3). If there is a next participant, go to step GG 9 to retrieve the email address of the participant. In step f &gt; 7 3, if no When the next participant has sent a fixed mail B to all participants, delete the itinerary (n) (step 6 7 4), and store the information of the received mail in the blank area of the itinerary (η) (step 675). Then, the process of receiving the mail is ended. In addition, after sending a fixed mail B to all the attendees of the itinerary (η) in step 6 71, the step G 5 Π to step G 5 The processing of 5 is the same, and it is also possible to send a fixed mail A indicating the attendance of the meeting to all the attendees of the received mail. Similarly, if it is in accordance with the fourth embodiment described above, C P ϋ 5 1 except for the previous third embodiment. In addition to the structure, it also has the function of detecting the reception by the function of comparison means. When the itinerary data of the itinerary mail and the itinerary data that has been registered in R. A Μ Π overlap, the conditional discrimination means to determine whether the received itinerary emails meet the predetermined conditions is determined by the condition discrimination means as When the specified conditions can be met, the duplicated itinerary data recorded in R. A Μ (U) will be deleted, and a renewal method will be formed to record the itinerary information included in the itinerary email in RA Μ 6 1 and make it a new one. -9 0-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (〇 呢) 8 4 specifications (210 乂 297 mm) (read the precautions on the back of the paper before filling this page) Printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Ministry of Standards of the People's Republic of China A7 B7 V. Description of the Invention (dead) 然而 However, for example, the mail address of important objects such as the company's supervisor and the mail address of the itinerary received are the same In the case of predetermined conditions, the duplicate itinerary data registered in the RA M 61 is deleted and replaced with the itinerary data of important objects. Therefore, even if the received itinerary mail and the registered itinerary overlap, the itinerary mail is not mechanically excluded, but the priority of the itinerary data can be considered to apply itinerary management. In addition, in the above-mentioned third and fourth embodiments, although a dedicated e-mail device containing a program for sending and receiving e-mail in ROM62 has been described, it may be configured to record the program for sending and receiving e-mail in software. The program is implemented on a recording medium such as a disc or a compact disc on a general-purpose personal computer or word processor. That is, in the third embodiment, by recording the following programs on a recording medium driven by a general-purpose personal computer or word processor, the general-purpose methods can be operated as an e-mail device. The steps are as follows: an email receiving step for receiving e-mails; a trip data recording step for recording billion trips; a trip data identification step for discriminating whether the received email contains itineraries with itinerary information ; Itinerary data comparison step, when the itinerary identification step is identified as an itinerary email, the itinerary data contained in the itinerary email is compared with the itinerary data recorded in 100 million; the itinerary data recording control step is compared in this itinerary When it is detected that the two itinerary data does not overlap, it records the itinerary data of the itinerary mail received by it; and the itinerary data automatic sending step, and through the above itinerary data comparison step, it is detected that the two itinerary data are duplicated At the time of sending, I will send a letter to the received itinerary. 9 1-This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A 4 Zhuge (210X297 mm) (Read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) v Pack ·

、tT A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明(% ) 源自動地發送定形郵件。 另外,在第4實施形態中,藉將下列程式記錄在以通 用之値人電腦或字處理機等手段驅動之記錄媒體,可使該 等通用手段作為電子郵件裝置動作,該程式所包含之步 驟有:電子郵件收信步驟,用來接受電子郵件;行程資 料記億步驟,用來記億行程資料;行程資料辨別步驟, 用來辨別收信到之電子郵件是否為包含有行程資料之行 程郵件;行程資料比較步驟,藉由該行程資料辨別步驟 辨別為行程郵件時,將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料和 被記憶之行程資料加以比較;行程資料記億控制步驟, 當藉由該行程資料比較步驟檢測到該兩個行程資料並未 重複時,就記億收信到的行程郵件之行程資料;郵件條 件辨別步驟,當藉由上逑行程資料比較步驟檢測到上逑 兩傾行程資料有重複時,就用來辨別收信到之行程郵件 是否能滿足所定條件;和行程資料記億控制步驟,當藉 由上述郵件條件辨別步驟辨別為能滿足上述所定條件時 ,就刪除被記憶而重複之行程資料的同時,並記憶上述 行程郵件所包含之行程資料。 而且,在上述第3實施形態中,用以登錄行程之郵件 雖使用與通常郵件不同形態之行程郵件,但是,當在收 倍到的通常郵件之本文内檢測到有特定密碼時,就以該 通常郵件作為行程郵件亦可。另外,當行程登錄終了時 ,從收信郵件區域中消除該行程郵件,藉以節省收信郵 件區域之記億容量亦可。 -92- (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) &gt; n Ms m 、裝--- 訂 /Μ . 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(91 ) 而且,在上述第4實施形態中,雖使用了郵件位址作 為決定優先順序之條件,但是也得以郵件内之其他因素 (例如,會議名稱或參加者)作為預先被指定之條件。 若依照第3和第4實施形態時,與電子郵件之處理連 動而自動進行行程管理的同時,且與行程管理連動而自 動發送電子郵件。從而,在電子郵件之處理和行程管理 之處理互相連結的場合,可使該等處理簡化,而減輕使 用者之負載。 2 7 .第5實施形態 下面將説明本發明之第5實施形態。 第7 2圖是本發明第5實施形態的R A Μ 6 1之記億内容。本 實施形態之特徽在於設有行程暫時登錄區域的一點。第 7 3圖是第5實施形態之主流程,被構成為並無在第7圖 之主流程中步驟107之待命郵件消除處理,在步驟105 0 Ν旗標Ο M F為1的場合,在實行收信顯示處理之後,就 實施暫時登錄刪除處理(步驟108)。就該暫時登錄刪除 處理將於後面描述。 第5實施形態中之收信顯示處理與第8圔〜第10圔所 示之第1實施形態中收信顯示處理之流程相同,而且, 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閣讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 第9 _之收信顯示處理中步驟1 3 4之行程顯示處理亦與 第15画〜第18圖所示之流程相同。但是,第17圖之行程 顯示處理之步驟2 0 8中行程詳細顯示處理則與第1實施 形態不同。從而在第5實施形態中,對於與第1實施形 態相同之處理和相同之顯示畫面乃沿用第1實施形態之 -9 3 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ) 1 1 圖 面 9 同 時 9 就 其 重複 之說明 即予 從略, 下面 只説明與 1 1 第 1 實 施 形 態 不 同 之處 理。 1 I 1 · 8 · 行程詳細顯示處理。 '—. 請 ! 先 1 第 74 圖 第 80 圖 是第 5實施 形態 的行程 詳細 顯示處理 閎 讀 1 1 之 流 程 〇 而 且 9 第 8 1圔 是指定 曰之 行程詳 細顯 不畫面, 面 I 之 1 1 第 8 2 圖 是 該 曰 中 被 指定 之1 ® 行程 之行程 詳細 顯示畫面 '/主 意 1 I 事 1 第 83 _ 和 第 84 圖 Θ *d=i 疋足 形郵件 之顯 示畫面 〇 項 再 1 卜 在 第 74 圖 中 清 除行 程顯示 畫面 (步驟7 〇〇), 顯示(A) 1 本 4: 曰 之 行 程 詳 細 顯 示 之框 畫面(步驟701),其次, 將用以 頁 '—^ I 指 定 行 程 之 指 標 Π 設定 為1 (步 驟7 0 2),而 顯示 SCD(η) 1 1 I 之 曰 議 名 稱 和 時 間 資料 (步驟7 03) 〇 然後, 使η 遞增(步 1 1 驟 7 0 4) 9 辨 別 η 是 否超 過最大 數k (步驟70 5)。 當η並未 1 訂 1 超 過 k 時 9 就 轉 移 到步 驟 7 0 3, 用來顯示S CD(n)之會議 名 稱 和 時 間 資 料 〇 1 1 在 η 超 過 k 之 場 合, 就在第 8 1画 之畫面 顯示 (Α)日所 1 I 有 之 行 程 的 議 名 稱和 時間資 料。 在此種 狀態 將指標01 1 1 設 定 為 1 (步 驟 70 6) ,只 反轉顯 示SCD (m)(步驟7 07)。從 而 &gt; 最 初 反 轉 顯 示 畫面 最上面 的行 程。接 箸, 在畫面上 1 I 顯 示 滑 鼠 用 游 標 (步驟S 2 4 4 ), 辨別 滑鼠31 是否 被移動 1 I (步驟7 0 9 )〇 若被移動時就應其移動而移動游標位置(步 1 1 驟 7 1 〇) 〇 1 I 繼 而 5 在 第 7 5 圖 之流 程中, 辨別 滑鼠31 是否 被喀壢操 1 1 作 (步驟7 1 1 )〇 在未被喀喔操作時, 就轉移到第7 4圔之 1 I 步 驟 7 0 9 , 而辨別滑鼠之移動。 若被喀壢操作時,就辨 1 I -94- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(% ) 別游標位置是否在第81圖畫面之任一 SCD位置(步驟712) 。若是在該位置之場合,就將游標位置之S C D號碼設定在 指標m (步驟7 1 3 )。然而,只反轉顯示S C D ( m )(步驟7 1 4 ) 。然後,轉移到第7 4圖之步驟7 0 9,用來辨別滑鼠3 1之 移動。 在第? 5圔之步驟7 1 2中,當游標位置並非S C D位置之場 合,就辨別游檫位置是否在第8 1圖畫面之刪除開關之位 置(步驟7 1 5 )。若為該位置之場合,就刪除S C D ( m )之資 料(步驟716),將(A)日之行程加予分類(步驟717)。然 後,清除第8 1圖之顯示(步驟7 1 8 ),轉移到第7 4圔之步 驟7 01 ,用來顯示(A)日行程之框畫面。在第75圖之步驟 7 1 5,游標位置並非刪除開關之位置時,就辨別游標位 置是否在第81圖畫面的結束開關之位置(步驟719)。若 為該位置之場合,就清除第81圖畫面之顯示(步驟720) ,結束該行程詳細顯示處理之流程。 在步驟7 1 8清除顯示之後,就在第7 6_之流程中,辨 別在R A Μ 6 1的行程郵件之暫時登錄區域是否暫時記憶有 郵件(步驟7 2 1 )。若無郵件之場合,就轉移到第7 4圔之 步驟701,實行重新顯示Α日行程之處理。另一方面, 若有暫時被記億的郵件之場合,就將用以表示暫時登錄 區域的郵件號碼之指標k設定為1(步驟722),而邊使k 遞増,同時實行下列之各項處理。亦即,辨別在被刪除 之行程資料S C D (in )之時間帶内可否加入郵件(k )(步驟 ? 2 3 ),若可加入之場合,就將該郵件(k )之行程資料從 -9 5 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 1 n I n n n I I UA ίν^ n n n n - - (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 B7_ 五、發明説明(% ) 暫時登錄區域轉送到S C D U )(步驟7 2 4 )。 其次,以郵件(k)之發信源作為收信人,發送第84圖 所示之定形郵件B (步驟7 2 5 )。亦即,由於郵件(k )之行 程與被登錄之其他行程重複的緣故,所以訂正先前發送 之表示缺席之郵件,發送表示要登錄在行程區域之郵件 。然而,從暫時登錄區域消除該郵件(k)。其次,使k 遞増(步驟7 2 7 ),辨別k是否超過最大數(步驟7 2 8 )。在 k小於最大數之場合,就轉移到步驟7 2 3,辨別在S C D ( m ) 之時間帶内有否可加入之郵件(k)。 在步驟723中,以指標k所指定之郵件(k)未能加入 S C D ( m)的時間帶内之場合,就轉移到步驟7 2 7 ,邊使k遞 増。在步驟7 2 8中,當k超過最大數之場合,就轉移到 第7 4 _之步驟7 0 1 ,實行A日行程之重新顯示處理。 在第7 5圖之步驟7 1 9 ,若游標位置並非結束開關位置 之場合,就在第7 7圔之流程中辨別游標位置是否為詳細 開闊位置(步驟7 2 9 )。若非該位置之場合,就轉移到第 7 4画之步驟7 0 9而辨別滑鼠之移動,但游標位置為詳細 開關位置時,就清除第81圖畫面之顯示(步驟730)。然 而,顯示第82蘭所示之行程詳細顯示畫面(2),亦即, 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 顯示在第81圖之畫而被反轉顯示的SCD(ib)之行程詳細畫 面(步驟7 3 1 )。 其次,在第82圔之畫面顯示滑鼠用游標(步驟732), 辨別滑鼠31是否被移動(步驟733)。若被移動之場合, 就應其移動而移動游標位置(步驟7 3 4 )。接箸,辨別滑 -9 6 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A7 B7 五、發明説明(% ) 鼠3 1是否被喀喔操作(步驟7 3 5 ),若被喀喔時就辨別游 檫位置是否為第82圖畫面之結束開關位置(步驟736)。 若為該位置之場合,就清除第8 2圖畫面之顯示(步驟7 3 7 ) ,而結束該行程詳細顯示處理之流程。 在步驟7 3 6上,若游標位置並非結束開關位置之場合 ,就在第7 8圖之流程,辨別游標位置是否為第8 2 _畫面 之刪除開關位置(步驟7 3 8 )。若為該位置之場合,就進 行S C 1) ( m )之刪除處理(步驟7 3 9 h然後,辨別在R AM 6 1之 暫時登錄區域是否暫時記億有郵件(步驟74Q)。若無郵 件之場合,就轉移到第7 7圖之步驟7 3 3,而辨別滑鼠3 1 之移動。若有被暫時記億的郵件之場合,就將用以表示 暫時登錄區域的郵件號碼之指標k設定為1 (步驟7 4 1 ) ,邊使k遞増,而實行下列各項處理。亦即,辨別在被 刪除的行程資料S C D ( m )之時間帶内可否加入郵件(k )之 行程(步驟7 4 2 ),若可加入之場合,就將該郵件(k )之行 程資料從暫時登錄區域轉送到S C D ( m )(步驟7 4 3 )。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 繼而,以郵件(k )之發信漉作為收信人,發送第8 4圔 所示之定形郵件B (步驟7 4 4 )。然後,從暫時登錄區域中 消除郵件(k )(步驟7 4 5 )。然而,使k遞增(步驟7 4 6 ), 而辨別k是否超過最大數(步驟747)。若k小於最大數 之場合,就轉移到步驟7 4 2 ,辨別是否有進入S C D (in )之 時間帶内之郵件(k )。 在步驟742,當以指標k指定之郵件(k)未進入SCD(m) 之時間帶内時,就轉移到步驟7 4 6而使k遞増。在步驟 -9 7 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(站) 747,當k超過最大數時,就轉移到第77_之步驟730而 清除該顯示。 在第7 8圏之步驟7 3 8 ,若游標位置並非刪除開關位置 之場合,就辨別游標位置是否為第8 2畫面之訂正開關位 置(步驟7 4 8 )。若為該位置之場合,就進行S C D (re)之行 程訂正處理(步驟7 4 9 ),辨別S C D ( m )之時間帶是否已淨 空(步驟7 5 0)。已淨空之場合就轉移到步驟7 4 Q ,辨別是 否有被暫時記億在暫時登錄區域之郵件。假如在暫時登 錄區域有郵件時,就實行與刪除處理同樣之處理。 在步驟7 4 8中,當游擦位置不在訂正開關位置之場合, 就轉移到第77圔之步驟7 3 3 ,以辨別滑鼠3 1之移動。另 外,在第78圖之步驟750,當SCD(m)之時間帶未淨空之 情況時,例如,在有會議場所和參加者之訂正之情況時 ,就轉移到第7 7圖之步驟7 3 3 ,以辨別滑鼠3 1之移動。 第79圖是第78_之步驟739之刪除處理之流程。在該 處理中,指定參加者之一人(步驟7 5 1 )。然後,以該 參加者之郵件位址作為第8 3圔所示之缺席通知的定形郵 件A之收信人(步驟7 5 2 )。其次,將SCD (m)之資料寫入 定形郵件A之本文(步驟7 5 3 ),自動的發送定形郵件A (步驟7 5 4 )。其次,辨別是否已完成參加者全體人員之 指定而發送了定形郵件A (步驟7 5 5 )。在參加者全體人員 之指定尚未完成之情況時就轉移到步驟751,用來指定 下一値參加者。在步驟7 5 5 ,當完成參加者全體人員之 指定,對全體人員發信過定形郵件A時,就消除S C D ( m ) -98- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210 X 297公釐) (請先閎讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) —叙· 訂 A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ) 1 1 之 資 料 (步驟7 5 6 ), 然後結束該刪除處理之 流程 〇 1 1 第 80 圖 是 第 78 圖 步驟 749中訂正處理之流 程。 在該 處 1 I 理 中 &gt; 將 文 字 游 標 顯示 在第82圖畫面之會議名稱區域 -S 請 1 先 1 (步驟7 57 )〇 然後, 辨別滑鼠3 1是否被移動 (步驟7 5 8 ) β 聞 % 1 I 在 有 被 移 動 之 情 況 時, 就應該移動而移動游標(步驟 7 5 9 ) 背 © 1 I 之 1 I 0 其 次 , 辨 別 滑 鼠 3 1是 否被喀喔(步驟7 6 0 ) ,當 有被 喀 注 意 1 I 事 1 m 時 就 辨 別 游 標 位 苗曰 置疋 否在第82圖.畫面之任一輸入區域 項 再 1 (步驟7 6 1 )〇 若在於任- -輸入區域位置之情 況時 ,就 使 填 寫 本 ί' 文 字 游 標 移 動 到 該 輸入 區域(步驟7 6 2 )。 頁 '—^ I 使 文 字 游 標 移 動 之後 ,或在步驟7 6 0滑鼠 3 1未 被喀 喔 通 1 之 情 況 時 , 就 辨 別 是否 進行過來自鍵盤之資料輸入或文 1 1 字 刪 除 等 訂 正 (步驟7 6 3 )。在已進行過資料 之輸 入或 訂 1 訂 TE 之 情 況 時 &gt; 就 變 更有 文字游標的輸入區域之行程資料 1 (步驟7 64 ), 變更有文字游標的輸入區域之 顯示 (步驟765) 1 1 〇 然 後 * 在 步 驟 7 6 3並未進行過資料之輸入 和訂 正之 情況 1 I 時 9 就 轉 移 到 步 驟 7 58, 以辨別滑鼠3 1之移 動。 1 1 在 步 驟 7 6 1, 當游標位置並非輸入區域之 位置 時, 就 ( Τ 辨 別 游 標 位 置 是 否 為第 82画畫面之結束開關之位置(步 1 1 驟 7 6 G) 〇 並 非 該 位 置之 情況時就轉移到步驟7 5 8而辨 別 1 滑 鼠 3 1 之 移 動 〇 在 步驟 7 6 6上,當游標位置 是在 結束 開關 1 1 位 置 之 情 況 時 就 結 束該 訂正處理之流程。 1 | 2 9 收 信 處 理 1 1 第 85 圖 是 因 m 計 時器 中斷實行的收信處理之流程。 在 1 I 該 處 理 中 9 辨 別 有 否收 信郵件(步驟7 6 7 ), 若有 收信 郵件 1 1 I -9 9 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A7 B7 五、發明説明(W) 之情況時,辨別在R A Μ 6 1之收信郵件區域有否空白(步驟 768)。並無空白之情況時,就刪除最早之收信時日之郵 件,而使該區域淨空(步驟7 6 9 ),然後轉移到步驟7 6 8。 在步驟7 6 8若有空白區域之情況時,或是在步驟7 6 9當有 郵件被刪除之情況時,就將收信郵件儲存在該空白區域 (步驟7 7 0 )。然後,在被儲存之收信郵件附加開封旗標 K A I F ϋ ( = 0 )(步驟7 7 1 ),在被儲存之.收信郵件附加Τ I Μ Ε (收信時刻 &gt; (步驟7 7 2 )。 接著,辨別用以表示郵件種類之旗標S C F是否為0,亦 即辨別收信郵件是否為通常郵件(步驟773)。當該旗瘭為 〇,收信郵件為通常郵件之情況時,就結束該收信處理。 當S C F為]之情況時,亦即當收信郵件為會議舉行通知 郵件之情況時,就指定與收信郵件之會議舉行年月曰對 應日之行程區域(步驟774)。其次,將指標η設定為1( 步驟7 7 5 ),使η遞増,同時辨別與收信郵件之會議舉行 年月日對應日的行程(η)之時間帶和收信郵件之時間帶 是否重複(步驟7 7 6 )。並無時間帶的重複之情況時就使 η遞増(步驟7 7 7 ),辨別η是否超過當日已登錄過之行 程數(步驟口 8 )。當η未超過行程數之情況時就轉移到 步驟7½,以辨別與η所指定之行程(η )的時間帶之重複。 然後,在步驟7 7 6〜步驟7 7 8中,使η遞増,同時辨別 與對應日所登錄的行程之時間帶的重複,若有時間帶重 複之行程(η )時,就以收信郵件之發信源作為收信人, 自動的發送第8 3画所示之定形郵件Α (步驟7 7 9 )。然後, -100- 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) ---------广袭------tT------ύ. (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) A7 B7 五、發明説明(&quot;) 將收信郵件儲存在R AM 6 1之槧時登錄區域(步驟7 8 ϋ ),結 束該收信處理之流程,回到第7 3圖之主流程。另一方面 ,在步驟7 7 8,當η超過行程數,所有之行程的時間帶 與收信郵件的時間帶不重複之情況時,就指定會議舉行 年月日的行程區域之空白區域(步驟7 8 1 ),將收信郵件 之資料儲存在該空白區域(步驟7 8 2 )。然後,結束該收 信處理之流程,回到第7 3圔之主流程。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 (請先聞讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 第8 6圖是第7 3圖的主流程之步驟1 0 8的暫時登錄刪除 處理之流程。在該處理中,辨別是否有郵件被儲存在 F. A Μ (Π之暫時登錄區域(步驟7 8 3 ),假如並無郵件時就立 即結束該流程。若在暫時登錄區域有郵件時,就指定該 區域内之郵件(步驟7 8 4 ),辨別被指定的郵件内之開始 時日是否超過規在時日(步驟7 8 5 )。若開始時日超過現 在時日之情況時,就刪除該郵件(步驟786)。在刪除郵 件之後,或被指定郵件之開始時日尚未超過現在時曰 之情況時,就辨別區域内郵件是否已全部被指定(步驟 7 8 7 )。在郵件尚未全部被指定之情況時,就轉移到步驟 784,用來指定下一個郵件。在步驟787,當全部郵件已 被指定之情況時,就結束該暫時登錄刪除處理之流程, 回到第7 3圖之主流程。 似此,若依照上述第5實施形態者,R A Μ 6 1之行程區 域乃構成用以記億行程資料之行程記憶手段,行程郵件 暫時登錄區域即構成用以辑時記億收信到之行程郵件之 暫時記億手段。然而,C P U 51之構成包含有:郵件收信 -1 0 1 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X 297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明( ) 1 1 手 段 » 用 來 接 受 郵 件 辨 別 手 段 &gt; 用 來 辨 別 收 信 到 之 郵 1 1 件 是 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 比 較 手 段 9 當 辨 1 別 為 行 程 郵 件 時 &gt; 就 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 /·—S 請 1 先 1 被 記 億 在 行 程 TrT ΙΞΞ 域 的 行 程 資 料 加 以 fcb 較 和 記 憶 控 制 手 閎 1 1 段 » 當 撿 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 並 未 重 複 時 就將 收 信 到 背 面 1 I 之 I 的 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 記 憶 在 行 程 區 域 〇 另 外 &gt; 當 檢 測 注 意 1 I 事 1 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 就 將. 收 信 到 之 行 程 郵 件 暫 項 I 再 Γ 時 記 億 在 暫時登錄區域 〇 填 寫 本 k C Ρ ϋ 5 1更構成 變更手段, 用來變更被記億在行程區 頁 ^^ 1 I 域 之 行 程 資 料 和 資 料 轉 送 手 段 &gt; 當 行 程 資 料 被 變 更 時 1 1 5 在 被 記 憶 於 行 程 區 域 的 重 複 之 行 TfH 程 資 料 已 淨 空 之 情 況 1 1 &gt; 用 來 將 被 記 億 在 暫 時 登 錄 區 域 的 重 複 之 行 程 資 料 轉 送 1 訂 到 行 程 區 域 〇 1 妖 而 5 在 郵 件 之 處理和行程管理之處理 互 相 連 結 之 情 1 1 況 9 與 一 方 之 處 理 連 動 而 白 動 的 進 行 另 一 方 之 處 理 9 同 1 I 時 行 程 有 變 更 之 情 況 &gt; 就 進 行 因 應 該 變 更 之 郵 件 處 理 〇 1 1 從 而 5 在 郵 件 之 處 理 和 行 程 管 理 之 處 理 互 相 連 結 之 情 況 Ci 1 時 9 可 消 除 煩 雜 之 作 業 而 減 輕 使 用 者 之 負 擔 9 同 時 &gt; 旦 1 在 變 更 行 程 時 得 有 3〇〇 W 性 的 應 付 〇 1 另 外 &gt; 在 上 述 第 5 實 施 形 態 中 雖 然 就 R 〇 Μ 6 2内收納 1 I 有 用 以 收 發 電 子 郵 件 的 程 式 之 專 用 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 加 以 說 1 | 明 但 是 &gt; 亦 可 構 成 為 將 用 以 收 發 電 子 郵 件 之 程 式 記 錄 1 1 在 軟 碟 或 光 碟 等 媒 ρ 9 而 使 通 用 之 個 人 電 腦 或 字 處 理 機 1 | 等 手 段 實 行 該 程 式 〇 1 1 -1 0 2 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明( ) 1 1 亦 m 藉 將 下 列 程 式 記 錄 在 以 通 用 之 個 人 電 腦 或 字 處 1 1 理 機 等 手 段 驅 動 之 媒 體 而 使 該 等 通 用 手 段 作 為 電 子 郵 1 1 件 裝 置 動 作 9 該 程 式 所 包 含 之 步 驟 有 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 —S 請 1 先 1 驟 &gt; 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 行 程 資 料 記 億 步 驟 9 用 來 將 行 聞 讀 1 I 程 資 料 記 憶 在 行 程 記 億 手 段 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 9 用 來 背 1 I 之 1 辨 別 收 信 到 之 郵 件 是 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 9 注 意 1 I 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 &gt; m 該 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 辨 別 為 行 程 事 項 再 1 1 郵 件 時 9 就 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 上 述 行 程 寫 本 k 記 億 手 段 所 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 比 較 9 ' 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 頁 1 I 制 步 驟 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 檢 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 1 1 料 並 不 重 複 時 9 就 將 收 信 到 的 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 記 億 1 1 在 上 述 行 程 記 憶 手 段 行 程 資 料 暫 時 記 億 控 制 步 驟 * 藉 1 訂 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 檢 測 到 上 逑 兩 値 行 程 資 料 有 重 1 複 時 就 將 上 述 收 信 到 之 行 程 郵 件 暫 時 記 億 在 暫 時 記 億 1 手 段 行 程 資 料 變 更 步 :驟 9 用 來 變 更 被 記 億 在 上 述 行 程 1 I 記 億 手 段 之 行 程 資 料 和 行 程 資 料 轉 送 步 驟 » 藉 由 該 行 1 1 程 資 料 更 步 驟 變 更 行 程 資 料 時 , 而 被 記 億 於 上 述 行 程 I 記 憶 手 段 的 重 複 之 行 程 資 料 已 被 淨 空 者 9 就 將 被 記 億 在 1 I 上 逑 暫 時 記 億 手 段 的 重 複 之 行 程 資 料 轉 送 到 上 述 行 程 記 1 I 11 手 段 〇 1 另 外 在 上 述 第 5 實 施 形 態 中 &gt; 用 以 登 錄 行 程 之 郵 件 1 雖 使 用 了 與 通 常 郵 件 不 同 形 態 之 行 程 郵 件 9 但 是 , 當 檢 1 1 測 到 所 收 信 的 逋 常 郵 件 之 本 文 内 有 一 特 定 密 碼 時 9 以 該 1 I 通 常 郵 件 作 為 行 程 郵 件 亦 可 〇 另 外 ί 當 行 程 登 錄 *±1* 兀 成 時 1 -1 0 2 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標隼(CNS ) A4規格(21 OX 297公釐) A7 B7 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 五、發明説明 ( ) 1 1 t 從 牧 信 郵 件 區 域 中 消 除 該 行 程 郵 件 9 以 求 節 省 收 信 郵 1 1 件 區 域 之 記 憶 容 景 〇 1 1 若 依 眧 上 述 第 5 實 施 形 態 者 , 當 郵 件 之 處 理 和 行 程 管 /·—V 請 ! 先 1 理 之 處 理 .百 相 連 結 之 場 合 與 一 方 之 處 理 連 動 而 白 動 進 閲 讀 1 I 行 另 —* 方 之 處 理 9 同 時 9 若 行 程 有 變 更 之 情 況 時 9 就 库 背 1 I 之 1 其 變 更 進 行 郵 件 之 處 理 〇 從 而 » 當 郵 件 之 處 理 和 行 程 管 注 意 1 1 事 1 理 之 處 理 互 相 連 結 之 情 況 時 , 可 消. 除 煩 雜 之 作 業 而 減 輕 項 再 1 1 使 用 者 之 負 擔 ί 遇 行 程 變 更 時 亦 可 3〇t» W 性 應 付 〇 填 寫 本 k 参 考 符 號 説 明 頁 1 I 2 1 A , 2 1 B , 2 1 C . .電子郵件裝置 1 1 I 5 . LA N 1 1 15 WAN 1 訂 1 ] B , 11 C , 1 1 V. .電子郵件服務部 1 2 2 輸 入 部 1 1 2 3 輸 出 部 1 I 2 4 控 制 部 1 1 2 5 記 憶 部 午 2 6 通 信 控 制 部 1 I 3 1 滑 鼠 1 1 3 2 鍵 盤 1 | 4 1 輸 出 控 制 部 1 1 4 2 顯 示 手 段 1 1 5 1 CPU 1 6 1 RAM 1 1 1 6 2 RO Μ 1 1 -1 0 4 - 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X 297公釐), TT A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of Invention (%) The source automatically sends a fixed email. In addition, in the fourth embodiment, by recording the following programs on a recording medium driven by a general-purpose computer or word processor, the general-purpose methods can be operated as an e-mail device. The steps included in the program There are: E-mail receiving steps for receiving e-mail; Itinerary data recording steps for recording 100 million itinerary data; Itinerary data identification steps for identifying whether the received emails are itinerary mails containing itinerary data ; Itinerary data comparison step. When the itinerary is identified as an itinerary mail by the itinerary data identification step, the itinerary data contained in the itinerary mail is compared with the memorized itinerary data. The itinerary data is recorded in the control step. When the comparison step detects that the two itinerary data are not duplicated, it records the itinerary data of the itinerary emails received by the billion; the mail condition identification step, when it is detected by the previous itinerary data comparison step that When it is repeated, it is used to identify whether the received itinerary mail can meet the predetermined conditions; and itinerary data is recorded in 100 million yuan. Molding step, when the message by means of the above-described condition discriminating step of discriminating when satisfying the above predetermined conditions, and to delete a repeated stroke data memory simultaneously, the memory and the message contained in the above-described travel itinerary information. Furthermore, in the third embodiment described above, although the mail for registering the itinerary uses an itinerary mail in a different form from the normal mail, when a specific password is detected in the body of the received normal mail, the corresponding password is used. Usually, mail can be used as itinerary. In addition, when the registration of the itinerary is ended, the itinerary of the itinerary will be eliminated from the mail receiving area, so as to save hundreds of millions of capacity in the mail receiving area. -92- (Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page) &gt; n Ms m 、 install --- order / Μ. This paper size is applicable to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 5 Explanation of the invention (91) Furthermore, in the above-mentioned fourth embodiment, although the mail address is used as a condition for determining the priority order, other factors (for example, meeting name or participants) in the mail may be designated in advance Condition. According to the third and fourth embodiments, e-mail management is automatically performed in conjunction with e-mail processing, and e-mail is automatically transmitted in conjunction with the itinerary management. Therefore, in the case where the processing of e-mail and the processing of schedule management are interconnected, such processing can be simplified and the load on the user can be reduced. 27. Fifth Embodiment A fifth embodiment of the present invention will be described below. Fig. 72 shows the contents of R A M 61 according to the fifth embodiment of the present invention. The special emblem of this embodiment lies in the point where a temporary registration area is provided. Fig. 73 is the main flow of the fifth embodiment, and it is constituted so that the standby mail elimination processing of step 107 is not included in the main flow of Fig. 7. When step 105 0 Ν flag 0 MF is 1, it is implemented. After the reception display process, the temporary registration deletion process is performed (step 108). The temporary registration deletion process will be described later. The reception display process in the fifth embodiment is the same as the flow of the reception display process in the first embodiment shown in 8th to 10th. It is also printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Please read the notes on the back and fill in this page again.) The display process of steps 1 3 4 in the reception display process of the 9th _ is also the same as the process shown in the 15th to 18th drawings. However, the detailed stroke display processing in step 208 of the stroke display processing in FIG. 17 is different from the first embodiment. Therefore, in the fifth embodiment, the same processing and the same display screen as in the first embodiment are used in accordance with the first embodiment-9 3-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention () 1 1 Drawing 9 Simultaneous 9 The duplicate descriptions are omitted. The following only describes the processing that is different from the 1 1 first implementation form. 1 I 1 · 8 · Stroke detailed display processing. '—. Please! First, Figure 74, Figure 80, and Figure 5 are the detailed display of the itinerary of the fifth embodiment. Read the flow of 1 1 and 9. 8 1 is the detailed display screen of the specified stroke. 1 Figure 8 2 is the detailed display screen of the designated 1 ® itinerary in that day '/ idea 1 I matter 1 83_ and 84 Figure Θ * d = i 疋 foot-shaped mail display screen 0 items and 1 b In Fig. 74, the itinerary display screen is cleared (step 7 〇〇), and (A) is displayed. 1 book 4: The frame screen for detailed display of the itinerary (step 701). Secondly, it will be specified by page '— ^ I The index Π is set to 1 (step 7 0 2), and the SCD (η) 1 1 I is displayed as the name and time information (step 7 03). Then, η is incremented (step 1 1 step 7 0 4) 9 Discrimination Whether η exceeds the maximum number k (step 70 5). When η is not 1 and order 1 exceeds k, 9 moves to step 703, which is used to display the meeting name and time information of SCD (n). 0 1 1 When η exceeds k, it is drawn in the 81st. The screen displays the schedule name and time information of the trips that I have on day 1 I. In this state, the index 01 1 1 is set to 1 (step 70 6), and only SCD (m) is displayed in reverse (step 7 07). And &gt; initially reverse the top line of the display. Next, the mouse cursor is displayed on the screen at 1 I (step S 2 4 4), and it is discriminated whether the mouse 31 is moved 1 I (step 7 0 9). If it is moved, the cursor position should be moved according to its movement ( Step 1 1 Step 7 1 〇) 〇1 I then 5 In the flow chart in Figure 7 5, identify whether the mouse 31 was operated by clicking 1 1 (step 7 1 1). When not operating, click Move to 7th 4th to 1st step 7 0 9 and discern the movement of the mouse. If it is operated by a click, it will be identified 1 I -94- 1 1 1 1 This paper size is applicable to China National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) Printed by A7 B7, Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Explain (%) whether the cursor position is at any of the SCD positions in the picture in FIG. 81 (step 712). If it is at this position, the SC D number of the cursor position is set to the index m (step 7 1 3). However, only S C D (m) is displayed in reverse (step 7 1 4). Then, it transfers to step 7 0 9 in Fig. 74 to discriminate the movement of the mouse 31. In the first? In step 7 1 of step 5, when the cursor position is not in the position of the SC D position, it is discriminated whether the position of the cursor is in the position of the delete switch on the screen of Fig. 81 (step 7 1 5). If it is the position, the data of SCD (m) is deleted (step 716), and the trip on day (A) is added to the classification (step 717). Then, clear the display in Figure 81 (step 7 1 8), and move to step 7 01 in step 74, which is used to display the frame screen of (A) day trip. In step 7 1 5 of FIG. 75, when the cursor position is not the position of the delete switch, it is discriminated whether the cursor position is at the end switch position of the screen in FIG. 81 (step 719). If it is the position, the display of the picture in FIG. 81 is cleared (step 720), and the detailed display processing flow of the stroke is ended. After the display is cleared in step 7 1 8, it is discriminated in the flow of step 7 6_ whether it is temporarily stored in the temporary registration area of the travel mail of the RAM 6 1 (step 7 2 1). If there is no e-mail, go to step 701 of step 74, and execute the process of re-displaying the schedule on day A. On the other hand, if there is an e-mail that has been temporarily recorded as 100 million, the index k indicating the e-mail number of the temporarily registered area is set to 1 (step 722), and while k is incremented, the following items are performed simultaneously. deal with. That is, it is determined whether the mail (k) can be added within the time zone of the deleted travel data SCD (in) (step? 2 3). If it can be added, the travel data of the mail (k) is changed from -9 5-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) 1 n I nnn II UA ίν ^ nnnn--(Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page) A7 B7_ V. Description of the invention ( %) Transfer the temporary registration area to SCDU) (step 7 2 4). Next, using the source of the mail (k) as the recipient, send the shaped mail B shown in Fig. 84 (step 7 2 5). That is, because the travel of the mail (k) is duplicated with other registered itineraries, the previously sent absent mail is corrected, and the mail indicated to be registered in the travel area is sent. However, the message (k) is eliminated from the temporary registration area. Next, iterates k (step 7 2 7), and discriminates whether k exceeds the maximum number (step 7 2 8). When k is less than the maximum number, it moves to step 7 2 3 to discriminate whether there are any mails (k) that can be added within the time zone of SC D (m). In step 723, if the mail (k) specified by the index k cannot be added to the time slot of S CD (m), the process moves to step 7 2 7 while letting k pass. When k exceeds the maximum number in step 7 2 8, the process shifts to step 7 1 of step 7 4 _ and the re-display processing of the A-day schedule is performed. In step 7 19 of FIG. 75, if the cursor position is not the end switch position, it is determined whether the cursor position is a detailed open position in the flow of step 7 (7) (step 7 2 9). If it is not at this position, move to step 7 0 9 of the 74th drawing to discern the movement of the mouse, but when the cursor position is the detailed switch position, the display of the screen in FIG. 81 is cleared (step 730). However, the detailed itinerary display screen (2) shown in blue 82 is displayed, that is, printed by the staff consumer cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the precautions on the back before filling this page). The picture shown in Figure 81 The SCD (ib) detailed stroke screen is displayed in reverse (step 7 3 1). Next, the cursor for the mouse is displayed on the screen at step 82 (step 732), and it is determined whether the mouse 31 has been moved (step 733). If it is moved, move the cursor position according to its movement (step 7 3 4). Next, identify slip-9 6-This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) A7 B7 V. Description of the invention (%) Whether rat 3 1 has been operated (step 7 3 5), If it is clicked, it is discriminated whether the position of the peregrine falcon is the end switch position of the picture in FIG. 82 (step 736). If it is the position, the display of the screen in Fig. 82 (step 7 3 7) is cleared, and the detailed display processing flow of the stroke is ended. In step 7 36, if the cursor position is not the end switch position, it is determined whether the cursor position is the delete switch position of the 8 2 _ screen in the flow of FIG. 7 (step 7 3 8). If it is at this location, delete the SC 1) (m) (step 7 39 h), then determine whether there is a temporary mail in the temporary registration area of RAM 6 1 (step 74Q). If there is no mail In this case, move to step 7 3 3 in FIG. 7 and discern the movement of the mouse 31. If there is an e-mail that has been temporarily recorded as 100 million, an index k indicating the e-mail number of the temporarily registered area will be used. Set it to 1 (step 7 4 1), and execute the following processing while increasing k, that is, identify whether the itinerary of the mail (k) can be added within the time zone of the deleted itinerary data SCD (m) ( Step 7 4 2), if it can be added, the itinerary information of the mail (k) is transferred from the temporary registration area to the SCD (m) (step 7 4 3). Printed by the Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs ( Please read the precautions on the back before filling in this page.) Then, using the sender of mail (k) as the recipient, send the fixed mail B shown in step 8 4 (step 7 4 4). Then, log in temporarily Message (k) in the zone (step 7 4 5). However, increase k (step 7 4 6), and determine whether k exceeds the maximum number (step 747). If k is less than the maximum number, move to step 7 4 2 to identify whether there is a mail (k) within the time zone of entering SCD (in). In step 742, when the mail (k) designated by the index k does not enter the time zone of the SCD (m), it moves to step 7 4 6 to make k pass. In step -97-this paper size applies to China Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 X 297 mm) Printed by the Consumers Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs A7 B7 V. Invention description (station) 747. When k exceeds the maximum number, go to step 730 of 77_ And the display is cleared. In step 7 38 of the 7th eighth step, if the cursor position is not the delete switch position, it is discriminated whether the cursor position is the correction switch position of the 82nd screen (step 7 4 8). If it is In the case of the position, the SCD (re) travel correction process is performed (step 7 4 9), and it is discriminated whether the time zone of the SCD (m) is cleared (step 7 50). When the cleared space is shifted to step 7 4 Q To identify if there are any e-mails temporarily registered in the temporary registration area. When there is a mail in the area, the same processing as that of the deletion process is performed. In step 7 4 8, when the wipe position is not in the correction switch position, move to step 7 3 3 of 77th to identify the mouse 3 1 In addition, in step 750 of FIG. 78, when there is no headroom in the time of SCD (m), for example, if there is a correction of the meeting place and the participants, the process moves to FIG. 7 7 Step 7 3 3 to distinguish the movement of the mouse 31. Fig. 79 is the flow of the deletion process in step 739 of 78_. In this process, one of the participants is designated (step 7 5 1). Then, the mail address of the participant is used as the recipient of the fixed mail A of the absent notice shown in 83 (2) (step 7 5 2). Second, write the data of SCD (m) into the text of the fixed mail A (step 7 5 3), and send the fixed mail A automatically (step 7 5 4). Next, it is discriminated whether or not the designation of all the participants has been completed and a fixed mail A has been sent (step 7 5 5). If the designation of all participants has not been completed, the process proceeds to step 751, which is used to designate the next participant. In step 7 5 5, when the designation of all the participants is completed, and the fixed mail A is sent to all the people, the SCD (m) -98- is eliminated. This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210 X 297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) —Summarize · Order A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the invention) 1 1 (Step 7 5 6), Then, the flow of the deletion processing is ended. Fig. 80 is the flow of the correction processing in step 749 of Fig. 78. In this case, I will display the text cursor in the meeting name area on the screen in Figure 82-S Please 1 first (step 7 57). Then, identify whether the mouse 3 1 has been moved (step 7 5 8). β scent% 1 I should be moved when the cursor is moved (step 7 5 9) Back © 1 I of 1 I 0 Secondly, identify whether the mouse 3 1 is clicked (step 7 6 0) When you notice 1 I and 1 m, you can distinguish whether the cursor position Miao Yue is set in Fig. 82. Any input area item on the screen is again 1 (step 7 6 1). If it is any--input area position In this case, the text cursor is moved to the input area (step 7 6 2). Page '— ^ I After the text cursor is moved, or when the mouse 3 1 is not clicked in step 7 6 0, it is determined whether the data input from the keyboard or the text 1 1 word deletion has been corrected ( Step 7 6 3). In the case where data has been entered or a TE has been ordered &gt; The itinerary data 1 of the input area with text cursor is changed (step 7 64), and the display of the input area with text cursor is changed (step 765) 1 1 〇 Then * In the case where the data input and correction has not been performed in step 7 6 3, when 1 I 9 goes to step 7 58 to identify the movement of mouse 31. 1 1 In step 7 61, when the position of the cursor is not the position of the input area, it is (T to determine whether the position of the cursor is the position of the end switch of the 82nd picture (step 1 1 step 7 6 G) 〇 it is not the case At this time, it moves to step 7 5 8 and discriminates the movement of 1 mouse 3 1. At step 7 6, when the cursor position is the end switch 1 1 position, the flow of the correction process is ended. 1 | 2 9 Receiving process 1 1 The 85th figure is the flow of the receiving process that was interrupted by the m timer. In 1 I this process 9 identifies whether there is a receiving mail (step 7 6 7), if there is a receiving mail 1 1 I -9 9-1 1 1 1 This paper size is in accordance with Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm). Printed by A7 B7 of the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. Is there a blank space in the mail receiving area of RA Μ 1 (step 768). If there is no blank space, delete the earliest mail at the earliest receiving date and make the area clear. (Step 7 6 9), and then move to Step 7 6 8. If there is a blank area in step 7 6 8 or when a mail is deleted in step 7 6 9, the received mail is stored In this blank area (step 7 7 0). Then, the unopened flag KAIF ϋ (= 0) is attached to the stored incoming mail (step 7 7 1), and T I Μ Ε is attached to the stored incoming mail. (Receiving time> (Step 7 7 2). Next, it is determined whether the flag SCF indicating the type of mail is 0, that is, whether the received mail is a normal mail (step 773). When the flag is 0 When the received mail is a normal mail, the reception processing is terminated. When the SCF is], that is, when the received mail is a notification mail of the conference, the meeting of the designated and received mail is held. Year, month, and day travel area corresponding to the day (step 774). Second, set the index η to 1 (step 7 7 5), make η recursively, and identify the schedule of the day corresponding to the year, month, and day of the meeting with the received mail ( Whether the time zone of η) and the time zone of the received mail are repeated (step 7 7 6). There is no time When the tape is repeated, η will be stepped forward (step 7 7 7), to determine whether η exceeds the number of trips registered on the day (step 8). When η does not exceed the number of trips, go to step 7½, To discriminate the repetition of the time zone with the travel (η) specified by η. Then, in steps 7 7 6 to 7 7 8, n is incremented, and the time zone repetition with the itinerary registered on the corresponding day is discriminated. If there is a time course (η) that is repeated in the time zone, a letter is received. The sender of the mail is used as the recipient, and the shaped mail A shown in Fig. 83 is automatically sent (step 7 7 9). Then, -100- This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 specification (210X297 mm) --------- Wide Attack ------ tT ------ ύ. (Please (Please read the notes on the back before filling this page) A7 B7 V. Inventory (&quot;) Store the received mail in the registration area at the time of RAM 6 1 (step 7 8)), and end the process of receiving the mail , Return to the main flow of Figure 73. On the other hand, in step 7 7 8, when η exceeds the number of trips, and the time zone of all the trips does not overlap with the time zone of the received mail, a blank area of the trip area where the meeting is held is specified (step 7 8 1), store the data of the received mail in the blank area (step 7 8 2). Then, the process of this mail processing is ended, and the process returns to the main process of No. 73. Printed by the Employees' Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs (please read the notes on the back before filling out this page) Figure 8 6 is the temporary registration deletion process of step 108 of the main flow of Figure 7 3. In this process, it is discriminated whether any mail is stored in the temporary registration area of F. A Μ (Step 7 8 3), if there is no mail, the process is immediately ended. If there is a mail in the temporary registration area, then Specify the mail in the area (step 7 8 4), and discriminate whether the start date and time in the designated mail exceed the specified time (step 7 8 5). If the start date exceeds the current date, delete it The mail (step 786). After deleting the mail, or when the start date of the designated mail has not exceeded the present time, it is discriminated whether all the mails in the area have been designated (step 7 8 7). After the mail has not been all When designated, the process moves to step 784 to specify the next mail. In step 787, when all mails have been designated, the process of the temporary registration deletion process is ended, and the process returns to FIG. 7 3 Similarly, if according to the above fifth embodiment, the travel area of the RA M 61 is a travel memory means for recording 100 million travel data, and the temporary registration area of the travel e-mail is used to record 100 million time. The means of temporarily remembering billions of mail traveled by the letter. However, the composition of the CPU 51 includes: mail reception-1 0 1-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) Α4 specification (210X 297 mm) A7 B7 Ministry of Economic Affairs Printed by the Consumer Standards Cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards 5. Description of Invention (1) Means »Recognition Means for Accepting Mail &gt; Recognition Means for Receiving Mail 1 1 Whether it is an itinerary mail comparison means containing itinerary information 9 When When identifying 1 as an itinerary email, we will include the itinerary data and / · S included in the itinerary email. Please compare the memory data in the itinerary of the itinerary TrT ΙΞΞ with the fcb. »When it is detected that the two itinerary data does not overlap, the itinerary data of the itinerary mail received to the back 1 I of I is stored in the itinerary area. OTHERS &gt; When the detection notice 1 I Event 1 to the two itinerary information will be repeated. The received itinerary mail temporary item I will then be recorded in the temporary registration area. Filling out this k C Ρ ϋ 5 1 constitutes a means of change, used to change the Record billions in the itinerary area page ^^ 1 I itinerary data and data transfer means &gt; When the itinerary data is changed 1 1 5 In the case of repeated trips to TfH memorized in the itinerary area, the case data has been cleared 1 1 &gt; It is used to transfer the repeated itinerary data recorded in the temporary registration area to 1 and book it in the itinerary area. 0 1 Demon 5 It is linked with the processing of mail and the management of itinerary. 1 1 Case 9 It is linked with the processing of one party. The other party's processing will be carried out automatically. 9 If the schedule is changed at the same time as 1 I &gt; the mail processing according to the change will be performed. 0 1 1 and 5 Dealing with interconnected conditions Ci 1 Hour 9 Eliminates cumbersome tasks and reduces user burden 9 At the same time &gt; Once 1 It is necessary to deal with 300W when changing the schedule 〇1 In addition, in the fifth embodiment described above Although it is explained in 1 that there is a dedicated e-mail device containing a program for sending and receiving e-mails in ROM 6.2, it can also be configured to record the program for sending and receiving e-mails 1 1 on a floppy disk Or media such as optical discs ρ 9 to implement the program on a general-purpose personal computer or word processor 1 | etc. 〇1 1 -1 0 2 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to the Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X 297) (%) A7 B7 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 5. Description of the Invention () 1 1 Yim borrowed the following program to be recorded on a general-purpose personal computer or computer 1 1 Driven media to make these general means act as electronic mail 11 1 device 9 The steps included in this program include an e-mail receiving step—S please 1 first 1 step> Used to receive e-mail itinerary data and record billion steps 9 used Let ’s read the travel information and store the journey data in the itinerary. The journey data discerning step 9 is used to memorize the 1 I 1 to determine whether the received mail is a journey email that contains the journey data. 9 Note 1 I Travel data comparison steps &gt; m The itinerary discriminating step is discriminated as an itinerary item. 1 1 In the mail, 9 compare the itinerary data included in the itinerary mail with the itinerary data recorded in the above-mentioned writing book k. The control page 1 I detected the two itinerary data by the step data fcb compared with the step. 9 Record the travel information of the itinerary mail received by the traveller. 1 1 Temporarily record the traveler ’s travel data in the travel itinerary storage means. Steps to control the amount of money. * Borrowing 1 order The above travel data comparison step has detected that there is a duplicate of the last two travel data. At the time, the itinerary mail received above will be temporarily recorded in 100 million yuan and temporarily recorded in 100 million means. Itinerary data change steps: Step 9 is used to change the itinerary information and itinerary data transfer steps recorded in the above itinerary 1 I 100 million means. When the itinerary data is changed further from the line 1 1 trip data, and the repeated itinerary data that is recorded in the above-mentioned itinerary I memory means has been cleared, 9 will be recorded in the 1 I. The repetition of the temporary 100 million credits means The itinerary data is transferred to the above itinerary 1 I 11 Means 〇1 In addition, in the above fifth embodiment &gt; Mail for registering the itinerary 1 Although the schedule mail 9 which is different from the normal mail is used, when the check 1 1 detects that there is a specific password in the body of the normal mail received, 9 the 1 I normal mail can also be used as the schedule mail. Itinerary registration * ± 1 * Wu Chengshi 1 -1 0 2-1 1 1 1 This paper size is applicable to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (21 OX 297 mm) A7 B7 Printed by the Staff Consumer Cooperative of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Fifth, the description of the invention () 1 1 t Eliminate the itinerary mail from the Muxin mail area 9 in order to save the memory of the received mail 11 1 area of the memory 01 1 If you follow the fifth embodiment, when the mail The processing and itinerary management / · —V Please! The first one is the processing. The connection of one hundred phases is linked with the processing of one side and moves forward. Reading 1 I The other— * The side processing 9 At the same time 9 If the schedule is changed In case 9, the mail processing is performed on the library back 1 I 1 and its changes. Therefore »When the mail processing and schedule management attention 1 1 matter 1 processing is connected to each other, it can be eliminated. Eliminate the troublesome work and reduce the item Further 1 1 User's burden. 3 can be changed when the itinerary is changed. W Compatible. 0 Fill out the reference symbol description page 1 I 2 1 A, 2 1 B, 2 1 C.. Email device 1 1 I 5. LA N 1 1 15 WAN 1 Order 1] B, 11 C, 1 1 V.. Email service department 1 2 2 Input department 1 1 2 3 Output department 1 I 2 4 Control department 1 1 2 5 Memory department 2 6 Communication control unit 1 I 3 1 Mouse 1 1 3 2 Keyboard 1 | 4 1 Output control 1142 display means of portion 1 1 5 1 CPU 1 6 1 RAM 1 1 1 6 2 RO Μ 1 1 -1 0 4 - 1 1 the present paper scale applies China National Standard (CNS) A4 size (210X 297 mm)

Claims (1)

A8 B8 C8 D8 、申請專利枕圍 1. 一種電子郵件裝置,其特徵是具備有: 電子郵件收信手段,用來接受電子郵件; 行程資料記億手段,用來記億行程資料; 行程郵件辨別手段,用來辨別藉由上述電子郵件收 信手段所收信到之電子郵件是否為包含有行程資料之 行程郵件; 行程資料比較手段,藉由上述行程郵件辨別手段辨 別為上述電子郵件收信手段所收信到之電子郵件為行 程郵件時,就將上述行程郵件所包含之行程資料和上 述行程資料記億手段所記億之行程資料加以比較,藉 以檢測該兩個行程資料之間有無重複; 行程資料記億控制手段,藉由上述行程資料比較手 段之比較,檢測到上逑兩個行程資料之間並無重複時 ,就將上逑行程郵件所包含之行程資料記億在上述行 程資料記憶手段; 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 (請先閩讀背面之注意事哆再填寫本頁) 電子郵件自動發信手段,用來自動發送電子郵件; 第一電子郵件自動發信控制手段,藉由上逑行程資 料比較手段之比較,檢測到上述兩個行程資料之間有 重複時,就使上述電子郵件自動發信手段,將具有可 避免上述重複的行程變更之有關資訊的電子郵件,自 動發信給上述行程郵件之發信人;和 變更行程資料記憶控制手段,藉由上逑電子郵件自 動發信手段發送具有上述資訊之電子郵件後,因應具 有該資訊之電子郵件,使能避免上逑重複般,通知變 -1 0 5 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) Α4規格(210X297公釐) A8 Βδ C8 D8 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 六、申請專利範 圍 1 1 更 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 的 電 子 郵 件 9 藉 以 1 1 上 逑 電 子 郵 件 收 信 手 段 被 收 到 時 9 就 將 根 據 上 述 資 訊 1 1 變 更 之 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 行程 資 料 記 億 在 上 逑 行(^ 請 1 先 1 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 〇 閲 1 | 2 .如 申 請 專 利 範 圍 第 1 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 9 其 中 上 逑 行 背 © 1 1 之 1 1 程 資 料 具 有 用 以 指 定 '特 定 時 間 帶 之 時 間 帶 資 料 注 意 1 1 事 1 i 上 逑 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 手 段 乃 將 上 述 兩 個 行 程 資 料 所 具 項 再 1 I 有 之 時 間 帶 資 料 加 以 比 較 5 藉 以 檢 測 該 兩 .行 程 資 料 所 填 寫 本 I 具 有 之 時 間 帶 資 料 間 之 fnr· Μ 重 複 〇 頁 1 1 3 .如 申 請 專 利 範 圍 第 1 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 9 其 中 上 逑 行 1 1 1 程 資 料 具 有 用 以 指 定 特 定 時 間 帶 之 時 間 帶 資 料 1 1 更 具 有 空 白 時 間 帶 檢 測 手 段 * 用 來 檢 測 即 使 在 上 述 1 訂 行 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 所 記 億 之 任 一 行 程 資 料 之 時 間 帶 資 1 料 所 指 定 之 時 間 帶 亦 不 被 包 含 的 空 白 時 間 帶 1 1 上 述 第 1 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 控 制 手 段 乃 將 記 載 有 以 1 I 上 逑 空 白 時 間 帶 檢 測 手 段 所 撿 測 的 空 白 時 間 帶 之 定 形 1 1 電 子 郵 件 令 上 述 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 手 段 商 動 發 信 〇 r 4 .如 串 請 專 利 範 net 圍 第 3 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 » 其 中 上 述 第 1 I --- 電 子 郵 件 自 動 發 信 控 制 手 段 用 來 將 記 載 有 上 述 空 白 1 1 時 間 帶 撿 測 手 段 所 檢 測 到 之 空 白 時 間 帶 和 特 定 密 碼 之 1 定 形 電 子 郵 件 , 令 上 述 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 手 段 自 動 發 1 1 信 1 1 上 述 變 更 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 手 段 即 緖 由 上 述 電 子 郵 1 | 件 收 信 手 段 收 到 記 載 有 上 述 特 定 密 碼 之 電 子 郵 件 時 9 1 I -1 0 6 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A8 B8 C8 D8 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印裝 六、申請專利範圍 1 1 就 將 根 據 上 述 資 訊 所 變 更 的 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 1 1 I 行 程 資 料 使 上 述 行 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 加 以 記 億 〇 1 1 5 .如 申 請 專 利 範 圍 第 1 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 i 其 中 上 述 行 /·—S 讀 1 I 先 1 程 資 料 具 有 用 以 指 定 特 定 時 間 帶 之 時 間 帶 資 料 f 更 具 閩 1 | 備 有 * 背 1 I 之 1 1 空 白 時 間 帶 檢 測 手 段 t 用 來 檢 測 有 無 即 使 藉 具 有 在 注 意 1 1 1 上 逑 行 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 所 記 億 之 任 一 行 程 資 料 之 時 間 項 再 1 帶 資 料 所 指 定 之 時 間 帶 亦 不 被 包 含 的 空 白 時 間 帶 和 4 寫 本 k 第 —▲ 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 控 制 手 段 9 當 耢 由 上 述 空 白 頁 I 時 間 帶 檢 測 手 段 撿 測 到 並 •fnr m 上 述 空 白 時 間 帶 時 9 就 使 1 I 上 述 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 手 段 9 將 通 知 未 能 避 免 上 述 重 1 1 複 的 定 形 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 給 上 逑 行 程 郵 件 之 發 信 人。 1 訂 6 .如 串 請 專 利 範 圍 第 1 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 t 其 中 更 具 有 1 第 三 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 控 制 手 段 , 將 上 逑 變 更 行 程 資 1 1 料 記 億 控 制 手 段 根 據 上 逑 資 訊 變 更 的 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 1 I 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 9 令 上 述 行 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 記 億 時 9 1 1 就 使 上 述 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 手 段 * 將 通 知 根 據 該 資 訊 f 而 變 更 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 而 使 其 記 億 在 該 1 I 行 程 資 料 記 億 手 段 的 定 形 電 子 郵 件 9 自 動 發 信 給 該 行 1 程 郵 件 之 發 信 人 〇 I | 7 .如 申 士主 m 專 利 範 圍 第 3 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 J 其 中 當 現 在 I I 之 時 刻 已 超 過 m 由 上 述 第 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 控 制 手 1 1 段 令 上 逑 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 手 段 白 動 發 信 之 上 述 定 形 1 I 電 子 郵 件 所 記 載 之 空 白 時 間 帶 之 開 始 時 刻 時 上 述 之 1 1 -1 0 7 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(2.10X297公釐) A8 B8 C8 D8 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 六、申請專利範圍 1 變 更 行 程 資 料 記 憶 控 制 手 段 就 刪 除 行 程 郵 件 〇 1 1 8 — 種 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 9 其 特 徵 為 具 有 1 1 郵 件 收 信 手 段 , 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 /·—S 請 1 先 1 行 程 記 億 手 段 9 用 來 記 億 行 程 資 料 閱 讀 1 背 1 變 更 手 段 , 用 來 變 更 該 行 程 記 憶 手 段 之 記 憶 内 容 9 面 I 之 1 和 注 意 1 I 事 1 白 動 發 信 手 段 &gt; 當 藉 由 該 變 更 手 段 加 以 變 更 時 9 將 項 再 1 與 該 變 更 内 容 對 m VIA*' 的 内 容 之 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 給 待 定 本 k 對 象 者 0 頁 S__^ I 9 .如 請 專 利 範 圍 第 8 項 之 電 子 郵 件 裝 置 9 其 中 上 述 變 1 更 手 段 是 行 程 追 加 手 段 9 用 來 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 追 1 1 加 新 行 程 , 當 -4—I* 緒 由 該 行 程 追 加 手 段 追 加 行 程 時 9 上 述 1 訂 白 動 發 信 手 段 就 對 與 該 迫 加 之 行 程 有 關 之 對 象 1 白 動 1 發 送 定 形 郵 件 者 〇 1 10.如申請專利範圍第8 項之電子郵件裝置, 其中上述 1 I 變 更 手 段 是 行 程 追 加 手 段 9 用 來 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 1 1 追 加 新 行 程 9 當 藉 由 該 行 程 追 加 手 段 追 加 行 程 時 Ifl 上 述 白 動 發 信 手 段 就 對 與 該 追 加 之 行 程 有 關 Ζ 對 象 5 1 1 白 動 發 送 定 形 郵 件 上 ¥ 收 信 手 段 在 收 到 對 該 白 動 發 1 I 信 的 定 形 郵 件 之 回 信 郵 件 時 9 就 因 應 該 回 信 郵 件 之 内 1 容 變 更 被 記 憶 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 之 行 程 内 容 者 〇 1 | U .如申請專利範圍第8 項之電子郵件裝置, 其中上述 1 I 變 更 手 段 是 行 程 抹 消 手 段 &gt; 用 來 抹 消 被 記 憶 在 上 述 行 1 | 程 記 億 手 段 之 行 程 9 當 藉 由 該 行 程 抹 消 手 段 抹 消 行 程 1 I -1 08 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(21.0X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A8 B8 C8 D8 穴、申請專利範圍 時,上述自動發信手段就對與該被抹消行程肴關之對 象,自動發送定形郵件。 12. —種電子郵件裝置,其特徵為具有: 郵件收信手段,用來接受電子郵件; 行程記億手段,用來記憶行程資料; 辨別手段,用來辨別藉由上述郵件收信手段所收信 到之電子郵件是否為包含有行程資料之行程郵件; 比較手段,當藉由該辨別手段辨別為行程郵件時, 就將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料和上述行程記億手 段所記億之行程資料加以比較; 記憶控制手段,當藉由該比較手段檢測到該兩個行 程資料並無重複時,將收信到的行程郵件之行程資料 令上逑行程記億手段記億;和 自動發信手段,當藉由上逑比較手段檢測到上逑兩 痼行程資料有重複時,就對所收到的行程郵件之發信 源自動發送定形郵件者。 13. 如申請專利範圍第12項之電子郵件裝置,其中上述 行程資料具有用以指定特定時間帶之時間帶資料,上 述比較手段即用來辨別上述兩個行程資料内之時間帶 資料是否重複。 1 4 . 一種電子郵件裝置,其特徴為具有: 郵件收信手段,用來接受電子郵件; 行程記憶手段,用來記億行程資料; 辨別手段,用來辨別藉由上述郵件收信手段所收信 -10 9- 本紙張度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4^格(210X297公釐) (詩先閔讀背面之注意事磺再填寫本K) k. 訂 ABCD 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印策 六、申請專利範圍 1 Ί 到 之 電 子 郵 件 是 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 1 1 bb 較 手 段 9 當 藉 由 該 辨 別 手 段 辨 別 為 行 程 郵 件 時 9 1 1 就 使 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 上 逑 行 程 記 億 手 ✓-S 請 1 先 1 段 所 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 bb 較 閎 讀 1 背 1 記 億 控 制 手 段 , 當 藉 由 該 比 較 手 段 檢 測 到 該 兩 個 行 ft I 之 1 程 資 料 並 不 重 複 時 用 來 將 收 信 到 的 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 注 意 1 事 1 資 料 使 上 述 行 程 記 憶 手 段 記 億 項 再 1 I 條 件 辨 別 手 段 當 藉 由 上 述 比 較 手 段 撿 測 到 上 述 兩 % 寫 本 l·- I 値 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 用 來 辨 別 收 信 到 之 行 程 郵 件 是 頁 1 I 苔 滿 足 指 定 之 條 件 和 1 1 1 記 億 更 新 手 段 , 當 該 條 件 辨 別 手 段 辨 別 為 能 滿 足 上 1 1 述 指 定 條 件 時 用 來 刪 除 被 記 億 在 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 1 訂 的重複之行程資料 9' 同 時 並 將 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 1 行 程 資 料 令 上 述 行 程 記 億 手 段 記 億 者 Ο I 1 15.如申請專利範圍第14項之電子郵件裝置, 其中上述 1 I 行 程 資 料 具 有 用 以 指 定 特 定 時 間 帶 之 時 間 帶 資 料 9 上 丨 述 比 較 手 段 即 用 來 辨 別 上 逑 兩 個 行 程 資 料 内 之 時 間 帶 密 資 料 是 杏 重 複 Ο 1 | 16.如申請專利範圍第14項之電子郵件裝置, 其中上逑 I 1 指 定 條 件 為 上 述 .行 程 郵 件 的 發 信 源 位 址 預 先 被 指 定 之 1 1 位 址 〇 1 I 17.- -種電子郵件裝置, 其特徵為具有 1 1 郵 件 收 信 手 段 9 用 來 接 受 郵 件 9 1 | 行 程 記 i.-«£ fe 手 段 , 用 來 記 偉 IS、 行 程 資 料 &gt; I -1 1 0 - 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 六、申請專利範圍 A8 B8 C8 D8 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 之 ,手 行程 兩郵 之 在之行ϊί上資 旦、兩之 到 時億 傾行 逑程 段 ,空之 上,t 更述件 信 件記 兩之 上行 手 時淨複 中料5 中上郵 收 郵程 該件 到之 億 更已重 其資Btf其 m 程 所 程行 到郵 測到 記 變料的 帶之 /測行 段;行述 測程 檢收 程 以資段 置間内 置檢之 手件為上 檢行 段所 行 加程手 g 時# 段到 信郵別和 段之 手億 述 段行億 件之sf件手信 收程辨料 手到 較記 上 手之記 '。 帶 t 郵較收 件行段資;較信;比時 在 更複時段子間^ 子比述 郵之手程較比收億逑暫 億 變重暫手 時_ 電述上 述料別行比該將記上來 記 該的述億之定述 之上對1-上資辨之以由來段由用 被 由憶上記 特上 項由就111 別程該含加藉用手藉, 更 藉記在程 7 定別17藉,-1 辨行由包料當,億當時 變 當所億行^指^ .^1乃時 來有藉所資,時記,複 來 ,段記述 以來 圍,複 用含當件程段複程段重 用 段手被上範用ffl範段重 ,包,郵行手重行手有 ,和手億將到 j有卩。卩手有 段為段程之制不逑億料 段;送記來送 具 複專信料 手否手行億控並上記資 手料轉程用轉-»料手重II發資 別是較該記億料令時程 更資料行,料^|資較否#|件程 辨件比將所記資料暫行;變程資述合資卩程fchf是如郵行 郵 就段 程資 ·個件 行 上場程-$行It料 3 有個 8 y 9 ---------k 取------訂------Ά ' (讀先闉讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) A8 B8 C8 D8 經濟部中央標率局員工消費合作社印製 六、申請專利範圍 1 1 發 信 源 白 動 發 送 表 示 不 能 答 m ,/ίΐΛ 該 行 程 郵 件 要 求 之 第 1 1 I 1 定 形 郵 件 ί 當 藉 由 上 述 資 料 轉 送 手 段 將 被 記 憶 在 1 1 上 述 暫 時 記 億 手 段_ 的 重 複 之 行 程 資 料 9 被 轉 送 到 上 述 ✓—S 請 先 1 1 行 程 記 億 手 段^ 時 就 白 動 發 送 將 上 述 第 1 定 形 郵 件 修 閎 讀 1 正 而 表 示 可 答 m 上 述 要 求 之 第 2 定 形 郵 件 〇 背 面 之 1 1 2 0.-徼 -種記錄媒體, 為可以記錄電 記錄有得以電腦讀出之程式, 子郵件處理之程式用來實行; 其特 注 意 事 項 再 1 1 1- 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 9 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 填 寫 本 取 I 行 程 資 料 記 憶 步 驟 , 用 來 記 億 行 程 資 料 頁 、- 1 I 行 任 郵 件 辨 別 步 驟 9 用 來 辨 別 上 述 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 1 I 驟 所 收 信 到 之 電 子 郵 件 是 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 1 1 郵 件 1 訂 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 9 當 藉 由 上 述 行 程 郵 件 辨 別 步 驟 1 辨 別 為 上 述 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 所 收 信 到 之 電 子 郵 件 為 1 1 行 程 郵 件 時 , 就 將 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 和 1 I 上 述 行 程 資 料 記 憶 步 驟 所 記 憶 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 比 較 1 藉 以 撿 測 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 之 間 有 fay m 重 複 W. 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 當 藉 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 比 較 1 I 步 驟 之 比 較 &gt; 檢 測 到 上 逑 兩 値 行 程 資 料 之 間 並 •hrf 雛 重 複 I 1 時 , 用 來 將 上 述 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 以 上 述 行 1 程 資 料 記 憶 步 驟 記 億 t 1 1 電 子 郵 件 白 動 發 信 步 驟 , 用 來 白 動 地 發 送 電 子 郵 件; 1 1 第 一 電 子 郵 件 自 動 發 信 控 制 步 驟 &gt; 當 藉 由 上 述 行 程 1 1 資 料 比 較 步 驟 之 fcb 較 9 檢 測 到 上 述 兩 値 行 程 資 料 之 間 1 1 -1 12- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準'(CNS ) A4規格(21.0X297公釐) A8 B8 C8 D8 六、申請專利範圍 有重複時,就在上述電子郵件自動發信步驟,將具有 避免上述重複之行程變更有關資訊之電子郵件,自動 發信給上述行程郵件之發信人;和 變更行程資料記億控制步驟,在藉由上述電子郵件 自動發信步驟發送具有上述資訊之電子郵件後,因應 具有該資訊之電子郵件,使能避免上述重複般,通知 變更上逑行程郵件所包含之行程資料的電子郵件,藉 由上述電子郵件收信步驟收信到,就將根據上述資訊 所變更之上述行程郵件所包含的行程資料,以上述行 程資料記億步驟加以記憶者。 21. —種記錄媒體,記錄有得以電腦讀取之程式,其特 徵是可以記錄電子郵件處理之程式用來實行; 電子郵件收信步驟,用來接受電子郵件; 行程資料變更步驟,用來變更記億行程資料用之行 程資料記億手段的行程之記億内容;和 電子郵件自動發信步驟,當藉由該行程資料變更步 驟施行行程之變更時,用來將與該變更内容對應的内 容之電子郵件自動發信給特定對象。 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 I I - - - - - — I II - - .--*- m m -- ----- 1H - (請先閲讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁) 22. —種記錄媒體,記錄有得以電腦讀取之程式,其特徵 是可以記錄電子郵件處理之程式用來實行: 電子郵件收信步驟,用來接受電子郵件; 行程資料辨別步驟,用來辨別收受到之電子郵件是 否為包含有行程資料之行程郵件; 行程資料比較步驟,當藉由該行程資料辨別步驟辨 -1 1 3 -本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS )八4規格(210X297公釐) A8 B8 C8 D8 經濟部中央標隼局員工消費合作社印製 六、申請專利範圍 1 1 別 為 行 程 郵 件 時 9 就 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 1 1 1 料 和 被 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 fcb 較 1 1 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 » 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 祷 1 先 1 驟 檢 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 並 不 重 複 時 9 用 來 記 億 收 信 聞 1 I 到 之 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 和 背 ι6 1 I 之 1 I 行 程 資 料 白 動 發 信 步 驟 t 當 箱 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 bb 較 注 意 1 1 事 1 步 驟 檢 測 到 上 述 兩 値 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 &gt; 用 來 對 收 信 項 再 1 到 之 行 程 郵 件 之 發 信 源 自 動 發 送 定 形 郵 件 〇 填 禽 本 2 3.- -種記錄媒體, 記錄有得以電腦讀取之程式, 其特徽 頁 '—^ | 是 可 以 記 錄 電 子 郵 件 處 理 之 程 式 用 來 實 行 1 電 子 郵 件 收 信 步 驟 9 用 來 接 受 電 子 郵 件 1 1 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 9 用 來 辨 別所收信到之電子郵件是 1 1 丁 否 為 包 含 有 行 程 資 料 之 行 程 郵 件 1 I 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 辨 別 步 驟 辨 1 別 為 行 程 郵 件 時 » 就 將 該 行 程 郵 件 所 包 含 之 行 程 資 料 1 I 和 被 記 億 之 行 程 資 料 加 以 bb 較 1 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 ί 當 藉 由 該 行 程 資 料 fcb 較 步 驟 撿 測 到 該 兩 個 行 程 資 料 並 不 重 複 時 用 來 記 億 收 信 I I 到 之 行 程 郵 件 之 行 程 資 料 1 1 a 郵 件 條 件 辨 別 步 驟 &gt; 當 藉 由 上 述 行 程 資 料 比 較 步 驟 1 卜 撿 測 到 上 述 兩 個 行 程 資 料 有 重 複 時 9 用 來 辨 別 收 信 到 1 1 之 行 程 郵 件 是 否 滿 足 指 定 之 條 件 和 I 1 行 程 資 料 記 億 控 制 步 驟 &gt; 當 藉 由 該 郵 件 條 件 辨 別 步 1 1 驟 辨 別 為 能 滿 足 上 述 指 定 條 件 時 , 用 來 刪 除 被 記 億 的 1 I -1 14- 1 1 1 1 本紙張尺度逋用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) 經濟部中央標準局員工消費合作社印製 A8 B8 C8 D8 六、申請專利範圍 重複之行程資料,和用來記憶上述行程郵件所包含之 行程資料。 24.—種記錄媒體,記錄有得以電腦讀取之程式,其特徵 是可以記錄電子郵件處理之程式用來實行: 電子郵件收倍步驟,用來接受電子郵件; 行程資料記億步驟,用來將行程資料記億在行程記 億手段; 行程資料辨別步驟,用來辨別收信到之郵件是否為 包含有行程資料之行程郵件; 行程資料比較步驟,當藉由該行程資料辨別步驟辨 別為行程郵件時,就將該行程郵件所包含之行程資料 和上逑行程記憶手段所記憶之行程資料加以比較; 行程資料記億控制步驟,當藉由該行程資料比較步 驟檢測到該兩個行程資料並不重複時,用來將收信到 之行程郵件的行程資料記億在上逑之行程記億手段; 行程資料暫時記億控制步驟,當藉由上逑行程資料 比較步驟檢測到上述兩艏行程資料有重複時,用來暫 時記億上逑收信到之行程郵件; 行程資料變更步驟,用來變更被記億在上述行程記 憶手段之行程資料;和 行程資料轉送步驟,當藉由該行程資料變更步驟施 行變更時,在上述行程記億手段所記億的重複之行程 .資料已被淨空之場合,用來將上述被暫時記億的重複 之行程資料轉送到上述行程記憶手段。 -1 1 5 - 本紙張尺度適用中國國家標準(CNS ) A4規格(210X297公釐) (請先閱讀背面之注意事項再填寫本頁)A8 B8 C8 D8, patent application pillow 1. An e-mail device, which is characterized by: E-mail receiving means for receiving e-mail; Itinerary data recording means for recording 100 million itinerary information; Itinerary identification for itinerary Means for discriminating whether the email received by the above-mentioned email receiving means is an itinerary that includes itinerary data; itinerary data comparison means, by using the above-mentioned itinerary email discriminating means, as the above-mentioned email receiving means When the received e-mail is an itinerary email, the itinerary data contained in the above itinerary email and the itinerary data recorded in the above hundred million means of billing means are compared to detect whether there is a duplication between the two itinerary data; The itinerary data recording control method, through the comparison of the above-mentioned itinerary data comparison means, when it is detected that there is no overlap between the last two itinerary data, the itinerary data included in the last itinerary email is recorded in the above itinerary data memory Means; Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs Note: Please fill in this page again.) The automatic email sending method is used to automatically send emails. The first automatic email sending control method is to detect the above two itinerary data by comparing the previous itinerary data comparison means. When there is overlap between them, the above-mentioned automatic e-mail sending means will be automatically sent to the sender of the above-mentioned itinerary e-mails with relevant information that can avoid the above-mentioned itinerary change; and the itinerary data storage control means will be changed. After sending the e-mail with the above information by the automatic e-mail sending method, the e-mail with the information can be used to avoid the repetition of the e-mail and the notification changes -1 0 5-This paper standard applies the Chinese national standard (CNS) Α4 specification (210X297 mm) A8 Βδ C8 D8 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 6. Application for patents 1 1 More emails of the itinerary information included in the above itinerary emails 9 By 1 1 9 when the mail receiving means is received According to the above information 1 1 The itinerary information contained in the above itinerary emails that have been changed is recorded on the website (^ Please refer to the first way to record the 100 million yuan means 0 through 1 | 2. For example, the email device 9 in the scope of patent application 9 of which上 行行 背 © 1 1 of 1 1 The journey data has time zone information to specify the 'specified time zone'. Note 1 1 event 1 i The trip schedule data fcb compares the above two schedule data items with 1 I There are time zone data to compare 5 to detect the two. Fill in the itinerary information. The fnr · M between the time zone data included in this I is repeated. Page 1 1 3. For example, the e-mail device of the first scope of the patent application 9 9 L 1 1 1 process data has time zone data to specify a specific time zone 1 1 has blank time zone detection means * It is used to detect the blank time zone that is not included even if the time zone data of any one of the itinerary data recorded in the above-mentioned 1 booking data recording method is 100 million yuan. The sending control means is to record the shape of the blank time zone recorded by the 1 I blank time zone detection method. 1 1 The e-mail causes the above-mentioned e-mail white-sending means to send a letter. 4 Please patent the e-mail device around item 3 »where the above 1 I --- automatic email transmission control means is used to record the blank time zone and 1 fixed email with specific password, so that the above-mentioned email can be automatically sent by the white letter sending means 1 1 letter 1 1 100 million control means immediately when the above-mentioned electronic mail 1 | mail receiving means received the e-mail with the above-mentioned specific password 9 1 I -1 0 6-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A8 B8 C8 D8 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 6. Application for patent scope 1 1 The 1 1 I itinerary data included in the above itinerary emails changed based on the above information will be recorded in the above itinerary data Billion means to record billions. 151. For example, the electronic mail device of the first scope of the patent application i where the above line / · —S read 1 I first pass data has time zone data to specify a specific time zone f more Min1 | equipped with * back 1 I 1 1 1 blank time zone detection means t is used to detect the presence or absence even if you have the attention 1 1 1 The time item of any itinerary data recorded in the list of 100 million yuan is recorded. 1 The blank time band that is not included in the time band specified by the band data and 4 copies. K — — Email white motion sender control Means 9 When the blank page I time zone detection means detects and fnr m the above blank time zone 9 makes 1 I the above-mentioned e-mail white paper transmission means 9 will notify the failure to avoid the above-mentioned duplicate 1 1 duplicate Fixed-form emails are sent to the sender of the last trip email. 1 order 6. If you request the e-mail device in item 1 of the patent scope, which has 1 third e-mail white letter sending control means, it will change the listing cost of the listing. 1 1 It is expected that the control means will be changed according to the listing information. The itinerary information contained in the above-mentioned itinerary email 1 I 9 The above-mentioned itinerary information is recorded in 100 million hours 9 1 1 The above-mentioned e-mail is sent in white * * The notification will be changed based on the information f Formal emails that are recorded by the itinerary data in the 1 I. It is a fixed email 9 that records the billions of dollars in the itinerary. 9 Automatically sends the letter to the sender of the bank's 1-way email. 0I | 7. J Among them, when the moment of II has exceeded m, the above-mentioned email white-sending control controller 11 paragraph 1 orders the email white-sending method to send the white email. At the beginning of the blank time zone recorded in the above-mentioned setting 1 I above-mentioned 1 1 -1 0 7-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specifications (2.10X297 mm) A8 B8 C8 D8 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. 6. Application for patents. 1 Change the schedule data memory control means to delete the trip mail. 0 1 1 8-an email device. 9 It is characterized by 1 1 mail receiving means. Accept e-mail / · -S Please 1 First 1 Way to record 100 million trips 9 Read to record 100 million trips 1 Read 1 Change 1 means to change the content of the trip memory means 9 Face 1 and Attention 1 I Event 1 White-moving means of transmission &gt; Hours 9 Send the email of item 1 and the content of this change to m VIA * 'to the person who is waiting for the target k page 0 S __ ^ I 9. For example, please request the e-mail device of item 8 of the patent scope 9 Among them, the above 1 means of change is the additional means of itinerary 9 to add 11 to the new itinerary in the above means of counting hundreds of millions. When -4-1 * is used to add an additional means by the additional means of itinerary, 9 the above 1 means of ordering white letter Regarding the object related to the forced itinerary 1 White movement 1 Those who send the fixed mail 0 1 10. For the e-mail device with the scope of patent application item 8, the above 1 I change means is the itinerary addition means 9 for the above itinerary Billion means 1 1 Add a new itinerary 9 When an itinerary is added by the itinerary addition means Ifl The above-mentioned white motion sending means is related to the additional itinerary. Z Object 5 1 1 White motion sends a fixed post On the receiving means, when receiving the reply mail of the fixed mail with the 1 I letter from Baidong 9, the content of the itinerary should be changed according to the content of the reply mail. 01 | U . For example, the electronic mail device of the eighth item of the patent application, wherein the above 1 I change means is a stroke erasing means &gt; for erasing the strokes which are memorized in the above line 1 | Cheng Jiyi means 9 when erasing by the stroke erasing means Itinerary 1 I -1 08-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (21.0X297 mm). When printed by A8, B8, C8, and D8 holes in the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs, the scope of patent application, The above-mentioned automatic letter sending method automatically sends a fixed email to the object related to the deleted schedule. 12. An electronic mail device, which is characterized by: means for receiving mail, for receiving e-mail; means for recording trips, for memorizing travel information; means for distinguishing, which is used for distinguishing received by the means for receiving mail Whether the received email is an itinerary mail containing itinerary information; for comparison means, when it is determined as an itinerary mail by the discrimination means, the itinerary data included in the itinerary mail and the amount recorded in the above itinerary counting method Comparison of itinerary data; memory control means, when it is detected by the comparison means that the two itinerary data are not duplicated, the itinerary data of the received itinerary email is recorded on the itinerary and recorded in 100 million; and automatically sent The letter means, when it is detected by the comparison means that the schedule data of the two schedules are duplicated, the fixed email is automatically sent to the source of the received schedule email. 13. If the e-mail device under the scope of patent application No. 12 is used, the above itinerary data has time zone data for specifying a specific time zone, and the above comparison means is used to distinguish whether the time zone data in the above two itinerary data is duplicated. 14. An electronic mail device, which particularly has: means for receiving mail, for receiving e-mail; means for remembering travel, for recording data of 100 million trips; means for distinguishing, which is used for distinguishing received by the means for receiving mail Letter-10 9- This paper is in accordance with Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 ^ (210X297 mm) (Notes on the back of Shi Xianmin, please fill in this K) k. Order ABCD staff consumption of the Central Bureau of Standards Cooperative cooperative policy 6. Scope of patent application 1 是否 Whether the emails received are itinerary mails containing itinerary information 1 1 bb Comparison method 9 When it is identified as itinerary mails by this discrimination means 9 1 1 The stroke data and the last stroke are recorded in hundreds of millions of hands. ✓-S Please add bb to the stroke data recorded in the first and first paragraphs and compare them with each other. When the two lines are detected by the comparison method, ft I When the process data is not duplicated, it is used to note the itinerary of the received itinerary. It is noted that 1 event 1 data makes the above journey memory means memorize 100 million items and 1 I condition discrimination means when the above two% are detected by the above comparison means. Manuscript l ·-I 値 The itinerary is used to identify the received itinerary when the itinerary information is repeated. Page 1 I The moss meets the specified conditions and 1 1 1 billion update means. When the condition identification means is determined to meet the above 1 1 It is used to delete the duplicate itinerary data booked in the above-mentioned itinerary counting means 1 when the specified conditions are stated 9 '. At the same time, the itinerary information included in the above itinerary email will be used to record the above itinerary counting means. 0 I 1 15 For example, the electronic mail device under the scope of application for patent No. 14 wherein the above 1 I itinerary data has time zone data for specifying a specific time zone 9 The comparison method mentioned above is used to identify the time-band dense data in the two schedule data of the last two repeats. 0 1 | 16. For the email device under the scope of patent application No. 14, where the first I 1 specified conditions are The source address of the itinerary mail is specified in advance as a 11 address. 〇1 I 17.- A type of electronic mail device, which is characterized by having 1 1 mail receiving means 9 for receiving mail 9 1 | Itinerary i .- «£ fe means to record Wei IS, itinerary information &gt; I -1 1 0-1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to China National Standard (CNS) A4 specification (210X297 mm) 6. Scope of patent application A8 B8 C8 D8 Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economy When the two hands were on the net, they recombined the materials. Yigeng has already re-invested its assets. Btf has completed the process of measuring and recording the tape / posting section of the variable material; the description of the inspection and inspection process is based on the hand piece of the built-in inspection of the asset section as the upper inspection section. When the trip is over, it ’s time # Duan to Xinbeibei and Duan Zhishou, Yishou Duan, Yishang, sf, and sf. The hand-off process is to tell you what to do. The postal mail with t is more expensive than the receiving line; more reliable; more time-consuming than in the time period ^ Zi Bishu's hand travel ratio is more than 100 million yuan, and the time is changed. Will write down to write down the description of the description of the hundred million on the 1-up to identify the origin of the paragraph by the use of the memory of the above-mentioned item of the above-mentioned reason on the 111 in addition to the process should be borrowed by hand, more debited in the process 7 Definitely 17 borrows, -1 identify the line by the package, when the billions became the place of the billion lines ^ refers to ^. ^ 1 is from time to time borrowed funds, time records, come back, paragraph descriptions since the cycle, reuse When the re-use section of the repetitive section of the piece is re-used by the ffl section, the parcel, the post office, the re-use, and the number of hands will reach j. There is a paragraph for the system. The system is not worth 100 million yuan; send a note to send a reply letter, whether the hand is in charge of the billion control, and write down the capital transfer. The 100 million records make the time schedule more informative, and the materials ^ | 资 比 不 # | pieces process identification than temporary recording of the recorded information; variable process description joint venture process fchf Cheng- $ 行 It Material 3 There is an 8 y 9 --------- k Take -------- Order ------ Ά ((Read first, read the notes on the back, then fill out this Page) This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (210X297 mm) A8 B8 C8 D8 Printed by the Employees' Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 6. Scope of patent application 1 1 White source sent by the source said it could not answer m, / ίΐΛ The 1st I 1 shaped mail required by the mail for this itinerary When the above-mentioned data transfer means will be stored in 1 1 The repeated itinerary data of the above-mentioned temporary billing means 9 is transferred to the above ✓—S Please First 1 1 trip to record 100 million means ^ when Baidong sent will The above 1st fixed mail repair 1 reads positively, which means that it can answer m. The 2nd fixed mail of the above request. 1 1 2 0.- 徼 -type of recording medium on the back side, in order to record electric records, there are programs that can be read by a computer. The sub-mail processing program is used for implementation; its special precautions are followed by 1 1 1- E-mail receiving step 9 for receiving e-mails to fill in this I-trip itinerary data storage step, for recording 100 million itinerary information pages,-1 I-line Step 9 is used to identify the e-mail. Step 1 I is used to identify whether the e-mail received is an itinerary containing itinerary information. 1 1 Mail 1 Itinerary fcb is compared with step 9. 1 It is determined that the email received by the above email receiving step is 1 1 when itinerary mail, itinerary information and 1 I included in the above email The stroke data stored in the stroke data memory step are compared 1 to detect that there is a fay m between the two stroke data. Repeat the W. The stroke data is recorded in 100 million control steps. When the above stroke data is compared 1 I step comparison &gt; detected When repeating I 1 between the last two trip data and • hrf, it is used to record the itinerary data included in the above-mentioned itinerary with the above-mentioned one-line data storage step. T 1 1 E-mail white-motion sending step, Send the e-mail in vain; 1 1 The first e-mail automatic transmission control step &gt; When the fcb of the data comparison step 1 of the above itinerary is 9 compared with the above two itinerary data is detected 1 1 -1 12- 1 1 1 1 This paper size applies to Chinese National Standards (CNS) A4 specifications (21.0X297 mm) A8 B8 C8 D8 6. When there is a duplication in the scope of patent application, the above electronic The automatic email sending step will automatically send emails with information about the itinerary changes to avoid the above itinerary, and automatically send the email to the sender of the above email; After sending the e-mail with the above information, the e-mail with the information should be used to avoid the above-mentioned repetition and notify the e-mail of changing the itinerary information included in the last itinerary email. , Who will remember the itinerary steps in the itinerary information contained in the above itinerary email changed based on the above information. 21. —A recording medium containing a program that can be read by a computer, which is characterized by a program that can record e-mail processing for implementation; an e-mail receiving step for receiving e-mail; a schedule data changing step for changing Billion content of the itinerary for billing billions of itinerary data; and an automatic email sending step for changing the content corresponding to the content of the itinerary when the itinerary is changed through the itinerary change step. Emails are automatically sent to specific people. Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs II------I II--.-- *-mm------ 1H-(Please read the precautions on the back before filling out this page) 22 . — A recording medium with a program that can be read by a computer, which is characterized by a program that can record e-mail processing for implementation: e-mail receiving steps to receive e-mail; itinerary data identifying steps to identify receiving Whether the received e-mail is an itinerary mail containing itinerary information; the itinerary information comparison step, when identified by the itinerary identification step -1 1 3-This paper size applies the Chinese National Standard (CNS) 8 4 specifications (210X297 mm) ) A8 B8 C8 D8 Printed by the Consumers' Cooperative of the Central Bureau of Standards of the Ministry of Economic Affairs 6. Scope of patent application 1 1 When it is not an itinerary email 9 The itinerary information included in the itinerary email is 1 1 1 Add fcb compared to 1 1 Itinerary data is recorded in 100 million control steps »When using this itinerary data fcb Compare step 1 When the two itinerary data are detected in the first step and the two are not repeated, 9 is used to record the travel information and back of the travel email from 1 I to 6 1 I to 1 I itinerary data. The above itinerary information bb is more careful. 1 1 event 1 When the above two itinerary information is detected to be duplicated &gt; It is used to automatically send a shaped email to the source of the itinerary email that arrives again 1 0 Fill out the bird's book 2 3. --A kind of recording medium, which has a program that can be read by a computer. Its special emblem page '— ^ | is a program that can record e-mail processing. It is used to implement 1 e-mail receiving step 9 for receiving e-mail 1 1 itinerary data identification Step 9 is used to identify whether the received e-mail is 1 1 or not it is the itinerary mail containing itinerary information 1 I itinerary Data fcb Compare steps When the 1 is identified as the itinerary by the itinerary discriminating step »Add bb to the itinerary data 1 I and the itinerary data recorded in the itinerary, and bb than 1 Itinerary data is recorded in 100 million control steps. Ί When the two itinerary data are detected by using the itinerary data fcb, and the two itinerary data are not duplicated, it is used to record the itinerary information of the itinerary mail to the billion mail II. 1 1 a Mail condition identification step &gt; When the above itinerary data is used Comparison step 1 When the above two itinerary data are detected to be duplicated, 9 is used to distinguish whether the mail received from 1 to 1 1 meets the specified conditions and I 1 itinerary data recording control steps.> When identified by the mail conditions Step 1 1 It is used to delete the 1 I -1 14- 1 1 1 1 paper rule when it is determined to meet the above specified conditions. Degrees are printed in Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm). Printed by the Consumer Cooperatives of the Central Standards Bureau of the Ministry of Economic Affairs. A8 B8 C8 D8. Itinerary information. 24.—A kind of recording medium with a program that can be read by a computer, which is characterized by a program that can record e-mail processing for implementation: E-mail double step to receive e-mail; Itinerary data to record billion steps to Record itinerary data in the itinerary. In the itinerary identification step, it is used to identify whether the received mail is an itinerary that contains the itinerary data. In the itinerary data comparison step, when it is identified as the itinerary by the itinerary data identification step When mail is sent, compare the itinerary data contained in the itinerary mail with the itinerary data stored in the previous itinerary memorization means; record the control steps of the travel data, and when the two itinerary data are detected by the itinerary data comparison step, When there is no repetition, the itinerary data used to record the itinerary of the itinerary mail received in the last one is recorded; the itinerary data is temporarily recorded in the hundred million control steps. When the above two itinerary is detected by the previous itinerary data comparison step When the data is duplicated, it is used to temporarily record the itinerary emails received by Yi Shang. To change the itinerary data recorded in the above-mentioned itinerary memory means; and the itinerary data transfer step, when the change is performed by the itinerary data change step, the repeated itinerary recorded in the above-mentioned itinerary means is recorded. The data has been cleared. In this case, it is used to transfer the above-mentioned repeated itinerary data temporarily recorded to 100 million to the above-mentioned itinerary memory means. -1 1 5-This paper size is applicable to Chinese National Standard (CNS) A4 (210X297 mm) (Please read the precautions on the back before filling this page)
TW87118845A 1997-11-14 1998-11-13 Electronic mail system and storage medium storing electronic mail processing program TW379495B (en)

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP32971897A JPH11149506A (en) 1997-11-14 1997-11-14 Electronic mail device with scheduler and medium for recording electronic mail and schedule management program
JP33084397A JPH11150558A (en) 1997-11-17 1997-11-17 Electronic mail system with scheduler and medium storing electronic mail and schedule management program
JP36378197A JPH11187065A (en) 1997-12-17 1997-12-17 Electronic mail device with scheduler and medium recording program of electronic mail and schedule management
JP35446197A JPH11184929A (en) 1997-12-24 1997-12-24 Electronic mail device with scheduler, schedule automatic adjustment method by electronic mail and computer readable recording medium for recording electronic mail program with scheduler

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
TW379495B true TW379495B (en) 2000-01-11

Family

ID=27480438

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
TW87118845A TW379495B (en) 1997-11-14 1998-11-13 Electronic mail system and storage medium storing electronic mail processing program

Country Status (2)

Country Link
TW (1) TW379495B (en)
WO (1) WO1999026174A1 (en)

Families Citing this family (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP2001216427A (en) * 1999-12-17 2001-08-10 Alcatel Usa Sourcing Lp System and method for event scheduling of electronic mail base
JP6970846B1 (en) * 2021-04-08 2021-11-24 株式会社電通 Appointment system, appointment server, and program

Family Cites Families (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPH08214023A (en) * 1995-02-03 1996-08-20 Asahi Chem Ind Co Ltd Network system capable of schedule management
WO1997023853A1 (en) * 1995-12-22 1997-07-03 Philips Electronics N.V. System for communicating between a group of apparatuses
US6018343A (en) * 1996-09-27 2000-01-25 Timecruiser Computing Corp. Web calendar architecture and uses thereof
EP0851372A3 (en) * 1996-12-26 1999-08-04 Canon Kabushiki Kaisha An information processing apparatus for managing schedule data and a method therefor

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
WO1999026174A1 (en) 1999-05-27

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
KR102624941B1 (en) Generation method, program, and information processing device
KR102594732B1 (en) Authentication method, program, terminal
US20060015376A1 (en) Method and system for employee reservation of meeting rooms
US20090271303A1 (en) Electronic bill process automation
US20170220976A1 (en) System and Method of Code-based Shipping
US20080103842A1 (en) Travel cost estimating
US7216114B2 (en) Transfer of mail folders between e-mail users
US20050010464A1 (en) Method of and apparatus for managing meeting, and computer product
WO2014074340A2 (en) Remote customer mail processing
Eisenberg et al. Organize Yourself!
JP2000029963A (en) Electronic settlement system
TW379495B (en) Electronic mail system and storage medium storing electronic mail processing program
Connon The ethics of database marketing
US20110179122A1 (en) Method and Computer Program Product for Sending Messages
Sova et al. 234 tips and tricks for recruiting users as participants in usability studies
TW200945223A (en) Electronic bill process automation
JP2003016228A (en) System and method for reporting/calling payment of tax/ premium, mail transmitting device and program
Okonkwo Migrants and housing investments: Theory and evidence from Nigeria
Ascueta et al. BusTap: A Real-Time Bus Tracking Android Application
Tran Operations Setup in Bangkok, Thailand for CRCC Asia's New Global Internship Program
JP6451618B2 (en) Communication assist system, communication assist method and program
Zizka et al. Airline Overbooking: Customer (dis) Satisfaction and Communication Challenges
US20150215260A1 (en) Method for guaranteeing communication liability
JP3317976B2 (en) Schedule management system that performs travel expense settlement processing
Tribunal About the Annual Report

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
GD4A Issue of patent certificate for granted invention patent